This file is indexed.

/usr/share/libreoffice/help/en-GB/swriter.ht is in libreoffice-help-en-gb 1:6.0.3-0ubuntu1.

This file is owned by root:root, with mode 0o644.

The actual contents of the file can be viewed below.

   1
   2
   3
   4
   5
   6
   7
   8
   9
  10
  11
  12
  13
  14
  15
  16
  17
  18
  19
  20
  21
  22
  23
  24
  25
  26
  27
  28
  29
  30
  31
  32
  33
  34
  35
  36
  37
  38
  39
  40
  41
  42
  43
  44
  45
  46
  47
  48
  49
  50
  51
  52
  53
  54
  55
  56
  57
  58
  59
  60
  61
  62
  63
  64
  65
  66
  67
  68
  69
  70
  71
  72
  73
  74
  75
  76
  77
  78
  79
  80
  81
  82
  83
  84
  85
  86
  87
  88
  89
  90
  91
  92
  93
  94
  95
  96
  97
  98
  99
 100
 101
 102
 103
 104
 105
 106
 107
 108
 109
 110
 111
 112
 113
 114
 115
 116
 117
 118
 119
 120
 121
 122
 123
 124
 125
 126
 127
 128
 129
 130
 131
 132
 133
 134
 135
 136
 137
 138
 139
 140
 141
 142
 143
 144
 145
 146
 147
 148
 149
 150
 151
 152
 153
 154
 155
 156
 157
 158
 159
 160
 161
 162
 163
 164
 165
 166
 167
 168
 169
 170
 171
 172
 173
 174
 175
 176
 177
 178
 179
 180
 181
 182
 183
 184
 185
 186
 187
 188
 189
 190
 191
 192
 193
 194
 195
 196
 197
 198
 199
 200
 201
 202
 203
 204
 205
 206
 207
 208
 209
 210
 211
 212
 213
 214
 215
 216
 217
 218
 219
 220
 221
 222
 223
 224
 225
 226
 227
 228
 229
 230
 231
 232
 233
 234
 235
 236
 237
 238
 239
 240
 241
 242
 243
 244
 245
 246
 247
 248
 249
 250
 251
 252
 253
 254
 255
 256
 257
 258
 259
 260
 261
 262
 263
 264
 265
 266
 267
 268
 269
 270
 271
 272
 273
 274
 275
 276
 277
 278
 279
 280
 281
 282
 283
 284
 285
 286
 287
 288
 289
 290
 291
 292
 293
 294
 295
 296
 297
 298
 299
 300
 301
 302
 303
 304
 305
 306
 307
 308
 309
 310
 311
 312
 313
 314
 315
 316
 317
 318
 319
 320
 321
 322
 323
 324
 325
 326
 327
 328
 329
 330
 331
 332
 333
 334
 335
 336
 337
 338
 339
 340
 341
 342
 343
 344
 345
 346
 347
 348
 349
 350
 351
 352
 353
 354
 355
 356
 357
 358
 359
 360
 361
 362
 363
 364
 365
 366
 367
 368
 369
 370
 371
 372
 373
 374
 375
 376
 377
 378
 379
 380
 381
 382
 383
 384
 385
 386
 387
 388
 389
 390
 391
 392
 393
 394
 395
 396
 397
 398
 399
 400
 401
 402
 403
 404
 405
 406
 407
 408
 409
 410
 411
 412
 413
 414
 415
 416
 417
 418
 419
 420
 421
 422
 423
 424
 425
 426
 427
 428
 429
 430
 431
 432
 433
 434
 435
 436
 437
 438
 439
 440
 441
 442
 443
 444
 445
 446
 447
 448
 449
 450
 451
 452
 453
 454
 455
 456
 457
 458
 459
 460
 461
 462
 463
 464
 465
 466
 467
 468
 469
 470
 471
 472
 473
 474
 475
 476
 477
 478
 479
 480
 481
 482
 483
 484
 485
 486
 487
 488
 489
 490
 491
 492
 493
 494
 495
 496
 497
 498
 499
 500
 501
 502
 503
 504
 505
 506
 507
 508
 509
 510
 511
 512
 513
 514
 515
 516
 517
 518
 519
 520
 521
 522
 523
 524
 525
 526
 527
 528
 529
 530
 531
 532
 533
 534
 535
 536
 537
 538
 539
 540
 541
 542
 543
 544
 545
 546
 547
 548
 549
 550
 551
 552
 553
 554
 555
 556
 557
 558
 559
 560
 561
 562
 563
 564
 565
 566
 567
 568
 569
 570
 571
 572
 573
 574
 575
 576
 577
 578
 579
 580
 581
 582
 583
 584
 585
 586
 587
 588
 589
 590
 591
 592
 593
 594
 595
 596
 597
 598
 599
 600
 601
 602
 603
 604
 605
 606
 607
 608
 609
 610
 611
 612
 613
 614
 615
 616
 617
 618
 619
 620
 621
 622
 623
 624
 625
 626
 627
 628
 629
 630
 631
 632
 633
 634
 635
 636
 637
 638
 639
 640
 641
 642
 643
 644
 645
 646
 647
 648
 649
 650
 651
 652
 653
 654
 655
 656
 657
 658
 659
 660
 661
 662
 663
 664
 665
 666
 667
 668
 669
 670
 671
 672
 673
 674
 675
 676
 677
 678
 679
 680
 681
 682
 683
 684
 685
 686
 687
 688
 689
 690
 691
 692
 693
 694
 695
 696
 697
 698
 699
 700
 701
 702
 703
 704
 705
 706
 707
 708
 709
 710
 711
 712
 713
 714
 715
 716
 717
 718
 719
 720
 721
 722
 723
 724
 725
 726
 727
 728
 729
 730
 731
 732
 733
 734
 735
 736
 737
 738
 739
 740
 741
 742
 743
 744
 745
 746
 747
 748
 749
 750
 751
 752
 753
 754
 755
 756
 757
 758
 759
 760
 761
 762
 763
 764
 765
 766
 767
 768
 769
 770
 771
 772
 773
 774
 775
 776
 777
 778
 779
 780
 781
 782
 783
 784
 785
 786
 787
 788
 789
 790
 791
 792
 793
 794
 795
 796
 797
 798
 799
 800
 801
 802
 803
 804
 805
 806
 807
 808
 809
 810
 811
 812
 813
 814
 815
 816
 817
 818
 819
 820
 821
 822
 823
 824
 825
 826
 827
 828
 829
 830
 831
 832
 833
 834
 835
 836
 837
 838
 839
 840
 841
 842
 843
 844
 845
 846
 847
 848
 849
 850
 851
 852
 853
 854
 855
 856
 857
 858
 859
 860
 861
 862
 863
 864
 865
 866
 867
 868
 869
 870
 871
 872
 873
 874
 875
 876
 877
 878
 879
 880
 881
 882
 883
 884
 885
 886
 887
 888
 889
 890
 891
 892
 893
 894
 895
 896
 897
 898
 899
 900
 901
 902
 903
 904
 905
 906
 907
 908
 909
 910
 911
 912
 913
 914
 915
 916
 917
 918
 919
 920
 921
 922
 923
 924
 925
 926
 927
 928
 929
 930
 931
 932
 933
 934
 935
 936
 937
 938
 939
 940
 941
 942
 943
 944
 945
 946
 947
 948
 949
 950
 951
 952
 953
 954
 955
 956
 957
 958
 959
 960
 961
 962
 963
 964
 965
 966
 967
 968
 969
 970
 971
 972
 973
 974
 975
 976
 977
 978
 979
 980
 981
 982
 983
 984
 985
 986
 987
 988
 989
 990
 991
 992
 993
 994
 995
 996
 997
 998
 999
1000
1001
1002
1003
1004
1005
1006
1007
1008
1009
1010
1011
1012
1013
1014
1015
1016
1017
1018
1019
1020
1021
1022
1023
1024
1025
1026
1027
1028
1029
1030
1031
1032
1033
1034
1035
1036
1037
1038
1039
1040
1041
1042
1043
1044
1045
1046
1047
1048
1049
1050
1051
1052
1053
1054
1055
1056
1057
1058
1059
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064
1065
1066
1067
1068
1069
1070
1071
1072
1073
1074
1075
1076
1077
1078
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084
1085
1086
1087
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095
1096
1097
1098
1099
1100
1101
1102
1103
1104
1105
1106
1107
1108
1109
1110
1111
1112
1113
1114
1115
1116
1117
1118
1119
1120
1121
1122
1123
1124
1125
1126
1127
1128
1129
1130
1131
1132
1133
1134
1135
1136
1137
1138
1139
1140
1141
1142
1143
1144
1145
1146
1147
1148
1149
1150
1151
1152
1153
1154
1155
1156
1157
1158
1159
1160
1161
1162
1163
1164
1165
1166
1167
1168
1169
1170
1171
1172
1173
1174
1175
1176
1177
1178
1179
1180
1181
1182
1183
1184
1185
1186
1187
1188
1189
1190
1191
1192
1193
1194
1195
1196
1197
1198
1199
1200
1201
1202
1203
1204
1205
1206
1207
1208
1209
1210
1211
1212
1213
1214
1215
1216
1217
1218
1219
1220
1221
1222
1223
1224
1225
1226
1227
1228
1229
1230
1231
1232
1233
1234
1235
1236
1237
1238
1239
1240
1241
1242
1243
1244
1245
1246
1247
1248
1249
1250
1251
1252
1253
1254
1255
1256
1257
1258
1259
1260
1261
1262
1263
1264
1265
1266
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271
1272
1273
1274
1275
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282
1283
1284
1285
1286
1287
1288
1289
1290
1291
1292
1293
1294
1295
1296
1297
1298
1299
1300
1301
1302
1303
1304
1305
1306
1307
1308
1309
1310
1311
1312
1313
1314
1315
1316
1317
1318
1319
1320
1321
1322
1323
1324
1325
1326
1327
1328
1329
1330
1331
1332
1333
1334
1335
1336
1337
1338
1339
1340
1341
1342
1343
1344
1345
1346
1347
1348
1349
1350
1351
1352
1353
1354
1355
1356
1357
1358
1359
1360
1361
1362
1363
1364
1365
1366
1367
1368
1369
1370
1371
1372
1373
1374
1375
1376
1377
1378
1379
1380
1381
1382
1383
1384
1385
1386
1387
1388
1389
1390
1391
1392
1393
1394
1395
1396
1397
1398
1399
1400
1401
1402
1403
1404
1405
1406
1407
1408
1409
1410
1411
1412
1413
1414
1415
1416
1417
1418
1419
1420
1421
1422
1423
1424
1425
1426
1427
1428
1429
1430
1431
1432
1433
1434
1435
1436
1437
1438
1439
1440
1441
1442
1443
1444
1445
1446
1447
1448
1449
1450
1451
1452
1453
1454
1455
1456
1457
1458
1459
1460
1461
1462
1463
1464
1465
1466
1467
1468
1469
1470
1471
1472
1473
1474
1475
1476
1477
1478
1479
1480
1481
1482
1483
1484
1485
1486
1487
1488
1489
1490
1491
1492
1493
1494
1495
1496
1497
1498
1499
1500
1501
1502
1503
1504
1505
1506
1507
1508
1509
1510
1511
1512
1513
1514
1515
1516
1517
1518
1519
1520
1521
1522
1523
1524
1525
1526
1527
1528
1529
1530
1531
1532
1533
1534
1535
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548
1549
1550
1551
1552
1553
1554
1555
1556
1557
1558
1559
1560
1561
1562
1563
1564
1565
1566
1567
1568
1569
1570
1571
1572
1573
1574
1575
1576
1577
1578
1579
1580
1581
1582
1583
1584
1585
1586
1587
1588
1589
1590
1591
1592
1593
1594
1595
1596
1597
1598
1599
1600
1601
1602
1603
1604
1605
1606
1607
1608
1609
1610
1611
1612
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618
1619
1620
1621
1622
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636
1637
1638
1639
1640
1641
1642
1643
1644
1645
1646
1647
1648
1649
1650
1651
1652
1653
1654
1655
1656
1657
1658
1659
1660
1661
1662
1663
1664
1665
1666
1667
1668
1669
1670
1671
1672
1673
1674
1675
1676
1677
1678
1679
1680
1681
1682
1683
1684
1685
1686
1687
1688
1689
1690
1691
1692
1693
1694
1695
1696
1697
1698
1699
1700
1701
1702
1703
1704
1705
1706
1707
1708
1709
1710
1711
1712
1713
1714
1715
1716
1717
1718
1719
1720
1721
1722
1723
1724
1725
1726
1727
1728
1729
1730
1731
1732
1733
1734
1735
1736
1737
1738
1739
1740
1741
1742
1743
1744
1745
1746
1747
1748
1749
1750
1751
1752
1753
1754
1755
1756
1757
1758
1759
1760
1761
1762
1763
1764
1765
1766
1767
1768
1769
1770
1771
1772
1773
1774
1775
1776
1777
1778
1779
1780
1781
1782
1783
1784
1785
1786
1787
1788
1789
1790
1791
1792
1793
1794
1795
1796
1797
1798
1799
1800
1801
1802
1803
1804
1805
1806
1807
1808
1809
1810
1811
1812
1813
1814
1815
1816
1817
1818
1819
1820
1821
1822
1823
1824
1825
1826
1827
1828
1829
1830
1831
1832
1833
1834
1835
1836
1837
1838
1839
1840
1841
1842
1843
1844
1845
1846
1847
1848
1849
1850
1851
1852
1853
1854
1855
1856
1857
1858
1859
1860
1861
1862
1863
1864
1865
1866
1867
1868
1869
1870
1871
1872
1873
1874
1875
1876
1877
1878
1879
1880
1881
1882
1883
1884
1885
1886
1887
1888
1889
1890
1891
1892
1893
1894
1895
1896
1897
1898
1899
1900
1901
1902
1903
1904
1905
1906
1907
1908
1909
1910
1911
1912
1913
1914
1915
1916
1917
1918
1919
1920
1921
1922
1923
1924
1925
1926
1927
1928
1929
1930
1931
1932
1933
1934
1935
1936
1937
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942
1943
1944
1945
1946
1947
1948
1949
1950
1951
1952
1953
1954
1955
1956
1957
1958
1959
1960
1961
1962
1963
1964
1965
1966
1967
1968
1969
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
1986
1987
1988
1989
1990
1991
1992
1993
1994
1995
1996
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2004
2005
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
2029
2030
2031
2032
2033
2034
2035
2036
2037
2038
2039
2040
2041
2042
2043
2044
2045
2046
2047
2048
2049
2050
2051
2052
2053
2054
2055
2056
2057
2058
2059
2060
2061
2062
2063
2064
2065
2066
2067
2068
2069
2070
2071
2072
2073
2074
2075
2076
2077
2078
2079
2080
2081
2082
2083
2084
2085
2086
2087
2088
2089
2090
2091
2092
2093
2094
2095
2096
2097
2098
2099
2100
2101
2102
2103
2104
2105
2106
2107
2108
2109
2110
2111
2112
2113
2114
2115
2116
2117
2118
2119
2120
2121
2122
2123
2124
2125
2126
2127
2128
2129
2130
2131
2132
2133
2134
2135
2136
2137
2138
2139
2140
2141
2142
2143
2144
2145
2146
2147
2148
2149
2150
2151
2152
2153
2154
2155
2156
2157
2158
2159
2160
2161
2162
2163
2164
2165
2166
2167
2168
2169
2170
2171
2172
2173
2174
2175
2176
2177
2178
2179
2180
2181
2182
2183
2184
2185
2186
2187
2188
2189
2190
2191
2192
2193
2194
2195
2196
2197
2198
2199
2200
2201
2202
2203
2204
2205
2206
2207
2208
2209
2210
2211
2212
2213
2214
2215
2216
2217
2218
2219
2220
2221
2222
2223
2224
2225
2226
2227
2228
2229
2230
2231
2232
2233
2234
2235
2236
2237
2238
2239
2240
2241
2242
2243
2244
2245
2246
2247
2248
2249
2250
2251
2252
2253
2254
2255
2256
2257
2258
2259
2260
2261
2262
2263
2264
2265
2266
2267
2268
2269
2270
2271
2272
2273
2274
2275
2276
2277
2278
2279
2280
2281
2282
2283
2284
2285
2286
2287
2288
2289
2290
2291
2292
2293
2294
2295
2296
2297
2298
2299
2300
2301
2302
2303
2304
2305
2306
2307
2308
2309
2310
2311
2312
2313
2314
2315
2316
2317
2318
2319
2320
2321
2322
2323
2324
2325
2326
2327
2328
2329
2330
2331
2332
2333
2334
2335
2336
2337
2338
2339
2340
2341
2342
2343
2344
2345
2346
2347
2348
2349
2350
2351
2352
2353
2354
2355
2356
2357
2358
2359
2360
2361
2362
2363
2364
2365
2366
2367
2368
2369
2370
2371
2372
2373
2374
2375
2376
2377
2378
2379
2380
2381
2382
2383
2384
2385
2386
2387
2388
2389
2390
2391
2392
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397
2398
2399
2400
2401
2402
2403
2404
2405
2406
2407
2408
2409
2410
2411
2412
2413
2414
2415
2416
2417
2418
2419
2420
2421
2422
2423
2424
2425
2426
2427
2428
2429
2430
2431
2432
2433
2434
2435
2436
2437
2438
2439
2440
2441
2442
2443
2444
2445
2446
2447
2448
2449
2450
2451
2452
2453
2454
2455
2456
2457
2458
2459
2460
2461
2462
2463
2464
2465
2466
2467
2468
2469
2470
2471
2472
2473
2474
2475
2476
2477
2478
2479
2480
2481
2482
2483
2484
2485
2486
2487
2488
2489
2490
2491
2492
2493
2494
2495
2496
2497
2498
2499
2500
2501
2502
2503
2504
2505
2506
2507
2508
2509
2510
2511
2512
2513
2514
2515
2516
2517
2518
2519
2520
2521
2522
2523
2524
2525
2526
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531
2532
2533
2534
2535
2536
2537
2538
2539
2540
2541
2542
2543
2544
2545
2546
2547
2548
2549
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554
2555
2556
2557
2558
2559
2560
2561
2562
2563
2564
2565
2566
2567
2568
2569
2570
2571
2572
2573
2574
2575
2576
2577
2578
2579
2580
2581
2582
2583
2584
2585
2586
2587
2588
2589
2590
2591
2592
2593
2594
2595
2596
2597
2598
2599
2600
2601
2602
2603
2604
2605
2606
2607
2608
2609
2610
2611
2612
2613
2614
2615
2616
2617
2618
2619
2620
2621
2622
2623
2624
2625
2626
2627
2628
2629
2630
2631
2632
2633
2634
2635
2636
2637
2638
2639
2640
2641
2642
2643
2644
2645
2646
2647
2648
2649
2650
2651
2652
2653
2654
2655
2656
2657
2658
2659
2660
2661
2662
2663
2664
2665
2666
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674
2675
2676
2677
2678
2679
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688
2689
2690
2691
2692
2693
2694
2695
2696
2697
2698
2699
2700
2701
2702
2703
2704
2705
2706
2707
2708
2709
2710
2711
2712
2713
2714
2715
2716
2717
2718
2719
2720
2721
2722
2723
2724
2725
2726
2727
2728
2729
2730
2731
2732
2733
2734
2735
2736
2737
2738
2739
2740
2741
2742
2743
2744
2745
2746
2747
2748
2749
2750
2751
2752
2753
2754
2755
2756
2757
2758
2759
2760
2761
2762
2763
2764
2765
2766
2767
2768
2769
2770
2771
2772
2773
2774
2775
2776
2777
2778
2779
2780
2781
2782
2783
2784
2785
2786
2787
2788
2789
2790
2791
2792
2793
2794
2795
2796
2797
2798
2799
2800
2801
2802
2803
2804
2805
2806
2807
2808
2809
2810
2811
2812
2813
2814
2815
2816
2817
2818
2819
2820
2821
2822
2823
2824
2825
2826
2827
2828
2829
2830
2831
2832
2833
2834
2835
2836
2837
2838
2839
2840
2841
2842
2843
2844
2845
2846
2847
2848
2849
2850
2851
2852
2853
2854
2855
2856
2857
2858
2859
2860
2861
2862
2863
2864
2865
2866
2867
2868
2869
2870
2871
2872
2873
2874
2875
2876
2877
2878
2879
2880
2881
2882
2883
2884
2885
2886
2887
2888
2889
2890
2891
2892
2893
2894
2895
2896
2897
2898
2899
2900
2901
2902
2903
2904
2905
2906
2907
2908
2909
2910
2911
2912
2913
2914
2915
2916
2917
2918
2919
2920
2921
2922
2923
2924
2925
2926
2927
2928
2929
2930
2931
2932
2933
2934
2935
2936
2937
2938
2939
2940
2941
2942
2943
2944
2945
2946
2947
2948
2949
2950
2951
2952
2953
2954
2955
2956
2957
2958
2959
2960
2961
2962
2963
2964
2965
2966
2967
2968
2969
2970
2971
2972
2973
2974
2975
2976
2977
2978
2979
2980
2981
2982
2983
2984
2985
2986
2987
2988
2989
2990
2991
2992
2993
2994
2995
2996
2997
2998
2999
3000
3001
3002
3003
3004
3005
3006
3007
3008
3009
3010
3011
3012
3013
3014
3015
3016
3017
3018
3019
3020
3021
3022
3023
3024
3025
3026
3027
3028
3029
3030
3031
3032
3033
3034
3035
3036
3037
3038
3039
3040
3041
3042
3043
3044
3045
3046
3047
3048
3049
3050
3051
3052
3053
3054
3055
3056
3057
3058
3059
3060
3061
3062
3063
3064
3065
3066
3067
3068
3069
3070
3071
3072
3073
3074
3075
3076
3077
3078
3079
3080
3081
3082
3083
3084
3085
3086
3087
3088
3089
3090
3091
3092
3093
3094
3095
3096
3097
3098
3099
3100
3101
3102
3103
3104
3105
3106
3107
3108
3109
3110
3111
3112
3113
3114
3115
3116
3117
3118
3119
3120
3121
3122
3123
3124
3125
3126
3127
3128
3129
3130
3131
3132
3133
3134
3135
3136
3137
3138
3139
3140
3141
3142
3143
3144
3145
3146
3147
3148
3149
3150
3151
3152
3153
3154
3155
3156
3157
3158
3159
3160
3161
3162
3163
3164
3165
3166
3167
3168
3169
3170
3171
3172
3173
3174
3175
3176
3177
3178
3179
3180
3181
3182
3183
3184
3185
3186
3187
3188
3189
3190
3191
3192
3193
3194
3195
3196
3197
3198
3199
3200
3201
3202
3203
3204
3205
3206
3207
3208
3209
3210
3211
3212
3213
3214
3215
3216
3217
3218
3219
3220
3221
3222
3223
3224
3225
3226
3227
3228
3229
3230
3231
3232
3233
3234
3235
3236
3237
3238
3239
3240
3241
3242
3243
3244
3245
3246
3247
3248
3249
3250
3251
3252
3253
3254
3255
3256
3257
3258
3259
3260
3261
3262
3263
3264
3265
3266
3267
3268
3269
3270
3271
3272
3273
3274
3275
3276
3277
3278
3279
3280
3281
3282
3283
3284
3285
3286
3287
3288
3289
3290
3291
3292
3293
3294
3295
3296
3297
3298
3299
3300
3301
3302
3303
3304
3305
3306
3307
3308
3309
3310
3311
3312
3313
3314
3315
3316
3317
3318
3319
3320
3321
3322
3323
3324
3325
3326
3327
3328
3329
3330
3331
3332
3333
3334
3335
3336
3337
3338
3339
3340
3341
3342
3343
3344
3345
3346
3347
3348
3349
3350
3351
3352
3353
3354
3355
3356
3357
3358
3359
3360
3361
3362
3363
3364
3365
3366
3367
3368
3369
3370
3371
3372
3373
3374
3375
3376
3377
3378
3379
3380
3381
3382
3383
3384
3385
3386
3387
3388
3389
3390
3391
3392
3393
3394
3395
3396
3397
3398
3399
3400
3401
3402
3403
3404
3405
3406
3407
3408
3409
3410
3411
3412
3413
3414
3415
3416
3417
3418
3419
3420
3421
3422
3423
3424
3425
3426
3427
3428
3429
3430
3431
3432
3433
3434
3435
3436
3437
3438
3439
3440
3441
3442
3443
3444
3445
3446
3447
3448
3449
3450
3451
3452
3453
3454
3455
3456
3457
3458
3459
3460
3461
3462
3463
3464
3465
3466
3467
3468
3469
3470
3471
3472
3473
3474
3475
3476
3477
3478
3479
3480
3481
3482
3483
3484
3485
3486
3487
3488
3489
3490
3491
3492
3493
3494
3495
3496
3497
3498
3499
3500
3501
3502
3503
3504
3505
3506
3507
3508
3509
3510
3511
3512
3513
3514
3515
3516
3517
3518
3519
3520
3521
3522
3523
3524
3525
3526
3527
3528
3529
3530
3531
3532
3533
3534
3535
3536
3537
3538
3539
3540
3541
3542
3543
3544
3545
3546
3547
3548
3549
3550
3551
3552
3553
3554
3555
3556
3557
3558
3559
3560
3561
3562
3563
3564
3565
3566
3567
3568
3569
3570
3571
3572
3573
3574
3575
3576
3577
3578
3579
3580
3581
3582
3583
3584
3585
3586
3587
3588
3589
3590
3591
3592
3593
3594
3595
3596
3597
3598
3599
3600
3601
3602
3603
3604
3605
3606
3607
3608
3609
3610
3611
3612
3613
3614
3615
3616
3617
3618
3619
3620
3621
3622
3623
3624
3625
3626
3627
3628
3629
3630
3631
3632
3633
3634
3635
3636
3637
3638
3639
3640
3641
3642
3643
3644
3645
3646
3647
3648
3649
3650
3651
3652
3653
3654
3655
3656
3657
3658
3659
3660
3661
3662
3663
3664
3665
3666
3667
3668
3669
3670
3671
3672
3673
3674
3675
3676
3677
3678
3679
3680
3681
3682
3683
3684
3685
3686
3687
3688
3689
3690
3691
3692
3693
3694
3695
3696
3697
3698
3699
3700
3701
3702
3703
3704
3705
3706
3707
3708
3709
3710
3711
3712
3713
3714
3715
3716
3717
3718
3719
3720
3721
3722
3723
3724
3725
3726
3727
3728
3729
3730
3731
3732
3733
3734
3735
3736
3737
3738
3739
3740
3741
3742
3743
3744
3745
3746
3747
3748
3749
3750
3751
3752
3753
3754
3755
3756
3757
3758
3759
3760
3761
3762
3763
3764
3765
3766
3767
3768
3769
3770
3771
3772
3773
3774
3775
3776
3777
3778
3779
3780
3781
3782
3783
3784
3785
3786
3787
3788
3789
3790
3791
3792
3793
3794
3795
3796
3797
3798
3799
3800
3801
3802
3803
3804
3805
3806
3807
3808
3809
3810
3811
3812
3813
3814
3815
3816
3817
3818
3819
3820
3821
3822
3823
3824
3825
3826
3827
3828
3829
3830
3831
3832
3833
3834
3835
3836
3837
3838
3839
3840
3841
3842
3843
3844
3845
3846
3847
3848
3849
3850
3851
3852
3853
3854
3855
3856
3857
3858
3859
3860
3861
3862
3863
3864
3865
3866
3867
3868
3869
3870
3871
3872
3873
3874
3875
3876
3877
3878
3879
3880
3881
3882
3883
3884
3885
3886
3887
3888
3889
3890
3891
3892
3893
3894
3895
3896
3897
3898
3899
3900
3901
3902
3903
3904
3905
3906
3907
3908
3909
3910
3911
3912
3913
3914
3915
3916
3917
3918
3919
3920
3921
3922
3923
3924
3925
3926
3927
3928
3929
3930
3931
3932
3933
3934
3935
3936
3937
3938
3939
3940
3941
3942
3943
3944
3945
3946
3947
3948
3949
3950
3951
3952
3953
3954
3955
3956
3957
3958
3959
3960
3961
3962
3963
3964
3965
3966
3967
3968
3969
3970
3971
3972
3973
3974
3975
3976
3977
3978
3979
3980
3981
3982
3983
3984
3985
3986
3987
3988
3989
3990
3991
3992
3993
3994
3995
3996
3997
3998
3999
4000
4001
4002
4003
4004
4005
4006
4007
4008
4009
4010
4011
4012
4013
4014
4015
4016
4017
4018
4019
4020
4021
4022
4023
4024
4025
4026
4027
4028
4029
4030
4031
4032
4033
4034
4035
4036
4037
4038
4039
4040
4041
4042
4043
4044
4045
4046
4047
4048
4049
4050
4051
4052
4053
4054
4055
4056
4057
4058
4059
4060
4061
4062
4063
4064
4065
4066
4067
4068
4069
4070
4071
4072
4073
4074
4075
4076
4077
4078
4079
4080
4081
4082
4083
4084
4085
4086
4087
4088
4089
4090
4091
4092
4093
4094
4095
4096
4097
4098
4099
4100
4101
4102
4103
4104
4105
4106
4107
4108
4109
4110
4111
4112
4113
4114
4115
4116
4117
4118
4119
4120
4121
4122
4123
4124
4125
4126
4127
4128
4129
4130
4131
4132
4133
4134
4135
4136
4137
4138
4139
4140
4141
4142
4143
4144
4145
4146
4147
4148
4149
4150
4151
4152
4153
4154
4155
4156
4157
4158
4159
4160
4161
4162
4163
4164
4165
4166
4167
4168
4169
4170
4171
4172
4173
4174
4175
4176
4177
4178
4179
4180
4181
4182
4183
4184
4185
4186
4187
4188
4189
4190
4191
4192
4193
4194
4195
4196
4197
4198
4199
4200
4201
4202
4203
4204
4205
4206
4207
4208
4209
4210
4211
4212
4213
4214
4215
4216
4217
4218
4219
4220
4221
4222
4223
4224
4225
4226
4227
4228
4229
4230
4231
4232
4233
4234
4235
4236
4237
4238
4239
4240
4241
4242
4243
4244
4245
4246
4247
4248
4249
4250
4251
4252
4253
4254
4255
4256
4257
4258
4259
4260
4261
4262
4263
4264
4265
4266
4267
4268
4269
4270
4271
4272
4273
4274
4275
4276
4277
4278
4279
4280
4281
4282
4283
4284
4285
4286
4287
4288
4289
4290
4291
4292
4293
4294
4295
4296
4297
4298
4299
4300
4301
4302
4303
4304
4305
4306
4307
4308
4309
4310
4311
4312
4313
4314
4315
4316
4317
4318
4319
4320
4321
4322
4323
4324
4325
4326
4327
4328
4329
4330
4331
4332
4333
4334
4335
4336
4337
4338
4339
4340
4341
4342
4343
4344
4345
4346
4347
4348
4349
4350
4351
4352
4353
4354
4355
4356
4357
4358
4359
4360
4361
4362
4363
4364
4365
4366
4367
4368
4369
4370
4371
4372
4373
4374
4375
4376
4377
4378
4379
4380
4381
4382
4383
4384
4385
4386
4387
4388
4389
4390
4391
4392
4393
4394
4395
4396
4397
4398
4399
4400
4401
4402
4403
4404
4405
4406
4407
4408
4409
4410
4411
4412
4413
4414
4415
4416
4417
4418
4419
4420
4421
4422
4423
4424
4425
4426
4427
4428
4429
4430
4431
4432
4433
4434
4435
4436
4437
4438
4439
4440
4441
4442
4443
4444
4445
4446
4447
4448
4449
4450
4451
4452
4453
4454
4455
4456
4457
4458
4459
4460
4461
4462
4463
4464
4465
4466
4467
4468
4469
4470
4471
4472
4473
4474
4475
4476
4477
4478
4479
4480
4481
4482
4483
4484
4485
4486
4487
4488
4489
4490
4491
4492
4493
4494
4495
4496
4497
4498
4499
4500
4501
4502
4503
4504
4505
4506
4507
4508
4509
4510
4511
4512
4513
4514
4515
4516
4517
4518
4519
4520
4521
4522
4523
4524
4525
4526
4527
4528
4529
4530
4531
4532
4533
4534
4535
4536
4537
4538
4539
4540
4541
4542
4543
4544
4545
4546
4547
4548
4549
4550
4551
4552
4553
4554
4555
4556
4557
4558
4559
4560
4561
4562
4563
4564
4565
4566
4567
4568
4569
4570
4571
4572
4573
4574
4575
4576
4577
4578
4579
4580
4581
4582
4583
4584
4585
4586
4587
4588
4589
4590
4591
4592
4593
4594
4595
4596
4597
4598
4599
4600
4601
4602
4603
4604
4605
4606
4607
4608
4609
4610
4611
4612
4613
4614
4615
4616
4617
4618
4619
4620
4621
4622
4623
4624
4625
4626
4627
4628
4629
4630
4631
4632
4633
4634
4635
4636
4637
4638
4639
4640
4641
4642
4643
4644
4645
4646
4647
4648
4649
4650
4651
4652
4653
4654
4655
4656
4657
4658
4659
4660
4661
4662
4663
4664
4665
4666
4667
4668
4669
4670
4671
4672
4673
4674
4675
4676
4677
4678
4679
4680
4681
4682
4683
4684
4685
4686
4687
4688
4689
4690
4691
4692
4693
4694
4695
4696
4697
4698
4699
4700
4701
4702
4703
4704
4705
4706
4707
4708
4709
4710
4711
4712
4713
4714
4715
4716
4717
4718
4719
4720
4721
4722
4723
4724
4725
4726
4727
4728
4729
4730
4731
4732
4733
4734
4735
4736
4737
4738
4739
4740
4741
4742
4743
4744
4745
4746
4747
4748
4749
4750
4751
4752
4753
4754
4755
4756
4757
4758
4759
4760
4761
4762
4763
4764
4765
4766
4767
4768
4769
4770
4771
4772
4773
4774
4775
4776
4777
4778
4779
4780
4781
4782
4783
4784
4785
4786
4787
4788
4789
4790
4791
4792
4793
4794
4795
4796
4797
4798
4799
4800
4801
4802
4803
4804
4805
4806
4807
4808
4809
4810
4811
4812
4813
4814
4815
4816
4817
4818
4819
4820
4821
4822
4823
4824
4825
4826
4827
4828
4829
4830
4831
4832
4833
4834
4835
4836
4837
4838
4839
4840
4841
4842
4843
4844
4845
4846
4847
4848
4849
4850
4851
4852
4853
4854
4855
4856
4857
4858
4859
4860
4861
4862
4863
4864
4865
4866
4867
4868
4869
4870
4871
4872
4873
4874
4875
4876
4877
4878
4879
4880
4881
4882
4883
4884
4885
4886
4887
4888
4889
4890
4891
4892
4893
4894
4895
4896
4897
4898
4899
4900
4901
4902
4903
4904
4905
4906
4907
4908
4909
4910
4911
4912
4913
4914
4915
4916
4917
4918
4919
4920
4921
4922
4923
4924
4925
4926
4927
4928
4929
4930
4931
4932
4933
4934
4935
4936
4937
4938
4939
4940
4941
4942
4943
4944
4945
4946
4947
4948
4949
4950
4951
4952
4953
4954
4955
4956
4957
4958
4959
4960
4961
4962
4963
4964
4965
4966
4967
4968
4969
4970
4971
4972
4973
4974
4975
4976
4977
4978
4979
4980
4981
4982
4983
4984
4985
4986
4987
4988
4989
4990
4991
4992
4993
4994
4995
4996
4997
4998
4999
5000
5001
5002
5003
5004
5005
5006
5007
5008
5009
5010
5011
5012
5013
5014
5015
5016
5017
5018
5019
5020
5021
5022
5023
5024
5025
5026
5027
5028
5029
5030
5031
5032
5033
5034
5035
5036
5037
5038
5039
5040
5041
5042
5043
5044
5045
5046
5047
5048
5049
5050
5051
5052
5053
5054
5055
5056
5057
5058
5059
5060
5061
5062
5063
5064
5065
5066
5067
5068
5069
5070
5071
5072
5073
5074
5075
5076
5077
5078
5079
5080
5081
5082
5083
5084
5085
5086
5087
5088
5089
5090
5091
5092
5093
5094
5095
5096
5097
5098
5099
5100
5101
5102
5103
5104
5105
5106
5107
5108
5109
5110
5111
5112
5113
5114
5115
5116
5117
5118
5119
5120
5121
5122
5123
5124
5125
5126
5127
5128
5129
5130
5131
5132
5133
5134
5135
5136
5137
5138
5139
5140
5141
5142
5143
5144
5145
5146
5147
5148
5149
5150
5151
5152
5153
5154
5155
5156
5157
5158
5159
5160
5161
13 .uno%3AClosePreview 3a To exit the print preview, click the Close Preview button.
13 .uno%3APrintPreview 3d Displays a preview of the printed page or closes the preview.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Ffileformat 37 Select the file format to store the resulting document.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Fselected 99 Processes only the marked records from the database. This option is only available when you have previously marked the necessary records in the database.
27 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Fto 34 Specify the number of the last record to be printed.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Fpathpb 23 Opens the Select Path dialogue box.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Frbfrom 35 Specify the number of the first record to be printed.
1c DBACCESS_HID_TLB_TREELISTBOX 1c Select a database and table.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2FMailmergeDialog 4a The Mail Merge dialogue box helps you in printing and saving form letters.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Fprinter 18 Prints the form letters.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Ffrom 35 Specify the number of the first record to be printed.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Ffile 20 Saves the form letters in files.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Findividualdocuments 2e Create one document for every one data record.
28 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Fall 2c Processes all the records from the database.
12 .uno%3AMergeDialog 4a The Mail Merge dialogue box helps you in printing and saving form letters.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Fgenerate 3a Generate each file name from data contained in a database.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Ffield 55 Uses the content of the selected database field as the file name for the form letter.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Fsingledocument 34 Create one big document containing all data records.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailmerge%2Fpath 2d Specifies the path to store the form letters.
1e .uno%3ASendOutlineToStarImpres 48 Sends the outline of the active document to a new presentation document.
1d .uno%3ASendOutlineToClipboard 4b Sends the outline of a document to the clipboard in Rich Text Format (RTF).
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fabstractdialog%2Fparas 74 Specify the maximum number of consecutive paragraphs to be included in the AutoAbstract document after each heading.
15 .uno%3ACreateAbstract bc Copies the headings and a number of subsequent paragraphs in the active document to a new AutoAbstract text document. An AutoAbstract is useful for obtaining an overview of long documents.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fabstractdialog%2Foutlines 48 Enter the extent of the outline levels to be copied to the new document.
1e .uno%3ASendAbstractToStarImpre 96 Opens the current document as a $[officename] Impress presentation. The current document must contain at least one predefined heading paragraph style.
23 HID_SEND_HTML_CTRL_LISTBOX_TEMPLATE 54 Select the heading paragraph style that you want to use to indicate a new HTML page.
11 .uno%3ANewHtmlDoc bc Saves the file as an HTML document, so that you can view it in a web browser. You can choose to create a separate page when a heading style that you specify is encountered in the document.
15 HID_NAVIGATOR_LISTBOX 101 Lists the names of all open text documents. To view the content of a document in the Navigator window, select the name of the document in the list. The current document displayed in the Navigator is indicated by the word "active" after its name in the list.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fchapterup f3 Moves the selected heading, and the text below the heading, up one heading position in the Navigator and in the document. To move only the selected heading and not the text associated with the heading, hold down Ctrl, and then click this icon.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fpromote d1 Increases the outline level of the selected heading, and the headings that occur below the heading, by one. To only increase the outline level of the selected heading, hold down Ctrl, and then click this icon.
11 HID_NAVI_OUTLINES 7a Click 1 to only view the top level headings (chapter heading) in the Navigator window, and 10 to view all of the headings.
12 HID_NAVI_DRAG_COPY a6 Inserts a copy of the selected item where you drag-and-drop in the current document. You cannot drag-and-drop copies of graphics, OLE objects, references and indexes.
11 HID_NAVI_DRAG_HYP a3 Creates a hyperlink when you drag-and-drop an item into the current document. Click the hyperlink in the document to jump to the item that the hyperlink points to.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fnavigation c5 Opens the Navigation toolbar, with which you can quickly jump to the next or the previous item in the category that you select. Select the category, and then click the "Previous" and "Next" arrows.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fcontenttoggle 4a Switches between master view and normal view if a master document is open.
10 .uno%3ANavigator 121 Shows or hides the Navigator window, where you can quickly jump to different parts of your document. Navigator is also available as a deck of the Sidebar. You can also use the Navigator to insert elements from the current document or other open documents, and to organise master documents.
19 SW_HID_NAVIGATOR_TREELIST 121 Shows or hides the Navigator window, where you can quickly jump to different parts of your document. Navigator is also available as a deck of the Sidebar. You can also use the Navigator to insert elements from the current document or other open documents, and to organise master documents.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fforward a3 Jumps to the next item in the document. To specify the type of item to jump to, click the Navigation icon, and then click an item category - for example, "Images".
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Flistbox 22 Shows or hides the Navigator list.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fheadings 74 Click this icon, and then choose the number of heading outline levels that you want to view in the Navigator window.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fnumericfield 51 Type the number of the page number that you want to jump to and then press Enter.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Froot 5a Switches between the display of all categories in the Navigator and the selected category.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fchapterdown f5 Moves the selected heading, and the text below the heading, down one heading position in the Navigator and in the document. To move only the selected heading and not the text associated with the heading, hold down Ctrl, and then click this icon.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fback a7 Jumps to the previous item in the document. To specify the type of item to jump to, click the Navigation icon, and then click an item category - for example, "Images".
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fglobaltoggle 4a Switches between master view and normal view if a master document is open.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fdragmode b5 Sets the drag and drop options for inserting items from the Navigator into a document, for example, as a hyperlink. Click this icon, and then choose the option that you want to use.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Freminder f1 Click here to set a reminder at the current cursor position. You can define up to five reminders. To jump to a reminder, click the Navigation icon, in the Navigation window click the Reminder icon, and then click the Previous or Next button.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fanchor 38 Jumps between the footnote text and the footnote anchor.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fdemote d1 Decreases the outline level of the selected heading, and the headings that occur below the heading, by one. To only decrease the outline level of the selected heading, hold down Ctrl, and then click this icon.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fheader 4d Moves the cursor to the header, or from the header to the document text area.
12 HID_NAVI_DRAG_LINK 161 Inserts the selected item as a link where you drag-and-drop in the current document. Text is inserted as protected sections. The contents of the link are automatically updated when the source is changed. To manually update the links in a document, choose Tools - Update - Links. You cannot create links for graphics, OLE objects, references and indexes.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Ffooter 4d Moves the cursor to the footer, or from the footer to the document text area.
e SW_HID_NID_TBL 2a Select this icon to browse through tables.
1e SW_HID_NID_TABLE_FORMULA_ERROR 3c Select this icon to browse through incorrect table formulae.
18 SW_HID_NID_TABLE_FORMULA 32 Select this icon to browse through table formulae.
13 SW_HID_NID_SRCH_REP 32 Select this icon to browse through search results.
f SW_HID_NID_PREV 3c Sets the cursor to the previous object of the selected type.
11 SW_HID_NID_POSTIT 2c Select this icon to browse through comments.
f SW_HID_NID_CTRL 32 Select this icon to browse through control fields.
e SW_HID_NID_BKM 2d Select this icon to browse through bookmarks.
e SW_HID_NID_FRM 2f Select this icon to browse through text frames.
e SW_HID_NID_SEL 2e Select this icon to browse through selections.
e SW_HID_NID_REG 2c Select this icon to browse through sections.
b HID_NAVI_VS 115 Click the icon for the type of objects you want to browse through. Then click either the "Previous Object" or "Next Object" arrow buttons. The names of these buttons indicate the type of object you have selected. The text cursor is placed on whichever object you have selected.
d HID_SCRL_NAVI b5 If you click this icon in the Navigator or in the lower right of the document window, a toolbar will appear which enables you to choose among the existing targets within a document.
11 HID_SCRL_PAGEDOWN 3b Click the down button to scroll to the next page or object.
e SW_HID_NID_DRW 33 Select this icon to browse through drawing objects.
e SW_HID_NID_GRF 2c Select this icon to browse through graphics.
f HID_SCRL_PAGEUP 3d Click the up button to scroll to the previous page or object.
16 SW_HID_NID_INDEX_ENTRY 31 Select this icon to browse through index entries.
e SW_HID_NID_FTN 2d Select this icon to browse through footnotes.
f SW_HID_NID_MARK 2d Select this icon to browse through reminders.
f SW_HID_NID_NEXT 38 Sets the cursor to the next object of the selected type.
e SW_HID_NID_OLE 2f Select this icon to browse through OLE objects.
f SW_HID_NID_OUTL 2c Select this icon to browse through headings.
e SW_HID_NID_PGE 29 Select this icon to browse through pages.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Frelfile 3c Links to AutoText directories on your computer are relative.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Frelnet 2c Links to files on the Internet are relative.
28 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fpath 5b Opens the Edit Paths dialogue box, in which you can select the directory to store AutoText.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditcategories%2Fpathlb be Displays the current path to the directory where the selected AutoText category files are stored. If you are creating an AutoText category, select where you want to store the category files.
27 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fnew cf Creates a new AutoText entry from the selection that you made in the current document. The entry is added to the currently selected AutoText category. You must first enter a name before you see this command.
13 .uno%3AEditGlossary d9 Creates, edits, or inserts AutoText. You can store formatted text, text with graphics, tables and fields as AutoText. To quickly insert AutoText, type the shortcut for the AutoText in your document, and then press F3.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditcategories%2FEditCategoriesDialog 2e Adds, renames, or deletes AutoText categories.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditcategories%2Frename 5e Changes the name of the selected AutoText category to the name that you enter in the Name box.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fshortname 96 Displays the shortcut for the selected AutoText entry. If you are creating a new AutoText entry, type the shortcut that you want to use for the entry.
28 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fname bc Lists the name of the currently selected AutoText entry. If you have selected text in the document, type the name of the new AutoText entry, click the AutoText button, and then choose New.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fimport 91 Opens a dialogue box in which you can select the MS 97/2000/XP Word document or template containing the AutoText entries that you want to import.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditcategories%2Fname bb Displays the name of the selected AutoText category. To change the name of the category, type a new name, and then click Rename. To create a new category, type a name, and then click New.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Finsert 123 Displays a suggestion for completing a word as a Help Tip after you type the first three letters of a word that matches an AutoText entry. To accept the suggestion, press Enter. If more than one AutoText entry matches the letters that you type, press Ctrl+Tab to advance through the entries.
28 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fcopy 2e Copies the selected AutoText to the clipboard.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditcategories%2Fgroup 43 Lists the existing AutoText categories and the corresponding paths.
28 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fedit a0 Opens the selected AutoText entry for editing in a separate document. Make the changes that you want, choose File - Save AutoText, and then choose File - Close.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditcategories%2Fnew 50 Creates a new AutoText category using the name that you entered in the Name box.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fautotext 89 Click to display additional AutoText commands, for example, to create a new AutoText entry from a text selection in the current document.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Freplace 6d Replaces the content of the selected AutoText entry with the selection that was made in the current document.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Frename 68 Opens the Rename AutoText dialogue box, in which you can change the name of the selected AutoText entry.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fnewtext d5 Creates a new AutoText entry only from the text in the selection that you made in the current document. Graphics, tables and other objects are not included. You must first enter a name before you see this command.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fmacro 62 Opens the Assign Macro dialogue box, with which you attach a macro to the selected AutoText entry.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautotext%2Fcategories 2e Adds, renames, or deletes AutoText categories.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Frenameautotextdialog%2Fnewsc 32 Assigns a shortcut to the selected AutoText entry.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Frenameautotextdialog%2Foldname 38 Displays the current name of the selected AutoText item.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Frenameautotextdialog%2Fnewname 36 Type the new name for the selected AutoText component.
1d .uno%3AAuthoritiesEntryDialog 26 Edits the selected bibliography entry.
13 HID_DLG_FLDEDT_PREV 3d Jumps to the previous field of the same type in the document.
12 .uno%3AFieldDialog 7e Opens a dialogue box in which you can edit the properties of a field. Click in front of a field, and then choose this command.
13 HID_DLG_FLDEDT_NEXT 39 Jumps to the next field of the same type in the document.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocumentpage%2Fnumformat b0 Select the format for the content of the field. For date, time and user-defined fields, you can also click "Additional formats" in the list, and then choose a different format.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertfootnote%2Fnext 3d Moves to the next footnote or endnote anchor in the document.
13 .uno%3AEditFootnote 77 Edits the selected footnote or endnote anchor. Click in front of the footnote or endnote, and then choose this command.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertfootnote%2Fprev 41 Moves to the previous footnote or endnote anchor in the document.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fnext 3f Jumps to the next index entry of the same type in the document.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Ffirst 40 Jumps to the first index entry of the same type in the document.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Ftypecb 3e Displays the type of index that the selected entry belongs to.
17 .uno%3AIndexEntryDialog 66 Edits the selected index entry. Click in front of or in the index entry, and then choose this command.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fprevious 43 Jumps to the previous index entry of the same type in the document.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fentryed 9e Edit the index entry if necessary. When you modify the index entry, the new text only appears in the index, and not at the index entry anchor in the document.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Flevelnf 37 Changes the outline level of a table of contents entry.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fdelete 59 Deletes the selected entry from the index. The entry text in the document is not deleted.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fkey1cb 9d To create a multilevel index, type the name of the first level index entry, or select a name from the list. The current index entry is added below this name.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Flast 3f Jumps to the last index entry of the same type in the document.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fkey2cb 80 Type the name of the second level index entry, or select a name from the list. The current index entry is added below this name.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Fremove 6a Removes the selected section from the document, and inserts the contents of the section into the document.
11 .uno%3AEditRegion 3c Changes the properties of sections defined in your document.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Ftree 8c Opens the Options dialogue box, in which you can edit the column layout, background, footnote and endnote behaviour of the selected section.
c .uno%3ARuler 4d Contains a sub-menu for showing or hiding the horizontal and vertical rulers.
11 .uno%3AViewBounds 62 Shows or hides the boundaries of the printable area of a page. The boundary lines are not printed.
c .uno%3AMarks 76 Shows or hides shadings around fields in your document like non-breaking spaces, soft hyphens, indexes, and footnotes.
11 .uno%3AFieldnames 3f Switches between showing fields as field names or field values.
13 .uno%3AControlCodes 6a Shows hidden formatting symbols in your text, such as paragraph marks, line breaks, tab stops, and spaces.
11 .uno%3ABrowseView 3d Displays the document as it would be viewed in a Web browser.
12 .uno%3APrintLayout 36 Displays how the document will look when you print it.
1b .uno%3AShowHiddenParagraphs 21 Shows or hides hidden paragraphs.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertbreak%2Fpagenumsb 4a Enter the new page number for the page that follows the manual page break.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertbreak%2Flinerb 7e Ends the current line, and moves the text found to the right of the cursor to the next line, without creating a new paragraph.
12 .uno%3AInsertBreak 59 Inserts a manual line break, column break or a page break at the current cursor position.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertbreak%2Fpagerb cd Inserts a manual page break, and moves the text found to the right of the cursor to the beginning of the next page. The inserted page break is indicated by a non-printing border at the top of the new page.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertbreak%2Fcolumnrb ef Inserts a manual column break (in a multiple column layout), and moves the text found to the right of the cursor to the beginning of the next column. A manual column break is indicated by a non-printing border at the top of the new column.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertbreak%2Fstylelb 46 Select the page style for the page that follows the manual page break.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertbreak%2Fpagenumcb c7 Assigns the page number that you specify to the page that follows the manual page break. This option is only available if you assign a different page style to the page that follows manual page break.
14 .uno%3AInsertSection 137 Inserts a text section at the cursor position in the document. You can also select a block of text and then choose this command to create a section. You can use sections to insert blocks of text from other documents, to apply custom column layouts, or to protect or to hide blocks of text if a condition is met.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Fcondition 39 Enter the condition that must be met to hide the section.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2Fwithcond 39 Enter the condition that must be met to hide the section.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2Fselectpassword 3f Opens a dialogue box where you can change the current password.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Fpassword 3f Opens a dialogue box where you can change the current password.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2Flink 61 Inserts the contents of another document or section from another document in the current section.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Fprotect 30 Prevents the selected section from being edited.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Flink 61 Inserts the contents of another document or section from another document in the current section.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Fcurname 20 Type a name for the new section.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2Fsectionname 41 Select the section in the file that you want to insert as a link.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2FSectionPage 23 Sets the properties of the section.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Fhide 3b Hides and prevents the selected section from being printed.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2Fdde a3 Creates a DDE link. Select this check box, and then enter the DDE command that you want to use. The DDE option is only available if the Link check box is selected.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Ffile 49 Locate the file that you want to insert as a link, and then click Insert.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Fdde a3 Creates a DDE link. Select this check box, and then enter the DDE command that you want to use. The DDE option is only available if the Link check box is selected.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2Ffilename 74 Enter the path and the filename for the file that you want to insert, or click the Browse button to locate the file.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2Fwithpassword 60 Protects the selected section with a password. The password must have a minimum of 5 characters.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Fsection 41 Select the section in the file that you want to insert as a link.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2FEditSectionDialog 23 Sets the properties of the section.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Ffilename 74 Enter the path and the filename for the file that you want to insert, or click the Browse button to locate the file.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2Fselectfile 49 Locate the file that you want to insert as a link, and then click Insert.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2Fhide 3b Hides and prevents the selected section from being printed.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsectionpage%2Fprotect 30 Prevents the selected section from being edited.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Feditsectiondialog%2Fwithpassword 60 Protects the selected section with a password. The password must have a minimum of 5 characters.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findentpage%2Fafter 3d Specifies the indents after the section, at the right margin.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findentpage%2Fbefore 3d Specifies the indents before the section, at the left margin.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertfootnote%2Fendnote 79 Inserts an endnote anchor at the current cursor position in the document, and adds an endnote at the end of the document.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertfootnote%2Ffootnote 78 Inserts a footnote anchor at the current cursor position in the document, and adds a footnote to the bottom of the page.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertfootnote%2Fchoosecharacter 3d Inserts a special character  as a footnote or endnote anchor.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertfootnote%2Fcharacterentry 4c Choose this option to define a character or symbol for the current footnote.
15 .uno%3AInsertFootnote 75 Inserts a footnote or an endnote in the document. The anchor for the note is inserted at the current cursor position.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertfootnote%2Fautomatic 57 Automatically assigns consecutive numbers to the footnotes or endnotes that you insert.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertbookmark%2Fdelete 96 To delete a bookmark, select the bookmark from the Insert Bookmark dialogue box and click the Delete button. No confirmation dialogue box will follow.
15 .uno%3AInsertBookmark 81 Inserts a bookmark at the cursor position. You can then use the Navigator to quickly jump to the marked location at a later time.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertbookmark%2Fbookmarks c0 Type the name of the bookmark that you want to create. The lower list contains all of the bookmarks in the current document. To delete a bookmark, select it in the list, and then click Delete.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertcaption%2Fauto 9e Opens the Caption dialogue box. It has the same information as the dialogue box you get by menu %PRODUCTNAME Writer - AutoCaption in the Options dialogue box.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertcaption%2Fposition 62 Adds the caption above or below the selected item. This option is only available for some objects.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertcaption%2FInsertCaptionDialog 4b Adds a numbered caption to a selected image, table, chart, frame, or shape.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertcaption%2Fseparator_edit 51 Enter optional text characters to appear between the number and the caption text.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertcaption%2Fcategory e6 Select the caption category, or type a name to create a new category. The category text appears before the caption number in the caption label. Each predefined caption category is formatted with a paragraph style of the same name.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertcaption%2Fnumbering 41 Select the type of numbering that you want to use in the caption.
1a .uno%3AInsertCaptionDialog 4b Adds a numbered caption to a selected image, table, chart, frame, or shape.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertcaption%2Fnum_separator_edit 3f Type the text that you want to appear after the caption number.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcaptionoptions%2Fborder_and_shadow 41 Applies the border and shadow of the object to the caption frame.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcaptionoptions%2Fseparator 5e Enter the character that you want to insert between the chapter number and the caption number.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcaptionoptions%2Fstyle 1e Specifies the character style.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertcaption%2Foptions c2 Adds the chapter number to the caption label. To use this feature, you must first assign an outline level to a paragraph style, and then apply the style to the chapter headings in your document.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcaptionoptions%2Flevel 6f Select the number of outline levels from the top of the chapter hierarchy down to include in the caption label.
12 HID_ENVELOP_INSERT 3d Inserts the envelope before the current page in the document.
15 .uno%3AInsertEnvelope 14 Creates an envelope.
11 HID_ENVELOP_PRINT 30 Creates a new document and inserts the envelope.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvaddresspage%2Finsert b0 Select the database field containing the address data that you want to insert, and then click the left arrow button. The data is added to the address box containing the cursor.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvaddresspage%2Ftable 4e Select the database table containing the address data that you want to insert.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvaddresspage%2Fdatabase 48 Select the database containing the address data that you want to insert.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvaddresspage%2FEnvAddressPage 96 Enter the delivery and return addresses for the envelope. You can also insert address fields from a database, for example from the Addresses database.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvaddresspage%2Fsenderedit 6b Includes a return address on the envelope. Select the Sender check box, and then enter the return  address.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvaddresspage%2Faddredit 1b Enter the delivery address.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvformatpage%2Fwidth 20 Enter the width of the envelope.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvformatpage%2Fsenderedit 56 Click and choose the text formatting style for the sender field that you want to edit.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvformatpage%2Fleftaddr 6f Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the left edge of the envelope and the addressee field.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvformatpage%2Fleftsender 6c Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the left edge of the envelope and the sender field.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvformatpage%2Ftopsender 6b Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the top edge of the envelope and the sender field.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvformatpage%2FEnvFormatPage 37 Specifies the layout and the dimension of the envelope.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvformatpage%2Ftopaddr 6e Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the top edge of the envelope and the addressee field.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvformatpage%2Fheight 21 Enter the height of the envelope.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvformatpage%2Fformat 7d Select the envelope size that you want, or select "User-defined", and then enter the width and the height of the custom size.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvformatpage%2Faddredit 59 Click and choose the text formatting style for the addressee field that you want to edit.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Fdown 2e Enter the amount to shift the print area down.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Fright 36 Enter the amount to shift the print area to the right.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Fbottom 45 Feeds the envelope with the print side face down in the printer tray.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Ftop 43 Feeds the envelope with the print side face up in the printer tray.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Fsetup 7d Opens the Print Setup dialogue box in which you can define additional printer settings, such as paper format and orientation.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Fvertright 46 Feeds the envelope vertically from the right edge of the printer tray.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Fhorileft 47 Feeds the envelope horizontally from the left edge of the printer tray.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Fvertcenter 42 Feeds the envelope vertically from the centre of the printer tray.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2FEnvPrinterPage 27 Set the print options for the envelope.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Fhoricenter 44 Feeds the envelope horizontally from the centre of the printer tray.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Fhoriright 48 Feeds the envelope horizontally from the right edge of the printer tray.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fenvprinterpage%2Fvertleft 45 Feeds the envelope vertically from the left edge of the printer tray.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffielddialog%2Fcancel 18 Closes the dialogue box.
12 .uno%3AInsertField 2f Inserts a field at the current cursor position.
10 HID_FIELD_INSERT 7d Inserts the selected field at the current cursor position in the document. To close the dialogue box, click the Close button.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocumentpage%2Foffset 40 Enter the contents that you want to add to a user-defined field.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocumentpage%2Flevel 50 Select the chapter heading level that you want to include in the selected field.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocumentpage%2Fselect 83 Lists the available fields for the field type selected in the Type list. To insert a field, click the field, and then click Insert.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocumentpage%2Ftype 8e Lists the available field types. To add a field to your document, click a field type, click a field in the Select list, and then click Insert.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocumentpage%2Fvalue 57 Enter the offset value that you want to apply to a page number field, for example "+1".
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocumentpage%2Fformat 77 Click the format that you want to apply to the selected field, or click "Additional formats" to define a custom format.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocumentpage%2Ffixed 4a Inserts the field as static content, that is, the field cannot be updated.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldrefpage%2Fvalue f Edit the value.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldrefpage%2FFldRefPage bf This is where you insert the references or referenced fields into the current document. References are referenced fields within the same document or within sub-documents of a master document.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldrefpage%2Fformat 48 Select the format that you want to use for the selected reference field.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldrefpage%2Fname 40 Type the name of the user-defined field that you want to create.
1b .uno%3AInsertReferenceField bf This is where you insert the references or referenced fields into the current document. References are referenced fields within the same document or within sub-documents of a master document.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldrefpage%2Ftype 91 Lists the available field types. To add a field to your document, click a field type, click a field in the Selection list, and then click Insert.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocumentpage%2Fselect b6 Lists the available fields for the field type selected in the Type list. To insert a field, click the field, select a format in the "Insert reference to" list, and then click Insert.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropdownfielddialog%2Fedit 54 Displays the Edit Fields: Functions dialogue box, where you can edit the Input list.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Flistname 27 Enter a unique name for the Input list.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Fdown 29 Moves the selected item down in the list.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Fremove 28 Removes the selected item from the list.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Flistitems 3b Lists the items. The topmost item is shown in the document.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Fadd 1a Adds the Item to the list.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Fitem 11 Enter a new item.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Ftype 8e Lists the available field types. To add a field to your document, click a field type, click a field in the Select list, and then click Insert.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropdownfielddialog%2Flist 48 Choose the item that you want to display in the document, then click OK.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Fup 27 Moves the selected item up in the list.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Fcond2 8b Enter the text to display when the condition is met in the Then box, and the text to display when the condition is not met in the Else box.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Fmacro 7c Opens the Macro Selector, in which you can choose the macro that will run when you click the selected field in the document.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Fvalue 70 Sets additional function parameters for fields. The type of parameter depends on the field type that you select.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldfuncpage%2Fformat 77 Click the format that you want to apply to the selected field, or click "Additional formats" to define a custom format.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropdownfielddialog%2Fnext 42 Closes the current Input list and displays the next, if available.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddbpage%2Fcondition 3a For fields linked to a condition, enter the criteria here.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocinfopage%2Ffixed 4a Inserts the field as static content, that is, the field cannot be updated.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocinfopage%2Fformat 77 Click the format that you want to apply to the selected field, or click "Additional formats" to define a custom format.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocinfopage%2Fselect 83 Lists the available fields for the field type selected in the Type list. To insert a field, click the field, and then click Insert.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocinfopage%2FFldDocInfoPage 8e Lists the available field types. To add a field to your document, click a field type, click a field in the Select list, and then click Insert.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocinfopage%2Ftype 8e Lists the available field types. To add a field to your document, click a field type, click a field in the Select list, and then click Insert.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2Fdelete 7d Removes the user-defined field from the selection list. You can only remove fields that are not used in the current document.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2Fapply 32 Adds the user-defined field to the Selection list.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2Fseparator 5d Type the character that you want to use as a separator between the heading or chapter levels.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2Flevel 52 Choose the heading or chapter level at which to restart numbering in the document.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2Finvisible 29 Hides the field contents in the document.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddocumentpage%2Fselect 83 Lists the available fields for the field type selected in the Type list. To insert a field, click the field, and then click Insert.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2Ftype 8e Lists the available field types. To add a field to your document, click a field type, click a field in the Select list, and then click Insert.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2Fnumformat 77 Click the format that you want to apply to the selected field, or click "Additional formats" to define a custom format.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2Fname 40 Type the name of the user-defined field that you want to create.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2Fvalue 40 Enter the contents that you want to add to a user-defined field.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2FFldVarPage 8e Lists the available field types. To add a field to your document, click a field type, click a field in the Select list, and then click Insert.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffldvarpage%2Fformat 48 In the Format list, define if the value is inserted as text or a number.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintmergedialog%2FPrintMergeDialog e0 When you print a document that contains database fields, a dialogue box asks you if you want to print a form letter. If you answer Yes, the Mail Merge dialogue box opens in which you can select the database records to print.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddbpage%2Fformat 29 Lists the available user-defined formats.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddbpage%2Ftype 8e Lists the available field types. To add a field to your document, click a field type, click a field in the Select list, and then click Insert.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddbpage%2Fuserdefinedcb 47 Applies the format that you select in the List of user-defined formats.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddbpage%2Fbrowse 8b Opens a file open dialogue box in which you can select a database file (*.odb). The selected file is added to the Databases Selection list.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddbpage%2Fselect 54 Select the database table or the database query that you want the field to refer to.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddbpage%2Fcondition 3a For fields linked to a condition, enter the criteria here.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddbpage%2Frecnumber 62 Enter the number of the record that you want to insert when the condition that you specify is met.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddbpage%2FFldDbPage 8e Lists the available field types. To add a field to your document, click a field type, click a field in the Select list, and then click Insert.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fflddbpage%2Ffromdatabasecb 31 Uses the format defined in the selected database.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputfielddialog%2FInputFieldDialog 4f Inserts a text field that you can open and edit by clicking it in the document.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputfielddialog%2Fnext 2e Jumps to the next input field in the document.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputfielddialog%2Ftext bb This box displays the name that you entered in the Reference box of the Input Field on the Functions tab of the Fields dialogue box. The box underneath displays the contents of the field.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnewuserindexdialog%2FNewUserIndexDialog 70 Enter a name for the new user-defined index. The new index is added to the list of available indexes and tables.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Finsert 22 Marks an index entry in your text.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fsearchcasewordonlycb 48 Searches for whole words or cells that are identical to the search text.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fsearchcasesensitivecb 3b Distinguishes between upper-case and lower-case characters.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fapplytoallcb 8e Automatically marks all other occurrences of the selected text in the document. Text in headers, footers, frames and captions is not included.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Flevelnf c9 Entries using the paragraph format "Heading X" (X = 1-10) can be automatically added to the table of contents. The level of the entry in the index corresponds to the outline level of the heading style.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fmainentrycb 40 Makes the selected text the main entry in an alphabetical index.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fnew 59 Opens the Create New User-defined Index dialogue box where you can create a custom index.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Ftypecb 33 Select the index that you want to add the entry to.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fphonetic0ed f9 Enter the phonetic reading for the corresponding entry. For example, if a Japanese Kanji word has more than one pronunciation, enter the correct pronunciation as a Katakana word. The Kanji word is then sorted according to the phonetic reading entry.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fclose 18 Closes the dialogue box.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fentryed a6 Displays the text that is selected in the document. If you want, you can enter a different word for the index entry. The selected text in the document is not changed.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fkey1cb b2 Makes the current selection a subentry of the word that you enter here. For example, if you select "cold", and enter "weather" as the 1st key, the index entry is "weather, cold".
19 .uno%3AInsertIndexesEntry 3c Marks the selected text as index or table of contents entry.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Findexentry%2Fkey2cb c9 Makes the current selection a sub-subentry of the 1st key. For example, if you select "cold", and enter "weather" as the 1st key and "winter" as the 2nd key, the index entry is "weather, winter, cold".
17 .uno%3AInsertMultiIndex 47 Inserts an index or a table of contents at the current cursor position.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocstylespage%2Fedit 5d Opens the Paragraph Style dialogue box, in which you can modify the selected paragraph style.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocstylespage%2Fdefault 4d Resets the formatting of the selected level to the "Default" paragraph style.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocstylespage%2Fassign 43 Formats the selected index level with the selected paragraph style.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocstylespage%2Flevels 39 Select the index level that you change the formatting of.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocstylespage%2Fstyles 74 Select the paragraph style that you want to apply to the selected index level, and then click the Assign (<) button.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Findexmarks 79 Includes the index entries that you inserted by choosing Insert - Table of Contents and Index - Index Entry in the index.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fstyles 6b Opens the Assign Styles dialogue box, in which you can select the paragraph styles to include in the index.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Faddstylescb e7 Includes the paragraph styles that you specify in the Assign Styles dialogue box as index entries. To select the paragraph styles that you want to include in the index, click the Assign Styles (...) button to the right of this box.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Ftitle 25 Enter a title for the selected index.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Ftype 31 Select the type of index that you want to insert.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fscope 4f Select whether to create the index for the document or for the current chapter.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Freadonly 36 Prevents the contents of the index from being changed.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Flevel 3b Enter the number of heading levels to include in the index.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Ffromheadings 96 Creates the index using outline levels, that is, paragraphs formatted with one of the predefined heading styles (Heading 1-10) are added to the index.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fkeytype aa Select numeric when you want to sort numbers by value, such as in 1, 2, 12. Select alphanumeric, when you want to sort the numbers by character code, such as in 1, 12, 2.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Flang 3f Select the language rules to use for sorting the index entries.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Ffromfile 64 Automatically marks index entries using a concordance file - a list of words to include in an index.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Ffile 2b Select, create, or edit a concordance file.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fuseff 11b Replaces identical index entries, which occur also on the directly following page or pages, with a single entry that lists the first page number and a "p" or "pp". For example, the entries "View 10, View 11, View 12" are combined as "View 10pp", and "View 10, View 11" as "View 10p".
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fkeyasentry 2d Inserts index keys as separate index entries.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fcombinesame c3 Replaces identical index entries with a single entry that lists the page numbers where the entry occurs in the document. For example, the entries "View 10, View 43" are combined as "View 10, 43".
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fusedash d5 Replaces identical index entries that occur on consecutive pages with a single entry and the page range in which the entry occurs. For example, the entries "View 10, View 11, View 12" are combined as "View 10-12".
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Finitcaps 3d Automatically capitalises the first letter of an index entry.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fcasesens 81 Distinguishes between upper-case and lower-case letters in identical index entries. For Asian languages special handling applies.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fobjnames 28 Creates index entries from object names.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fdisplay 46 Select the part of the caption that you want to use for index entries.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fcaptions 2b Creates index entries from object captions.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fcategory 47 Select the caption category that you want to use for the index entries.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Ffromoles 22 Includes OLE objects in the index.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Ffromframes 22 Includes text frames in the index.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fuselevel 78 Indents table, graphic, text frame, and OLE object index entries according their place in the chapter heading hierarchy.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Ffromtables 1d Includes tables in the index.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Ffromgraphics 1f Includes graphics in the index.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fobjects 47 Select the object types that you want to include in a table of objects.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fbrackets 42 Select the brackets that you want to enclose bibliography entries.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocindexpage%2Fnumberentries 2f Automatically numbers the bibliography entries.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fassignstylesdialog%2Fright 49 Moves the selected paragraph style down one level in the index hierarchy.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fassignstylesdialog%2FAssignStylesDialog 35 Creates index entries from specific paragraph styles.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fassignstylesdialog%2Fleft 47 Moves the selected paragraph style up one level in the index hierarchy.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2FTocEntriesPage 94 Specify the format of the index or table entries. The appearance of this tab changes to reflect the type of index that you selected on the Type tab.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Freltostyle c1 Positions the tab stop relative to the "indent from left" value defined in the paragraph style selected on the Styles tab. Otherwise the tab stop is positioned relative to the left text margin.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fnumberformat 7d Only visible when you click the E# button in the Structure line. Select to show the chapter number with or without separator.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Falignright 2d Aligns the tab stop to the right page margin.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Ftabstoppos 4a Enter the distance to leave between the left page margin and the tab stop.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Ffillchar 28 Select the tab leader that you want use.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fcharstyle 49 Specify the formatting style for the selected part on the Structure line.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fchapterno 6d Inserts the chapter number. To assign chapter numbering to a heading style, choose Tools - Chapter Numbering.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Ftoken 2d Displays the remainder of the Structure line.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fhyperlink 1aa Creates a hyperlink for the part of the entry that you enclose by the opening (LS) and the closing (LE) hyperlink tags. On the Structure line, click in the empty box in front of the part that you want to create a hyperlink for, and then click this button. Click in the empty box after the part that you want to hyperlink, and then click this button again. All hyperlinks must be unique. Available only for a table of contents.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fedit 48 Opens a dialogue box in which you can edit the selected character style.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fentrytext 28 Inserts the text of the chapter heading.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Ftabstop dc Inserts a tab stop. To add leader dots to the tab stop, select a character in the Fill character box. To change the position of the tab stop, enter a value in the Tab stop position box, or mark the Align right check box.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fall 46 Applies the current settings to all levels without closing the dialog.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fpageno 25 Inserts the page number of the entry.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fcommasep 41 Arranges the index entries on the same line, separated by commas.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fentryoutlinelevel 59 Enter the maximum hierarchy level down to which objects are shown in the generated index.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Falphadelim 5a Uses the initial letters of the alphabetically arranged index entries as section headings.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fmainstyle cf Specify the formatting style for the main entries in the alphabetical index. To convert an index entry into a main entry, click in front of the index field in the document and then choose Edit - Index Entry.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fchapterinfo 8e Inserts chapter information, such as the chapter heading and number. Select the information that you want to display in the Chapter entry box.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fchapterentry 4b Select the chapter information that you want to include in the index entry.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fdown3cb 44 Sorts the bibliography entries in a descending alphanumerical order.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Finsert a2 Adds the reference code for the selected bibliography entry to the Structure line. Select an entry in the list, click in an empty box, and then click this button.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fauthfield 7b To add an entry to the Structure line, click the entry, click in an empty box on the Structure line, and then click Insert.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fremove 3c Removes the selected reference code from the Structure line.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fkey3lb 95 Select the entry by which to sort the bibliography entries. This option is only available if you select the Content radio button in the Sort by area.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fup3cb 41 Sorts the bibliography entries in ascending alphanumerical order.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fsortpos 5d Sorts the bibliography entries according to the position of their references in the document.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftocentriespage%2Fsortcontents 73 Sorts the bibliography entries by the Sort keys that you specify, for example, by author or by year of publication.
16 HID_AUTH_FIELD_CUSTOM4 46 This is where you select the desired entry data for your bibliography.
44 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateauthorentry%2FCreateAuthorEntryDialog 2b Change the content of a bibliography entry.
1d HID_AUTH_FIELD_AUTHORITY_TYPE 2d Select the source for the bibliography entry.
19 HID_AUTH_FIELD_IDENTIFIER 80 Displays the short name for the bibliography entry. You can only enter a name here if you are creating a new bibliography entry.
44 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateautomarkdialog%2FCreateAutomarkDialog 43 Create or edit a list of words to include in an Alphabetical Index.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbibliographyentry%2Fnew e1 Opens the Define Bibliography Entry dialogue box, where you can create a new bibliography record. This record is only stored in the document. To add a record to the bibliography database, choose Tools - Bibliography Database.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbibliographyentry%2Ffrombibliography 33 Inserts a reference from the bibliography database.
1d .uno%3AInsertAuthoritiesEntry 21 Inserts a bibliography reference.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbibliographyentry%2Finsert b2 Inserts the bibliographic reference into the document. If you created a new record, you must also insert it as an entry, otherwise the record is lost when you close the document.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbibliographyentry%2Fclose 18 Closes the dialogue box.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbibliographyentry%2Fedit 65 Opens the Define Bibliography Entry dialogue box where you can edit the selected bibliography record.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbibliographyentry%2Ffromdocument 5a Inserts a reference from the bibliography records that are stored in the current document.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbibliographyentry%2Fentrylb 49 Select the short name of the bibliography record that you want to insert.
1a .uno%3AInsertFrameInteract 7d Draws a frame where you drag in the document. Click the arrow next to the icon to select the number of columns for the frame.
12 .uno%3AInsertFrame 5f Inserts a frame that you can use to create a layout of one or more columns of text and objects.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finserttable%2Fbordercb 21 Adds a border to the table cells.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finserttable%2Fdontsplitcb 34 Prevents the table from spanning more than one page.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finserttable%2Frepeatheaderspin 3f Select the number of rows that you want to use for the heading.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finserttable%2Fnameedit 1b Enter a name for the table.
12 .uno%3AInsertTable a8 Inserts a table into the document. You can also click the arrow, drag to select the number of rows and columns to include in the table, and then click in the last cell.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finserttable%2Fheadercb 24 Includes a heading row in the table.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finserttable%2Fcolspin 37 Enter the number of columns that you want in the table.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finserttable%2Fautoformat 56 Opens the AutoFormat dialogue box, where you can select a predefined layout for table.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finserttable%2Frowspin 34 Enter the number of rows that you want in the table.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finserttable%2Frepeatcb 65 Repeats the heading of the table at the top of subsequent page if the table spans more than one page.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fexchangedatabases%2Favailablelb 38 Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fexchangedatabases%2Fbrowse 7d Opens a file open dialogue box to select a database file (*.odb). The selected file is added to the Available Databases list.
1a .uno%3AChangeDatabaseField 31 Change the data sources for the current document.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fexchangedatabases%2Fdefine 68 Replaces the current data source with the data source that you selected in the Available Databases list.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fexchangedatabases%2Finuselb 2e Lists the databases that are currently in use.
10 .uno%3AInsertDoc 5a Inserts the contents of another document into the current document at the cursor position.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertscript%2Ftext 2e Enter the script code that you want to insert.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertscript%2Fprevious 18 Jump to Previous Script.
13 .uno%3AInsertScript 4c Inserts a script at the current cursor position in an HTML or text document.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertscript%2Fnext 14 Jump to Next Script.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertscript%2Fscripttype 31 Enter the type of script that you want to insert.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertscript%2Fbrowse 47 Locate the script file that you want to link to, and then click Insert.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertscript%2Furlentry ab Adds a link to a script file. Click the URL radio button, and then enter the link in the box. You can also click the Browse button, locate the file, and then click Insert.
17 .uno%3AInsertPageHeader 93 Adds or removes a header from the page style that you select in the sub-menu. The header is added to all of the pages that use the same page style.
17 .uno%3AInsertPageFooter 93 Adds or removes a footer from the page style that you select in the sub-menu. The footer is added to all of the pages that use the same page style.
23 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FspinWidow 96 Specifies the minimum number of lines in a paragraph in the first page after the break. Mark this check box, and then enter a number in the Lines box.
24 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FspinOrphan 88 Specifies the minimum number of lines in a paragraph before a page break. Mark this check box, and then enter a number in the Lines box.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FcheckSplitPara 51 Shifts the entire paragraph to the next page or column after a break is inserted.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FcomboPageStyle 46 Select the formatting style to use for the first page after the break.
27 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FcheckKeepPara 6a Keeps the current paragraph and the following paragraph together when a break or column break is inserted.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FcheckPageStyle 6c Mark this check box, and then select the page style that you want to use for the first page after the break.
2c cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FcomboBreakPosition 2a Select where you want to insert the break.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FcomboBreakType 2e Select the break type that you want to insert.
25 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FspinLineEnd 63 Enter the minimum number of characters to leave at the end of the line before a hyphen is inserted.
23 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FcheckAuto 43 Automatically inserts hyphens where they are needed in a paragraph.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FTextFlowPage 2b Specify hyphenation and pagination options.
27 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FspinLineBegin 66 Enter the minimum number of characters that must appear at the beginning of the line after the hyphen.
24 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FspinMaxNum 45 Enter the maximum number of consecutive lines that can be hyphenated.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FspinPageNumber 93 Enter the page number for the first page that follows the break. If you want to continue the current page numbering, leave the check box unchecked.
25 cui%2Fui%2Ftextflowpage%2FcheckInsert 49 Mark this check box, and then select the break type that you want to use.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropcapspage%2FcomboBOX_TEMPLATE 44 Select the formatting style that you want to apply to the drop caps.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropcapspage%2FentryEDT_TEXT 63 Enter the text that you want to display as drop caps instead of the first letters of the paragraph.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropcapspage%2FcheckCB_SWITCH 38 Applies the drop cap settings to the selected paragraph.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropcapspage%2FDropCapPage b1 Formats the first letter of a paragraph with a large capital letter, that can span several lines. The paragraph must span at least as many lines as you specify in the Lines box.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropcapspage%2FcheckCB_WORD 80 Displays the first letter of the first word in the paragraph as a drop cap, and the remaining letters of the word as large type.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropcapspage%2FspinFLD_DROPCAPS 37 Enter the number of characters to convert to drop caps.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropcapspage%2FspinFLD_LINES 98 Enter the number of lines that you want the drop cap to extend downward from the first line of the paragraph. Shorter paragraphs will not get drop caps.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fdropcapspage%2FspinFLD_DISTANCE 63 Enter the amount of space to leave between the drop caps and the rest of the text in the paragraph.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumparapage%2FspinNF_RESTART_PARA 37 Enter the number at which to restart the line numbering
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumparapage%2FcheckCB_RESTART_PARACOUNT 56 Restarts the line numbering at the current paragraph, or at the number that you enter.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumparapage%2FspinNF_NEW_START 3a Enter the number that you want to assign to the paragraph.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumparapage%2FcomboLB_OUTLINE_LEVEL 54 Assigns an outline level from 1 to 10 to the selected paragraphs or Paragraph Style.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumparapage%2FNumParaPage a7 Adds or removes outline level, numbering, or bullets from the paragraph. You can also select the style of numbering to use, and reset the numbering in a numbered list.
3f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumparapage%2FcheckCB_NUMBER_NEW_START 5a Select this check box, and then enter the number that you want to assign to the paragraph.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumparapage%2FcomboLB_NUMBER_STYLE 43 Select the Numbering Style that you want to apply to the paragraph.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumparapage%2Feditnumstyle 34 Edit the properties of the selected numbering style.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumparapage%2FcheckCB_COUNT_PARA 35 Includes the current paragraph in the line numbering.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumparapage%2FcheckCB_NEW_START 30 Restarts the numbering at the current paragraph.
11 .uno%3APageDialog 8e Specify the formatting styles and the layout for the current page style, including page margins, headers and footers, and the page background.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Flineposlb 81 Select the vertical alignment of the separator line. This option is only available if Height value of the line is less than 100%.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Flineheightmf 58 Enter the length of the separator line as a percentage of the height of the column area.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Flinestylelb 6e Select the formatting style for the column separator line. If you do not want a separator line, choose "None".
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Fspacing2mf 45 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the columns.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Fcolsnf 49 Enter the number of columns that you want in the page, frame, or section.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Fapplytolb 3d Select the item to which you want to apply the column layout.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2FColumnPage 5a Specifies the number of columns and the column layout for a page style, frame, or section.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Fautowidth 1f Creates columns of equal width.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Fwidth3mf 1e Enter the width of the column.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Fbalance 93 Distributes the text in multi-column sections. The text flows into all columns to the same height. The height of the section adjusts automatically.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Fnext 31 Moves the column display one column to the right.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Fback 30 Moves the column display one column to the left.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2Fspacingtocontents 66 Enter the amount of space to leave between the separator line and the first line of the footnote area.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2Flength 4e Enter the length of the separator line as a percentage of the page width area.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2Fmaxheightpage 5b Automatically adjusts the height of the footnote area depending on the number of footnotes.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2Fcolor 28 Select the colour of the separator line.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2Fmaxheightsb 2f Enter the maximum height for the footnote area.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2Fthickness 2b Select the thickness of the separator line.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2FFootnoteAreaPage 7a Specifies the layout options for footnotes, including the line that separates the footnote from the main body of document.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2Fposition 61 Select the horizontal alignment for the line that separates the main text from the footnote area.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2Fmaxheight 57 Sets a maximum height for the footnote area. Enable this option, then enter the height.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2Fstyle 67 Select the formatting style for the separator line. If you do not want a separator line, choose "None".
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnoteareapage%2Fspacetotext 72 Enter the amount of space to leave between the bottom page margin and the first line of text in the footnote area.
3f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fendntnumfmt 31 Specifies a custom numbering format for endnotes.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fendoffset 35 Enter the number that you want to assign the endnote.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fendntnum 3e Restarts the endnote numbering at the number that you specify.
42 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fendntattextend 28 Adds endnotes at the end of the section.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fftnsuffix 42 Enter the text that you want to display after the footnote number.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fendprefix 46 Enter the text that you want to display in front of the endnote number
41 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fftnnumviewbox 2d Select the numbering style for the footnotes.
41 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fendnumviewbox 2c Select the numbering style for the endnotes.
42 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fftnntattextend aa Adds footnotes at the end of the section. If the section spans more than one page, the footnotes are added to the bottom of the page on which the footnote anchors appear.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fendsuffix 41 Enter the text that you want to display after the endnote number.
4c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2FFootnotesEndnotesTabPage 58 Specifies where footnotes and endnotes are displayed as well as their numbering formats.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fftnntnum 3f Restarts the footnote numbering at the number that you specify.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fftnprefix 48 Enter the text that you want to display in front of the footnote number.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fftnoffset 36 Enter the number that you want to assign the footnote.
3f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotesendnotestabpage%2Fftnntnumfmt 32 Specifies a custom numbering format for footnotes.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftextgridpage%2FlistLB_COLOR 3b Specifies the printing and colour options of the text grid.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftextgridpage%2FcheckCB_RUBYBELOW 39 Displays Ruby text to the left of or below the base text.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftextgridpage%2FradioRB_CHARSGRID 4e Adds or removes a text grid for lines or characters to the current page style.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftextgridpage%2FspinMF_RUBYSIZE 26 Enter the font size for the Ruby text.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftextgridpage%2FTextGridPage af Adds a text grid to the current page style. This option is only available if Asian language support is enabled under Language Settings - Languages in the Options dialogue box.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftextgridpage%2FspinMF_TEXTSIZE 55 Enter the maximum base text size. A large value results in fewer characters per line.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftextgridpage%2FspinNF_LINESPERPAGE 3a Enter the maximum number of lines that you want on a page.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftextgridpage%2FspinNF_CHARSPERLINE 3f Enter the maximum number of characters that you want on a line.
14 .uno%3AGraphicDialog 47 Formats the size, position, and other properties of the selected image.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Ffollowtextflow b5 Keeps the selected object within the layout boundaries of the text that the object is anchored to. To place the selected object anywhere in your document, do not select this option.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Ffollowtextflow b5 Keeps the selected object within the layout boundaries of the text that the object is anchored to. To place the selected object anywhere in your document, do not select this option.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Ftopage 2a Anchors the selection to the current page.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Fvertpos 34 Select the vertical alignment option for the object.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fautoheight a6 Automatically adjusts the width or height of a frame to match the contents of the frame. If you want, you can specify a minimum width or minimum height for the frame.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Fbyhori 86 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the selected object and the reference point that you select in the To box.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Frelheightrelation 6c Decides what 100% height means: either text area (excluding margins) or the entire page (including margins).
21 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Fmirror 41 Reverses the current horizontal alignment settings on even pages.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Fheight 37 Enter the height that you want for the selected object.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Forigsize 47 Resets the size settings of the selected object to the original values.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Faschar 73 Anchors the selection as character. The height of the current line is resized to match the height of the selection.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fvertpos 34 Select the vertical alignment option for the object.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fheight 37 Enter the height that you want for the selected object.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2FFrameTypePage 4e Specifies the size and the position of the selected object or frame on a page.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Frelwidthrelation 6b Decides what 100% width means: either text area (excluding margins) or the entire page (including margins).
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fwidth 36 Enter the width that you want for the selected object.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2FSwPosSizePage 4e Specifies the size and the position of the selected object or frame on a page.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Fwidth 36 Enter the width that you want for the selected object.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Fratio 55 Maintains the height and width ratio when you change the width or the height setting.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Fvertanchor 46 Select the reference point for the selected vertical alignment option.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Ftochar 25 Anchors the selection to a character.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Ftopage 2a Anchors the selection to the current page.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Ftopara 2f Anchors the selection to the current paragraph.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Frelwidth 7d Calculates the width of the selected object as a percentage of the width of the text area of the paragraph it is anchored to.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fvertanchor 46 Select the reference point for the selected vertical alignment option.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Frelheight 7f Calculates the height of the selected object as a percentage of the height of the text area of the paragraph it is anchored to.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fratio 55 Maintains the height and width ratio when you change the width or the height setting.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Ftopara 2f Anchors the selection to the current paragraph.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Ftochar 25 Anchors the selection to a character.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Faschar 73 Anchors the selection as character. The height of the current line is resized to match the height of the selection.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fhoripos 36 Select the horizontal alignment option for the object.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Fbyvert 85 Enter the amount of space to leave between the top edge of the selected object and the reference point that you select in the To box.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Fhoripos 36 Select the horizontal alignment option for the object.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fhorianchor 48 Select the reference point for the selected horizontal alignment option.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fswpossizepage%2Fhorianchor 48 Select the reference point for the selected horizontal alignment option.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fmirror 41 Reverses the current horizontal alignment settings on even pages.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fbyhori 86 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the selected object and the reference point that you select in the To box.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmtypepage%2Fbyvert 85 Enter the amount of space to leave between the top edge of the selected object and the reference point that you select in the To box.
27 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Ftop 58 Enter the amount of space that you want between the top edge of the object and the text.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Fright 5a Enter the amount of space that you want between the right edge of the object and the text.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Foutside 60 Wraps text only around the contour of the object, but not in open areas within the object shape.
12 .uno%3AWrapContour 71 Wraps text around the shape of the object. This option is not available for the Through wrap type, or for frames.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Foutline 71 Wraps text around the shape of the object. This option is not available for the Through wrap type, or for frames.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Ftransparent 71 Moves the selected object to the background. This option is only available if you selected the Through wrap type.
28 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Fleft 59 Enter the amount of space that you want between the left edge of the object and the text.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrapdialog%2FWrapDialog 37 Specify the way you want text to wrap around an object.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Fthrough 27 Places the object in front of the text.
f .uno%3AWrapMenu 37 Specify the way you want text to wrap around an object.
f .uno%3ATextWrap 37 Specify the way you want text to wrap around an object.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Fbefore 43 Wraps text on the left side of the object if there is enough space.
28 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Fnone 96 Places the object on a separate line in the document. The Text in the document appears above and below the object, but not on the sides of the object.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Foptimal ce Automatically wraps text to the left, to the right, or on all four sides of the border frame of the object. If the distance between the object and the page margin is less than 2 cm, the text is not wrapped.
e .uno%3AWrapOff 96 Places the object on a separate line in the document. The Text in the document appears above and below the object, but not on the sides of the object.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2FWrapPage 37 Specify the way you want text to wrap around an object.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Fafter 44 Wraps text on the right side of the object if there is enough space.
d .uno%3AWrapOn 3f Wraps text on all four sides of the border frame of the object.
1d .uno%3AWrapThroughTransparent 71 Moves the selected object to the background. This option is only available if you selected the Through wrap type.
12 .uno%3AWrapThrough 27 Places the object in front of the text.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Fbottom 5b Enter the amount of space that you want between the bottom edge of the object and the text.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Fparallel 3f Wraps text on all four sides of the border frame of the object.
10 .uno%3AWrapIdeal ce Automatically wraps text to the left, to the right, or on all four sides of the border frame of the object. If the distance between the object and the page margin is less than 2 cm, the text is not wrapped.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwrappage%2Fanchoronly 3e Starts a new paragraph below the object after you press Enter.
15 .uno%3AWrapAnchorOnly 3e Starts a new paragraph below the object after you press Enter.
27 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2Fspinbutton 9b Enter the colour tolerance for the Colour Replacer as a percentage. To increase the colour range that the Colour Replacer selects, enter a high percentage.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_POLYEDIT 5f Lets you change the shape of the contour. Click here, and then drag the handles of the contour.
26 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_APPLY 2b Applies the contour to the selected object.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_RECT 73 Draws a rectangular contour where you drag in the object preview. To draw a square, hold down Shift while you drag.
27 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_SELECT 3e Changes to selection mode, so that you can select the contour.
26 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2Fcontainer 22 Displays a preview of the contour.
14 .uno%3AContourDialog 81 Changes the contour of the selected object. $[officename] uses the contour when determining the text wrap options for the object.
2b svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_POLYDELETE 67 Removes a point from the contour outline. Click here, and then click the point that you want to delete.
27 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_CIRCLE 3b Draws an oval contour where you drag in the object preview.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_POLY 184 Draws a closed contour consisting of straight line segments. Click where you want to start the polygon, and drag to draw a line segment. Click again to define the end of the line segment, and continue clicking to define the remaining line segments of the polygon. Double-click to finish drawing the polygon. To constrain the polygon to angles of 45 degree, hold down Shift when you click.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_POLYMOVE 4c Lets you drag the handles of the contour to change the shape of the contour.
2a svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_WORKPLACE 4b Deletes the custom contour. Click here, and then click in the preview area.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_UNDO 19 Reverses the last action.
2b svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_POLYINSERT 79 Inserts a handle that you can drag to change the shape of the contour. Click here, and then click on the contour outline.
2c svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_AUTOCONTOUR 42 Automatically draws a contour around the object that you can edit.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_REDO 2d Reverses the action of the last Undo command.
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffloatingcontour%2FTBI_PIPETTE c4 Selects the parts of the bitmap that are the same colour. Click here, and then click a colour in the bitmap. To increase the colour range that is selected, increase the value in the Tolerance box.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fpicturepage%2Fentry 8c Displays the path to the linked graphic file. To change the link, click the Browse button and then locate the file that you want to link to.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fpicturepage%2Fleftpages 39 Flips the selected image horizontally only on even pages.
15 .uno%3AFlipHorizontal 24 Flips the selected image vertically.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fpicturepage%2Fbrowse 4a Locate the new graphic file that you want to link to, and then click Open.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fpicturepage%2Frightpages 38 Flips the selected image horizontally only on odd pages.
13 .uno%3AFlipVertical 26 Flips the selected image horizontally.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fpicturepage%2FPicturePage 3d Specify the flip and the link options for the selected image.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fpicturepage%2Fhori 26 Flips the selected image horizontally.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fpicturepage%2Fvert 24 Flips the selected image vertically.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fpicturepage%2Fallpages 33 Flips the selected image horizontally on all pages.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feventassignpage%2Fassign 31 Assigns the selected macro to the selected event.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feventassignpage%2Fmacros 72 Lists the available macros. Select the macro that you want to assign to the selected event, and then click Assign.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feventassignpage%2Fdelete 35 Removes the macro assignment from the selected entry.
26 cui%2Fui%2Feventassignpage%2Flibraries 44 Lists the $[officename] program and any open $[officename] document.
2c cui%2Fui%2Feventassignpage%2FEventAssignPage 4c Specifies the macro to run when you click an image, frame, or an OLE object.
28 cui%2Fui%2Feventassignpage%2Fassignments 2a Lists the events that can trigger a macro.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmurlpage%2Fclient 3c Uses the image map that you created for the selected object.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmurlpage%2Furl 3a Enter the complete path to the file that you want to open.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmurlpage%2Fserver 1d Uses a server-side image map.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmurlpage%2FFrameURLPage 56 Specify the properties of the hyperlink for the selected graphic, frame or OLE object.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmurlpage%2Fsearch 49 Locate the file that you want the hyperlink to open, and then click Open.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmurlpage%2Fname 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmurlpage%2Fframe 47 Specify the name of the frame where you want to open the targeted file.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Fvertalign fe Specifies the vertical alignment of the frame's content. Mainly it means text content, but it also affects tables and other objects anchored to the text area (anchored as character, to character or to paragraph), for example frames, graphics or drawings.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Feditinreadonly 5d Allows you to edit the contents of a frame in a document that is read-only (write-protected).
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Fprotectsize 24 Locks the size of the selected item.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Ftextflow a3 Specifies the preferred text flow direction in a frame. To use the default text flow settings for the page, select Use superordinate object settings from the list.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Fprotectframe 40 Locks the position of the selected item in the current document.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Fname 23 Enter a name for the selected item.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2FFrameAddPage 3f Specifies properties for the selected object, graphic or frame.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Faltname 91 Enter the text to display in a web browser when the selected item is unavailable. Alternate text is also used to assist people with disabilities.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Fprintframe 37 Includes the selected item when you print the document.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Fprotectcontent 35 Prevents changes to the content of the selected item.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Fprev f8 Displays the item (object, graphic, or frame) that comes before the current item in a linked sequence. To add or change the previous link, select a name from the list. If you are linking frames, the current frame and the target frame must be empty.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffrmaddpage%2Fnext df Displays the item (object, graphic, or frame) that comes after the current item in a linked sequence. To add or change the next link, select a name from the list. If you are a linking frames, the target frame must be empty.
12 .uno%3AFrameDialog 73 Opens a dialogue box in which you can modify the properties of the selected object, for example, its size and name.
12 .uno%3ATableDialog 7d Specifies the properties of the selected table, for example, name, alignment, spacing, column width, borders, and background.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Frightmf 69 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the right page margin and the edge of the table.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Fleftmf 68 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the left page margin and the edge of the table.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Fcenter 2b Centres the table horizontally on the page.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Fright 3c Aligns the right edge of the table to the right page margin.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Fabovemf 70 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the top edge of the table and the text above the table.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Ffromleft 63 Aligns the left edge of the table to the indent that you enter in the Left box in the Spacing area.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Fname 69 Enter an internal name for the table. You can use this name to quickly locate the table in the Navigator.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Frelwidth 42 Displays the width of the table as a percentage of the page width.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2FFormatTablePage 52 Specify the size, position, spacing, and alignment options for the selected table.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Ffree 71 Horizontally aligns the table based on the values that you enter in the Left and Right boxes in the Spacing area.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Fwidthmf 1d Enter the width of the table.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Ffull 49 Extends the table horizontally to the left and to the right page margins.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Fbelowmf 73 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the bottom edge of the table and the text below the table.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Fleft 3a Aligns the left edge of the table to the left page margin.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftablecolumnpage%2Fnext 44 Displays the table columns found to the right of the current column.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftablecolumnpage%2Fwidth6 2d Enter the width that you want for the column.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftablecolumnpage%2Fback 43 Displays the table columns found to the left of the current column.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftablecolumnpage%2Fspace-nospin 8a Displays the amount of space that is available for adjusting the width of the columns. To set the width of the table, click the Table tab.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftablecolumnpage%2Fadaptwidth 3c Reduces or increases table width with modified column width.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftablecolumnpage%2Fadaptcolumns 42 If possible, change in column width will be equal for each column.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fvertorient 3f Specify the vertical text alignment for the cells in the table.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Frepeatheadernf 33 Enter the number of rows to include in the heading.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fheadline 50 Repeats the table heading on a new page when the table spans more than one page.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fkeep 4f Keeps the table and the following paragraph together when you insert the break.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fsplitrow 3e Allows a page break or column break inside a row of the table.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fsplit 40 Allows a page break or column break between the rows of a table.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fpagenonf 93 Enter the page number for the first page that follows the break. If you want to continue the current page numbering, leave the check box unchecked.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fpagestylelb 56 Select the page style that you want to apply to the first page that follows the break.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fbreak 61 Mark this check box, and then select the type of break that you want to associate with the table.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fpage 2f Inserts a page break before or after the table.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fpagestyle 56 Applies the page style that you specify to the first page that follows the page break.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fafter 2f Inserts a page or column break after the table.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2FTableTextFlowPage 42 Set the text flow options for the text before and after the table.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fbefore 30 Inserts a page or column break before the table.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Ftextdirection 31 Select the orientation for the text in the cells.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftabletextflowpage%2Fcolumn 48 Inserts a column break before or after the table on a multi-column page.
e .uno%3AProtect 40 Prevents the contents of the selected cells from being modified.
19 .uno%3AUnsetCellsReadOnly 48 Removes the cell protection for all selected cells in the current table.
28 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Frowheight%2Ffit 48 Automatically adjusts the row height to match the contents of the cells.
13 .uno%3ASetRowHeight 2a Changes the height of the selected row(s).
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Frowheight%2Fheightmf 37 Enter the height that you want for the selected row(s).
1a .uno%3ASetOptimalRowHeight 45 Automatically adjusts row heights to match the contents of the cells.
10 .uno%3AEntireRow 29 Selects the row that contains the cursor.
11 .uno%3ADeleteRows 2b Deletes the selected row(s) from the table.
15 .uno%3ASetColumnWidth 2c Changes the width of the selected column(s).
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnwidth%2Fwidth 39 Enter the width that you want for the selected column(s).
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnwidth%2Fcolumn 46 Enter the column number of the column you want to change the width of.
1c .uno%3ASetOptimalColumnWidth 47 Automatically adjusts column widths to match the contents of the cells.
13 .uno%3AEntireColumn 2c Selects the column that contains the cursor.
29 cui%2Fui%2Finsertrowcolumn%2Finsert_after 5c Adds new columns to the right of the current column, or adds new rows below the current row.
2a cui%2Fui%2Finsertrowcolumn%2Finsert_before 5b Adds new columns to the left of the current column, or adds new rows above the current row.
2a cui%2Fui%2Finsertrowcolumn%2Finsert_number 32 Enter the number of columns or rows that you want.
16 .uno%3AInsertRowDialog 1d Inserts a row into the table.
19 .uno%3AInsertColumnDialog 20 Inserts a column into the table.
14 .uno%3ADeleteColumns 2e Deletes the selected column(s) from the table.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconditionpage%2Fremove 48 Click here to remove the current context assigned to the selected style.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconditionpage%2Fapply 4a Click Assign to apply the selected Paragraph Style to the defined context.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconditionpage%2Fstyles 5f A list of all Paragraph Styles which can be assigned to a context is contained in the list box.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconditionpage%2Fcondstyle 41 Mark this check box to define a new style as a conditional style.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconditionpage%2Flinks c7 Here you can see the $[officename] predefined contexts, including outline levels 1 to 10, numbering/bullets levels 1 to 10, table header, table contents, section, border, footnote, header and footer.
1b .uno%3AStyleUpdateByExample 96 The manually formatted attributes of the text at the cursor position in the document will be added to the style that is selected in the Styles window.
1e SFX2_HID_TEMPLDLG_NEWBYEXAMPLE 58 Creates a new style based on the formatting of the current paragraph, page or selection.
18 .uno%3AStyleNewByExample 58 Creates a new style based on the formatting of the current paragraph, page or selection.
11 .uno%3ALoadStyles 4a Opens the Load Styles dialogue box to import styles from another document.
21 SFX2_HID_TEMPLDLG_UPDATEBYEXAMPLE 96 The manually formatted attributes of the text at the cursor position in the document will be added to the style that is selected in the Styles window.
1a SFX2_HID_TEMPLDLG_WATERCAN a0 Applies the selected style to the object or text that you select in the document. Click this icon, and then drag a selection in the document to apply the style.
10 .uno%3AListStyle 3b Displays formatting styles for numbered and bulleted lists.
10 .uno%3AEditStyle 75 Choose Edit Paragraph Style in the context menu of a paragraph to edit the style of all paragraphs of the same style.
15 SFX2_HID_TEMPLATE_FMT 82 Use the Styles deck of the Sidebar to apply, create, edit, and remove formatting styles. Double-click an entry to apply the style.
10 .uno%3APageStyle 25 Displays formatting styles for pages.
10 .uno%3ACharStyle 2a Displays formatting styles for characters.
11 .uno%3AFrameStyle 26 Displays formatting styles for frames.
10 .uno%3AParaStyle 2a Displays formatting styles for paragraphs.
17 .uno%3AOnlineAutoFormat 95 Automatically formats the document while you type. To set the formatting options, choose Tools - AutoCorrect Options, and then click the Options tab.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2Fbordercb 33 Includes border styles in the selected table style.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2Falignmentcb 38 Includes alignment settings in the selected table style.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2Fpatterncb 37 Includes background styles in the selected table style.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2Fformatlb 6d Lists the available formatting styles for tables. Click the format that you want to apply, and then click OK.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2Fnumformatcb 37 Includes numbering formats in the selected table style.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2Frename 5b Changes the name of the selected table style. You cannot rename the "Standard" table style.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2FAutoFormatTableDialog 59 Automatically applies formats to the current table, including fonts, shading and borders.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2Fadd 23 Adds a new table style to the list.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2Fremove 21 Deletes the selected table style.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2Ffontcb 35 Includes font formatting in the selected table style.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fpercentdialog%2FPercentDialog 61 Enter the minimum length for combining single-lined paragraphs as a percentage of the page width.
16 .uno%3AAutoFormatApply 67 Automatically formats the file according to the options that you set under Tools - AutoCorrect Options.
17 HID_AUTOFORMAT_EDIT_CHG 9a Opens a dialogue box in which you can accept or reject AutoCorrect changes. You can also view the changes made by a specific author or on a specific date.
15 HID_AUTOFORMAT_REJECT 26 Rejects all of the formatting changes.
1d .uno%3AAutoFormatRedlineApply a9 Automatically formats the file according to the options that you set under Tools - AutoCorrect Options. In a dialogue box, you are asked to accept or reject the changes.
15 HID_AUTOFORMAT_ACCEPT 26 Applies all of the formatting changes.
28 sfx%2Fui%2Floadtemplatedialog%2Ffromfile 51 Locate the file containing the styles that you want to load, and then click Open.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Floadtemplatedialog%2Foverwrite 5e Replaces styles in the current document that have the same name as the styles you are loading.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Floadtemplatedialog%2Fnumbering 50 Loads the numbering styles from the selected document into the current document.
2a sfx%2Fui%2Floadtemplatedialog%2Fcategories 65 Lists the available template categories. Click a category to view its contents in the Templates list.
11 .uno%3ALoadStyles 56 Imports formatting styles from another document or template into the current document.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Floadtemplatedialog%2Fframe 4c Loads the frame styles from the selected document into the current document.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Floadtemplatedialog%2Ftemplates 38 Lists the available templates for the selected category.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Floadtemplatedialog%2Ftext 62 Loads the paragraph and the character styles from the selected document into the current document.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Floadtemplatedialog%2Fpages 4b Loads the page styles from the selected document into the current document.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsplittable%2Fcustomheading 34 Inserts an additional blank row in the second table.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsplittable%2Fnoheading 30 Splits the table without copying the header row.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsplittable%2Fcustomheadingapplystyle 77 Inserts a blank header row in the second table that is formatted with the style of the first row in the original table.
11 .uno%3ASplitTable 49 Splits the current table into two separate tables at the cursor position.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsplittable%2Fcopyheading 52 Includes the first row of the original table as the first row of the second table.
11 .uno%3AMergeTable 8c Combines two consecutive tables into a single table. The tables must be directly next to each other and not separated by an empty paragraph.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fhyphenate%2Fdelete 3e Removes the current hyphenation point from the displayed word.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fhyphenate%2FHyphenateDialog 47 Inserts hyphens in words that are too long to fit at the end of a line.
10 .uno%3AHyphenate 47 Inserts hyphens in words that are too long to fit at the end of a line.
19 cui%2Fui%2Fhyphenate%2Fok 2d Inserts the hyphen at the indicated position.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fhyphenate%2Fworded 3d Displays the hyphenation suggestion(s) for the selected word.
1c cui%2Fui%2Fhyphenate%2Fright 73 Set the position of the hyphen. This option is only available if more than one hyphenation suggestion is displayed.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fhyphenate%2Fcontinue 48 Ignores the hyphenation suggestion and finds the next word to hyphenate.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fwordcount%2FWordCountDialog ae Counts the words and characters, with or without spaces, in the current selection and in the whole document. The count is kept up to date as you type or change the selection.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumbering%2Fsaveas a0 Opens a dialogue box where you can save the current settings for the selected chapter and outline level. You can then load these settings from another document.
1d .uno%3AChapterNumberingDialog 5c Specifies the number format and the hierarchy for chapter numbering in the current document.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnumberingnamedialog%2Fform 96 Click a numbering style in the list, and then enter a name for the style. The numbers correspond to the outline level that the styles are assigned to.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumbering%2Fform1 5c Select the predefined numbering style that you want to assign to the selected outline level.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumbering%2Fuser 75 Saves or loads a chapter and outline number format. A saved outline number format is available to all text documents.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumberingpage%2Fstartat 43 Enter the number that you want to restart the chapter numbering at.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumberingpage%2Fstyle 5d Select the paragraph style that you want to assign to the selected chapter and outline level.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumberingpage%2Fsuffix 41 Enter the text that you want to display after the chapter number.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumberingpage%2Flevel 72 Click the chapter and outline level that you want to modify, and then specify the numbering options for the level.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumberingpage%2Fcharstyle 2d Select the format of the numbering character.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumberingpage%2Fsublevelsnf 94 Select the number of outline levels to include in the chapter numbering. For example, select "3" to display three levels of chapter numbering: 1.1.1
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumberingpage%2Fprefix 42 Enter the text that you want to display before the chapter number.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinenumberingpage%2Fnumbering 50 Select the numbering style that you want to apply to the selected outline level.
15 .uno%3AFootnoteDialog 3a Specifies the display settings for footnotes and endnotes.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fcharstylelb 5e Select the character style that you want to use for the footnote numbers in the footnote area.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fcontfromed c7 Enter the text that you want to display on the page where the footnotes are continued, for example, "Continued from Page ". $[officename] Writer automatically inserts the number of the previous page.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fpagestylelb 39 Select the page style that you want to use for footnotes.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fposdoccb 3a Displays footnotes at the end of the document as endnotes.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fnumberinglb 4a Select the numbering style that you want to use for footnotes or endnotes.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fprefix 59 Enter the text that you want to display in front of the footnote number in the note text.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fpospagecb 2d Displays footnotes at the bottom of the page.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2FFootnotePage 34 Specifies the formatting for footnotes and endnotes.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fcharanchorstylelb 67 Select the character style that you want to use for footnote anchors in the text area of your document.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fparastylelb 31 Select the paragraph style for the footnote text.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fcountinglb 2e Select the numbering option for the footnotes.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fconted ca Enter the text that you want to display when the footnotes are continued on the next page, for example, "Continued on Page ". $[officename] Writer automatically inserts the number of the following page.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Foffsetnf 8a Enter the number for the first footnote in the document. This option is only available if you selected "Per Document" in the Counting box.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffootnotepage%2Fsuffix 53 Enter the text that you want to display after the footnote number in the note text.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fendnotepage%2Fcharstylelb 5c Select the character style that you want to use for the endnote numbers in the endnote area.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fendnotepage%2Fcharanchorstylelb 66 Select the character style that you want to use for endnote anchors in the text area of your document.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fendnotepage%2Foffsetnf 37 Enter the number for the first endnote in the document.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fendnotepage%2Fprefix 58 Enter the text that you want to display in front of the endnote number in the note text.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fendnotepage%2Fsuffix 52 Enter the text that you want to display after the endnote number in the note text.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fendnotepage%2FEndnotePage 26 Specifies the formatting for endnotes.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fendnotepage%2Fparastylelb 30 Select the paragraph style for the endnote text.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fendnotepage%2Fpagestylelb 38 Select the page style that you want to use for endnotes.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Fdontsplitcb 27 Does not divide the table across pages.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Frepeatheaderssb 25 Repeats the first n rows as a header.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Frepeatheading 3b Repeats the table header on each page that the table spans.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Fbordercb 2f Adds a border to the table and the table cells.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Fkeepcolumn 50 Creates columns of equal width, regardless of the position of the column marker.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Ftabs 3a Converts the text to a table using tabs as column markers.
17 .uno%3AConvertTableText 49 Converts the selected text into a table, or the selected table into text.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Fheadingcb 34 Formats the first row of the new table as a heading.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Fsemicolons 45 Converts the text to a table using semi-colons (;) as column markers.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Fparagraph 40 Converts the text to a table using paragraphs as column markers.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Fother 5d Converts the text to a table using the character that you type in the box as a column marker.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Fautofmt 59 Opens the AutoFormat dialogue box, in which you can select a predefined layout for table.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fconverttexttable%2Fothered 3b Type the character that you want to use as a column marker.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Fmatchcase 7c Distinguishes between upper-case and lower-case letters when you sort a table. For Asian languages special handling applies.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Fdelimpb 72 Opens the Special Characters dialogue box, where you can select the character that you want to use as a separator.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Fseparator 4d Enter the character that you want to use as a separator in the selected area.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Ftabs 56 If the selected paragraphs correspond to a list separated by tabs, select this option.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Frows 65 Sorts the rows in the table or the paragraphs in the selection according to the current sort options.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Fcolumns 45 Sorts the columns in the table according to the current sort options.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Fkey3 46 Specifies additional sorting criteria. You can also combine sort keys.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Fup3 3c Sorts in ascending order, (for example, 1, 2, 3 or a, b, c).
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Flanglb 33 Select the language that defines the sorting rules.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Fcolsb3 51 Enter the number of the table column that you want to use as a basis for sorting.
11 .uno%3ASortDialog 4a Sorts the selected paragraphs or table rows alphabetically or numerically.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Ftypelb3 2f Select the sorting option that you want to use.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsortdialog%2Fdown3 3c Sorts in descending order (for example, 9, 8, 7 or z, y, x).
13 .uno%3ACalculateSel 47 Calculates the selected formula and copies the result to the clipboard.
11 .uno%3ARepaginate 78 Updates the page formats in the document and recalculates the total number of pages that is displayed on the Status Bar.
15 .uno%3AUpdateCurIndex 1a Updates the current index.
14 .uno%3ARemoveTableOf 23 Deletes the current index or table.
13 .uno%3AEditCurIndex 21 Edits the current index or table.
17 .uno%3AUpdateAllIndexes 98 Update all indexes and tables of contents in the current document. You do not need to place the cursor in an index or table before you use this command.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Frestarteverynewpage 40 Restarts line numbering at the top of each page in the document.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Fblanklines 2c Includes empty paragraphs in the line count.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Ftextentry 33 Enter the text that you want to use as a separator.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Fstyledropdown 46 Select the formatting style that you want to use for the line numbers.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Flinesspin 3a Enter the number of lines to leave between the separators.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Fshownumbering 2a Adds line numbers to the current document.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Fformatdropdown 30 Select the numbering style that you want to use.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Fpositiondropdown 31 Select where you want the line numbers to appear.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Fspacingspin 57 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the line numbers and the text.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Flinesintextframes 9f Adds line numbers to text in text frames. The numbering restarts in each text frame, and is excluded from the line count in the main text area of the document.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flinenumbering%2Fintervalspin 31 Enter the counting interval for the line numbers.
10 .uno%3AUpdateAll 64 Updates all links, fields, indexes, tables of contents, and page formatting in the current document.
13 .uno%3AUpdateFields 3b Updates the contents of all fields in the current document.
15 .uno%3AUpdateAllLinks 2a Updates the links in the current document.
13 .uno%3AUpdateCharts 2b Updates the charts in the current document.
16 .uno%3ADrawGraphicMenu 3f Opens a sub-menu to edit the properties of the selected object.
12 .uno%3AMergeDialog 5f Starts the Mail Merge Wizard to create form letters or send e-mail messages to many recipients.
16 .uno%3AMailMergeWizard 5f Starts the Mail Merge Wizard to create form letters or send e-mail messages to many recipients.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmselectpage%2Frecentdoclb 14 Select the document.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmselectpage%2Frecentdoc 4e Use an existing mail merge document as the base for a new mail merge document.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmselectpage%2Fbrowsetemplate 27 Opens a template selector dialogue box.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmselectpage%2Fcurrentdoc 49 Uses the current Writer document as the base for the mail merge document.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmselectpage%2Ftemplate 4a Select the template that you want to create your mail merge document with.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmselectpage%2FMMSelectPage 50 Specify the document that you want to use as a base for the mail merge document.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmselectpage%2Fbrowsedoc 45 Locate the Writer document that you want to use, and then click Open.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmselectpage%2Fnewdoc 38 Creates a new Writer document to use for the mail merge.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmselectpage%2Floaddoc 52 Select an existing Writer document to use as the base for the mail merge document.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmoutputtypepage%2Femail 5c Creates mail merge documents that you can send as an e-mail message or an e-mail attachment.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmoutputtypepage%2FMMOutputTypePage 32 Specify the type of mail merge document to create.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmoutputtypepage%2Fletter 28 Creates a printable mail merge document.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmaddressblockpage%2Fnext 58 Use the browse buttons to preview the information from the previous or next data record.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmaddressblockpage%2Fprev 58 Use the browse buttons to preview the information from the previous or next data record.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmaddressblockpage%2Faddresslist 96 Opens the Select Address List dialogue box, in which you can choose a data source for the addresses, add new addresses, or type in a new address list.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmaddressblockpage%2Faddress 31 Adds an address block to the mail merge document.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmaddressblockpage%2Fsettingspreview 35 Select the address block layout that you want to use.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmaddressblockpage%2FMMAddressBlockPage 5e Specify the recipients for the mail merge document as well as the layout of the address block.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmaddressblockpage%2Fhideempty 2f Enable to leave empty lines out of the address.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmaddressblockpage%2Faddresspreview 3f Shows a preview of the address block template filled with data.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmaddressblockpage%2Fassign 24 Opens the Match Fields dialogue box.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmaddressblockpage%2Fsettings 2c Opens the Select Address Block dialogue box.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Fnext 58 Use the browse buttons to preview the information from the previous or next data record.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Fgeneral 5d Select the default salutation that is used when you do not specify a personalised salutation.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Ffemalefield 42 Select the field value that indicates the gender of the recipient.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Ffemalecol 59 Select the field name of the address database field that contains the gender information.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Fprev 58 Use the browse buttons to preview the information from the previous or next data record.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Fgreeting 12 Adds a salutation.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Fassign 24 Opens the Match Fields dialogue box.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Fnewmale 3a Opens the Custom Salutation (Male recipient) dialogue box.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Ffemale 38 Select the personalised greeting for a female recipient.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Fpreview 25 Displays a preview of the salutation.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2FMMSalutationPage 2a Specify the properties for the salutation.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Fpersonalized 70 Adds a personalised salutation to the mail merge document. To use the default salutation, unmark this check box.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Fnewfemale 3c Opens the Custom Salutation (Female recipient) dialogue box.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmsalutationpage%2Fmale 36 Select the personalised greeting for a male recipient.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmlayoutpage%2Fexample 3d Provides a preview of the salutation positioning on the page.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmlayoutpage%2Ftop 6a Enter the amount of space to leave between the top edge of the page and the top edge of the address block.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmlayoutpage%2FMMLayoutPage 4c Specify the position of the address blocks and salutations on the documents.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmlayoutpage%2Fzoom 2d Select a magnification for the print preview.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmlayoutpage%2Fleft 6c Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the left edge of the address block.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmlayoutpage%2Falign 49 Aligns the frame that contains the address block to the left page margin.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmlayoutpage%2Fup 18 Moves the salutation up.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmlayoutpage%2Fdown 1a Moves the salutation down.
27 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fccdialog%2Fbcc 4a Enter the recipients of e-mail blind copies, separated by a semicolon (;).
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fccdialog%2FCCDialog 44 Enter the recipients of e-mail copies, separated by a semicolon (;).
26 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fccdialog%2Fcc 44 Enter the recipients of e-mail copies, separated by a semicolon (;).
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcustomizeaddrlistdialog%2Fdelete 1b Deletes the selected field.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcustomizeaddrlistdialog%2Fadd 19 Inserts a new text field.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcustomizeaddrlistdialog%2Frename 20 Renames the selected text field.
4a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcustomizeaddrlistdialog%2FCustomizeAddrListDialog 3b Select the fields that you want to move, delete, or rename.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcustomizeaddrlistdialog%2Ftreeview 3b Select the fields that you want to move, delete, or rename.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2Fright 46 Select an item in the list and click an arrow button to move the item.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2Fup 46 Select an item in the list and click an arrow button to move the item.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2Faddrpreview 53 Displays a preview of the first database record with the current salutation layout.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2Fleft 46 Select an item in the list and click an arrow button to move the item.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2FAddressBlockDialog 34 Select a field and drag the field to the other list.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2Faddresses 34 Select a field and drag the field to the other list.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2Ftoaddr 73 Adds the selected field from the list of salutation elements to the other list. You can add a field more than once.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2Fdown 46 Select an item in the list and click an arrow button to move the item.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2Fcustom 50 Select a value from the list for the salutation and the punctuation mark fields.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2Ffromaddr 2f Removes the selected field from the other list.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Faddressblockdialog%2Faddressdest 3d Arrange the fields by drag-and-drop or use the arrow buttons.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2Fbodymle 22 Enter the main text of the e-mail.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2Fgeneral 52 Select the default greeting to use if a personalised salutation cannot be created.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2Ffemalecol 59 Select the field name of the address database field that contains the gender information.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2Fnewmale 3e Opens the Custom Salutation dialogue box for a male recipient.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2FMailBodyDialog 52 Type the message and the salutation for files that you send as e-mail attachments.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2Ffemale 38 Select the personalised greeting for a female recipient.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2Fgreeting 20 Adds a salutation to the e-mail.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2Fpersonalized 55 Adds a personalised salutation. To use the default salutation, unmark this check box.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2Ffemalefield 42 Select the field value that indicates the gender of the recipient.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2Fnewfemale 40 Opens the Custom Salutation dialogue box for a female recipient.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmmailbody%2Fmale 36 Select the personalised greeting for a male recipient.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Fok 1f Click to start sending e-mails.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Fto-nospin 41 Enter the number of the last record to include in the mail merge.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Ffrom-nospin 42 Enter the number of the first record to include in the mail merge.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Ffromrb 77 Selects a range of records starting at the record number in the From box and ending at the record number in the To box.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Fsendallrb 29 Select to send e-mails to all recipients.
42 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2FMMResultEmailDialog 49 Sends the mail merge output as e-mail messages to all or some recipients.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Fmailto 4c Select the database field that contains the e-mail address of the recipient.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Fcopyto 58 Opens the Copy To dialogue box in which you can specify one or more CC or BCC addresses.
1e .uno%3AMailMergeEmailDocuments 49 Sends the mail merge output as e-mail messages to all or some recipients.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Fsubject 2f Enter the subject line for the e-mail messages.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Fattach 21 Shows the name of the attachment.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Fsendassettings 86 Opens the E-Mail Message dialogue box in which you can enter the e-mail message for the mail merge files that are sent as attachments.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultemaildialog%2Fsendas 2f Select the mail format for the e-mail messages.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffindentrydialog%2Ffind 37 Displays the next record that contains the search text.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffindentrydialog%2Farea 3c Select the data field where you want to search for the text.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffindentrydialog%2Ffindin 27 Restricts the search to one data field.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffindentrydialog%2FFindEntryDialog 42 Searches for a record or recipient in the mail merge address list.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffindentrydialog%2Fentry 16 Enter the search term.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fassignfieldsdialog%2FPREVIEW 3a Displays a preview of the values of the first data record.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fassignfieldsdialog%2FAssignFieldsDialog 8b Matches the logical field names of the layout dialog to the field names in your database when you create new address blocks or salutations.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fassignfieldsdialog%2FFIELDS 46 Select a field name in your database for each logical address element.
1e SW_HID_MM_ADDBLOCK_MOVEBUTTONS 47 Select an item in the list and click an arrow button to move the entry.
1a SW_HID_MM_ADDBLOCK_PREVIEW 56 Displays a preview of the first database record with the current address block layout.
17 SW_HID_MM_ADDBLOCK_DRAG 3f Arrange the fields with drag-and-drop or use the arrow buttons.
19 SW_HID_MM_ADDBLOCK_REMOVE 2f Removes the selected field from the other list.
1b SW_HID_MM_ADDBLOCK_ELEMENTS 3d Select an address field and drag the field to the other list.
19 SW_HID_MM_ADDBLOCK_INSERT 49 Adds the selected field from the Address Elements list to the other list.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FCUSTOMIZE 68 Opens the Customise Address List dialogue box in which you can rearrange, rename, add and delete fields.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FFIND 62 Opens the Find Entry dialogue box. You can leave the dialogue box open while you edit the entries.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FNEW 2c Adds a new blank record to the address list.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FCreateAddressList 43 Enter new addresses or edit the addresses for mail merge documents.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FSTART 5f Click the buttons to navigate through the records or enter a record number to display a record.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FDELETE 1c Deletes the selected record.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FNEXT 5f Click the buttons to navigate through the records or enter a record number to display a record.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FEND 5f Click the buttons to navigate through the records or enter a record number to display a record.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FCONTAINER 3f Enter or edit the field contents for each mail merge recipient.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FPREV 5f Click the buttons to navigate through the records or enter a record number to display a record.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcreateaddresslist%2FSETNO-nospin 5f Click the buttons to navigate through the records or enter a record number to display a record.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultprintdialog%2Fok 20 Prints the mail merge documents.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultprintdialog%2Fto-nospin 41 Enter the number of the last record to include in the mail merge.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultprintdialog%2Ffrom-nospin 42 Enter the number of the first record to include in the mail merge.
1e .uno%3AMailMergePrintDocuments 38 Prints the mail merge output for all or some recipients.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultprintdialog%2Fprinters 13 Select the printer.
42 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultprintdialog%2FMMResultPrintDialog 38 Prints the mail merge output for all or some recipients.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultprintdialog%2Fprintersettings 1f Changes the printer properties.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultprintdialog%2Fprintallrb 24 Prints documents for all recipients.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultprintdialog%2Ffromrb 77 Selects a range of records starting at the record number in the From box and ending at the record number in the To box.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultsavedialog%2Fok 14 Saves the documents.
1d .uno%3AMailMergeSaveDocuments 23 Save the mail merge output to file.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultsavedialog%2Fto-nospin 41 Enter the number of the last record to include in the mail merge.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultsavedialog%2FMMResultSaveDialog 23 Save the mail merge output to file.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultsavedialog%2Fsinglerb 2b Saves the merged document as a single file.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultsavedialog%2Findividualrb cf Saves the merged document as a separate file for each recipient. The file names of the documents are constructed from the name that you enter, followed by an underscore, and the number of the current record.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultsavedialog%2Ffromrb 77 Selects a range of records starting at the record number in the From box and ending at the record number in the To box.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmmresultsavedialog%2Ffrom-nospin 42 Enter the number of the first record to include in the mail merge.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectblockdialog%2Fedit 5f Opens the Edit Address Block dialogue box where you can edit the selected address block layout.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectblockdialog%2Fnew 5c Opens the New Address Block dialogue box in which you can define a new address block layout.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectblockdialog%2Fdelete 2a Deletes the selected address block layout.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectblockdialog%2Fpreview 59 Select the block in the list that you want to use for mail merge addresses, and click OK.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectblockdialog%2FSelectBlockDialog 3f Select, edit, or delete an address block layout for mail merge.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectblockdialog%2Fnever 40 Excludes country or regional information from the address block.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectblockdialog%2Fcountry 3a Enter the country/region string that shall not be printed.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectblockdialog%2Falways 3e Includes country or regional information in the address block.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectblockdialog%2Fdependent 86 Only includes country or regional information in the address block if the value differs from the value that you enter in the text box.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectaddressdialog%2Fedit 59 Opens the New Address List dialogue box, in which you can edit the selected address list.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectaddressdialog%2Fcreate 54 Opens the New Address List dialogue box, in which you can create a new address list.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectaddressdialog%2Fchangetable 61 Opens the Select Table dialogue box, in which you can select another table to use for mail merge.
42 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectaddressdialog%2FSelectAddressDialog 4b Select the address list that you want to use for mail merge, then click OK.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectaddressdialog%2Ffilter 8a Opens the Standard Filter dialogue box, in which you can apply filters to the address list to display the recipients that you want to see.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselectaddressdialog%2Fadd 5d Select the database file that contains the addresses that you want to use as an address list.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselecttabledialog%2Fpreview 2d Opens the Mail Merge Recipients dialogue box.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselecttabledialog%2FSelectTableDialog 3f Select the table that you want to use for mail merge addresses.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fselecttabledialog%2Ftable 3f Select the table that you want to use for mail merge addresses.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftitlepage%2FDLG_TITLEPAGE 24 Insert title pages in your document.
16 .uno%3ATitlePageDialog 24 Insert title pages in your document.
17 .uno%3ADefaultNumbering 37 Adds or removes numbering from the selected paragraphs.
12 .uno%3AChainFrames 2b Links the selected frame to the next frame.
13 .uno%3AUnhainFrames 23 Breaks the link between two frames.
11 .uno%3AInsertRows f5 Inserts one or more rows in the table, below the cursor position or selection. You can insert more than one row by opening the corresponding dialogue box (choose Table - Insert - Rows), or by selecting more than one row before clicking the icon.
14 .uno%3AInsertColumns 114 Inserts one or more columns into the table, to the right of the cursor position or selection. You can insert several columns at the same time by opening the corresponding dialogue box (choose Table - Insert - Columns), or by selecting several columns before clicking the icon.
13 .uno%3ATableModeFix 72 If this mode is active, changes to a line and/or column affect only the neighbouring lines or columns in question.
17 .uno%3ATableModeFixProp 52 If this mode is active, changes to the line and/or column affect the entire table.
18 .uno%3ATableModeVariable 55 If this mode is active, changes to a line and/or column affect the size of the table.
e .uno%3AAutoSum 66 Activates the sum function. Note that the cursor must be in the cell where you want the sum to appear.
14 .uno%3ARemoveBullets 4f Turns off numbering or bullets in the current paragraph or selected paragraphs.
19 .uno%3ADecrementSubLevels 30 Shifts paragraphs with subpoints down one level.
19 .uno%3AIncrementSubLevels 38 Shifts paragraphs with subpoints up one numbering level.
1d .uno%3AInsertNeutralParagraph 53 Inserts a paragraph without numbering. The existing numbering will not be affected.
15 .uno%3AMoveUpSubItems 41 Moves a paragraph with subpoints to above the previous paragraph.
17 .uno%3AMoveDownSubItems 47 Moves a paragraph with all its subpoints below the following paragraph.
15 .uno%3ANumberingStart 1c Restarts the text numbering.
16 .uno%3AStatePageNumber 110 The current page number is displayed in this field of the status bar. A double-click opens the Navigator, with which you can navigate in the document. A right-click shows all bookmarks in the document. Click a bookmark to position the text cursor at the bookmark location.
14 .uno%3AStatusBarFunc 37 Displays current information about the active document.
f .uno%3AZoomPlus 30 Zooms in to get a close-up view of the document.
10 .uno%3AZoomMinus 38 Zooms out to see more of the document at a reduced size.
d .uno%3AZoomIn 38 Zooms out to see more of the document at a reduced size.
11 HID_PVIEW_ZOOM_LB 2f Determines the zoom level of the print preview.
13 .uno%3AShowTwoPages 2f Displays two pages in the Print Preview window.
12 .uno%3APreviewZoom b2 Defines the number of pages displayed on screen. Click the arrow next to the icon to open a grid to select the number of pages to be displayed as rows and columns in the preview.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fpreviewzoomdialog%2Fcols 2d Defines the number of pages shown in columns.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fpreviewzoomdialog%2Frows 24 Defines the number of rows of pages.
10 FN_SHOW_BOOKVIEW 48 Select to display the first page on the right side in the print preview.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fatan 26 Calculates the arc tangent in radians.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Facos 25 Calculates the arc cosine in radians.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Ftan 22 Calculates the tangent in radians.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fcos 21 Calculates the cosine in radians.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fsin 1e Calculates the sine in radians
f HID_MN_POP_FUNC 3a You can choose from the following trigonometric functions:
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fmin 32 Calculates the minimum value in an area or a list.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fnot 29 Tests for values matching the Boolean NOT
15 HID_MN_POP_STATISTICS 38 You can choose from the following statistical functions:
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fand 29 Tests for values matching the Boolean AND
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fsqrt 1b Calculates the square root.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fleq 39 Tests for values less than or equal to a specified value.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fg 2f Tests for values greater than a specified value
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fmax 32 Calculates the maximum value in an area or a list.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fphd 17 Calculates a percentage
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fneq 2d Tests for inequality between selected values.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fround 30 Rounds a number to the specified decimal places.
17 SW_HID_TBX_FORMULA_CALC 4f Opens a sub-menu, from which you can insert a formula into the cell of a table.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fsum 29 Calculates the sum of the selected cells.
e HID_MN_POP_OPS 31 You can insert various operators in your formula.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2F%7C 21 Separates the elements in a list.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fmean 42 Calculates the arithmetic mean of the values in an area or a list.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fpow 21 Calculates the power of a number.
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Feq 24 Checks if selected values are equal.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fxor 32 Tests for values matching the Boolean exclusive OR
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fgeq 3b Tests for values greater than or equal to a specified value
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fasin 23 Calculates the arc sine in radians.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2Fl 2c Tests for values less than a specified value
2a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finputwinmenu%2For 28 Tests for values matching the Boolean OR
19 SW_HID_TBX_FORMULA_CANCEL 41 Clears the contents of the input line and closes the formula bar.
18 SW_HID_TBX_FORMULA_APPLY ab Transfers the contents of the input line into your document and closes the formula bar. The contents of the input line are inserted at the cursor position in the document.
13 SW_HID_EDIT_FORMULA 8d Allows you to create a formula by typing it directly into the input line or by clicking the Formula icon to display the formulas in sub-menu.
11 .uno%3AInsertCtrl 61 The toolbar contains various functions for inserting frames, graphics, tables, and other objects.
16 .uno%3AInsertFieldCtrl 5b Click to open the Fields dialogue box. Click the arrow next to the icon to open a sub-menu.
15 HID_INSERT_FIELD_CTRL 5b Click to open the Fields dialogue box. Click the arrow next to the icon to open a sub-menu.
16 .uno%3AInsertDateField 24 Inserts the current date as a field.
16 .uno%3AInsertTimeField 24 Inserts the current time as a field.
1c .uno%3AInsertPageNumberField 42 Inserts the current page number as a field at the cursor position.
1b .uno%3AInsertPageCountField 3d Inserts as a field the total number of pages in the document.
17 .uno%3AInsertTopicField 45 Inserts the subject specified in the document properties as a field .
17 .uno%3AInsertTitleField 42 Inserts the title specified in the document properties as a field.
18 .uno%3AInsertAuthorField 48 Inserts the name of the person who created the document here as a field.
e .uno%3AGraphic 7b If the Images and Charts icon on the Tools bar is activated, no graphics are displayed - only empty frames as placeholders.
13 .uno%3AShadowCursor 2b Activates or deactivates the direct cursor.
10 FN_INSERT_HEADER 66 Displays the header of an HTML document if headers are enabled on the Format - Page - Header tab page.
10 FN_INSERT_FOOTER 66 Displays the footer of an HTML document if footers are enabled on the Format - Page - Footer tab page.
15 .uno%3AStateWordCount b8 The number of words in the document and selection is displayed in this field of the status bar. A double-click opens the word count dialogue box, which shows extra document statistics.
f .uno%3AFileMenu 5c These commands apply to the current document, open a new document, or close the application.
f .uno%3AEditMenu 4d This menu contains commands for editing the contents of the current document.
f .uno%3AViewMenu 52 This menu contains commands for controlling the on-screen display of the document.
16 .uno%3AInsertPagebreak 73 Inserts a manual page break at the current cursor position and places the cursor at the beginning of the next page.
11 .uno%3AInsertMenu cb The Insert menu contains commands for inserting new elements in your document. This includes images, media, charts, objects from other applications, hyperlink, comments, symbols, footnotes, and sections.
11 .uno%3AFormatMenu 4e Contains commands for formatting the layout and the contents of your document.
10 .uno%3AToolsMenu 9c Contains spelling tools, a gallery of object art that you can add to your document, as well as tools for configuring menus, and setting program preferences.
11 .uno%3AWindowList 43 Contains commands for manipulating and displaying document windows.
19 .uno%3AConvertTableToText 4a Opens a dialogue box with which you can convert the current table to text.
12 .uno%3ADeleteTable 1a Deletes the current table.
10 .uno%3ATableMenu 5a Shows commands to insert, edit and delete a table and its elements inside a text document.
12 .uno%3ASelectTable 1a Selects the current table.
18 .uno%3AHeadingRowsRepeat 53 Repeats the table headers on subsequent pages if the table spans one or more pages.
11 .uno%3AEntireCell 19 Selects the current cell.
19 .uno%3AConvertTextToTable 4d Opens a dialogue box with which you can convert the selected text to a table.
17 .uno%3AFormatStylesMenu 5a Contains commands to set, create, edit, update, load and manage styles in a text document.
16 .uno%3AParaRightToLeft 53 The text formatted in a complex text layout language is entered from right to left.
16 .uno%3AParaLeftToRight 27 The text is entered from left to right.
d .uno%3AShrink 2b Reduces the font size of the selected text.
10 HID_TEXT_TOOLBOX 3e The Formatting bar contains several text formatting functions.
b .uno%3AGrow 2d Increases the font size of the selected text.
12 HID_GRAFIK_TOOLBOX 59 The Image Bar contains functions for formatting and positioning selected bitmap graphics.
11 HID_TABLE_TOOLBOX 75 The Table Bar contains functions you need when working with tables. It appears when you move the cursor into a table.
10 HID_DRAW_TOOLBOX 125 You can see the Drawing Object Properties bar in Writer and Calc. Select the menu View - Toolbars - Drawing Object Properties. The controls are enabled when a drawing object is selected. You see some different icons by default, whether the current document is a text document or a spreadsheet.
f HID_NUM_TOOLBOX b4 The Bullets and Numbering bar contains functions to modify the structure of numbered paragraphs, including changing the order of paragraphs and defining different paragraph levels.
11 .uno%3AZoomSlider 7f Drag the Zoom slider to the left to show more pages, drag to the right to zoom into a page and show a smaller area of the page.
15 .uno%3ALanguageStatus 181 Displays the language for the selected text. Click to open a menu from which you can choose another language for the selected text or for the current paragraph. Choose None to exclude the text from spell checking and hyphenation. Choose Reset to Default Language to re-apply the default language for the selection or the paragraph. Choose More to open a dialogue box with more options.
11 .uno%3AViewLayout 92 The View Layout icons show from left to right: Single column mode. View mode with pages side by side. Book mode with two pages as in an open book.
14 .uno%3AInsertFormula 52 The Formula Bar allows you to create and insert calculations into a text document.
11 HID_FRAME_TOOLBOX 77 When a frame is selected, the Frame Bar provides the most important functions for formatting and positioning the frame.
f HID_OLE_TOOLBOX 87 The OLE Object bar appears when objects are selected, and contains the most important functions for formatting and positioning objects.
15 HID_DRAW_TEXT_TOOLBOX 49 Contains formatting commands for text that is contained in a draw object.
1d .uno%3AInsertHeaderFooterMenu 4b This sub-menu includes commands to add and remove page headers and footers.
14 .uno%3AInsertEndnote 41 Insert a endnote at the current cursor position without a prompt.
1a .uno%3AInsertFootnotesMenu 67 The menu contains commands to insert a footnote or endnote with or without additional user interaction.
15 .uno%3AInsertFootnote 42 Insert a footnote at the current cursor position without a prompt.
1a .uno%3AInsertFrameInteract 3a Insert a frame by drawing its shape with the mouse cursor.
16 .uno%3AInsertFrameMenu 57 This sub-menu contains both interactive and non-interactive means of inserting a frame.
1f .uno%3AMailMergeCreateDocuments 49 Creates a single merged document with page breaks between each recipient.
19 .uno%3AMailMergePrevEntry 3d Use the browse buttons to scroll through the address records.
1c .uno%3AMailMergeCurrentEntry 64 Enter the address record number of a recipient to preview the mail merge document for the recipient.
19 .uno%3AMailMergeNextEntry 3d Use the browse buttons to scroll through the address records.
1c .uno%3AMailMergeExcludeEntry 34 Excludes the current recipient from this mail merge.
1a .uno%3AMailMergeFirstEntry 3d Use the browse buttons to scroll through the address records.
19 .uno%3AMailMergeLastEntry 3d Use the browse buttons to scroll through the address records.
31 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fchartdatadialog%2FSwapRow 32 Switches the current row with its neighbour below.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fchartdatadialog%2FInsertRow 28 Inserts a new row below the current row.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATA_SERIES_LABEL 20 Enter names for the data series.
12 .uno%3ADiagramData 4d Opens the Chart Data Table dialogue box in which you can edit the chart data.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fchartdatadialog%2FSwapColumn 3c Switches the current column with its neighbour to the right.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fchartdatadialog%2FRemoveColumn 5e Deletes the current series or text column. It is not possible to delete the first text column.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fchartdatadialog%2FInsertColumn 33 Inserts a new data series after the current column.
3a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fchartdatadialog%2FInsertTextColumn 56 Inserts a new text column after the current column for hierarchical axes descriptions.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fchartdatadialog%2FRemoveRow 44 Deletes the current row. It is not possible to delete the label row.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finserttitledlg%2FsecondaryYaxis 3e Enter the desired secondary title for the y-axis of the chart.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finserttitledlg%2FsecondaryXaxis 3e Enter the desired secondary title for the x-axis of the chart.
17 .uno%3AInsertMenuTitles 3e Opens a dialogue box to enter or modify the titles in a chart.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finserttitledlg%2Fmaintitle 26 Enter the desired title for the chart.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finserttitledlg%2FprimaryYaxis 34 Enter the desired title for the y-axis of the chart.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finserttitledlg%2FprimaryZaxis 34 Enter the desired title for the z-axis of the chart.
31 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finserttitledlg%2Fsubtitle 29 Enter the desired subtitle for the chart.
3a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finserttitledlg%2FInsertTitleDialog 3e Opens a dialogue box to enter or modify the titles in a chart.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finserttitledlg%2FprimaryXaxis 34 Enter the desired title for the x-axis of the chart.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_LegendPosition%2FLB_LEGEND_TEXTDIR 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_LegendPosition%2Fbottom 30 Positions the legend at the bottom of the chart.
13 .uno%3AToggleLegend 44 To show or hide a legend, click Legend On/Off on the Formatting bar.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Fshow 34 Specifies whether to display a legend for the chart.
17 .uno%3AInsertMenuLegend 8f Opens the Legend dialogue box, which allows you to change the position of legends in the chart, and to specify whether the legend is displayed.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_LegendPosition%2Fleft 2e Positions the legend at the left of the chart.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_LegendPosition%2Ftop 2d Positions the legend at the top of the chart.
31 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_LegendPosition%2Fright 2f Positions the legend at the right of the chart.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_DataLabel%2FCT_DIAL 42 Click in the dial to set the text orientation for the data labels.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_DataLabel%2FNF_LABEL_DEGREES 3e Enter the counterclockwise rotation angle for the data labels.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FCB_VALUE_AS_NUMBER 30 Displays the absolute values of the data points.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FPB_NUMBERFORMAT 31 Opens a dialogue box to select the number format.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_DataLabel%2FPB_NUMBERFORMAT 31 Opens a dialogue box to select the number format.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuDataLabels 4d Opens the Data Labels dialogue box, which enables you to set the data labels.
3e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FPB_PERCENT_NUMBERFORMAT 35 Opens a dialogue box to select the percentage format.
3f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_DataLabel%2FPB_PERCENT_NUMBERFORMAT 35 Opens a dialogue box to select the percentage format.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FCB_CATEGORY 21 Shows the data point text labels.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FCB_SYMBOL 38 Displays the legend icons next to each data point label.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FLB_TEXT_SEPARATOR 48 Selects the separator between multiple text strings for the same object.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_DataLabel%2FLB_LABEL_TEXTDIR 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_DataLabel%2FLB_TEXT_SEPARATOR 48 Selects the separator between multiple text strings for the same object.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FCB_VALUE_AS_PERCENTAGE 3a Displays the percentage of the data points in each column.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FCT_DIAL 42 Click in the dial to set the text orientation for the data labels.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FLB_LABEL_PLACEMENT 3d Selects the placement of data labels relative to the objects.
3d %2Fmodules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_DataLabel%2FLB_LABEL_PLACEMENT 3d Selects the placement of data labels relative to the objects.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FNF_LABEL_DEGREES 3e Enter the counterclockwise rotation angle for the data labels.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataLabel%2FLB_LABEL_TEXTDIR 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FsecondaryX 29 Displays a secondary x-axis in the chart.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FprimaryY 30 Displays the y-axis as a line with subdivisions.
15 .uno%3AInsertMenuAxes 30 Specifies the axes to be displayed in the chart.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FsecondaryY 87 The major axis and the secondary axis can have different scaling. For example, you can scale one axis to 2 cm. and the other to 1.5 cm.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FprimaryZ 30 Displays the z-axis as a line with subdivisions.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FprimaryX 30 Displays the x-axis as a line with subdivisions.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FRB_NEGATIVE 1f Shows only negative error bars.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FRB_BOTH 27 Shows positive and negative error bars.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FRB_BOTH 27 Shows positive and negative error bars.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FCB_SYN_POS_NEG bf Enable to use the positive error values also as negative error values. You can only change the value of the "Positive (+)" box. That value gets copied to the "Negative (-)" box automatically.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FED_RANGE_POSITIVE 7f Enter the address range from where to obtain the positive error values. Use the Shrink button to select the range from a sheet.
3f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FED_RANGE_POSITIVE 7f Enter the address range from where to obtain the positive error values. Use the Shrink button to select the range from a sheet.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FMF_NEGATIVE 51 Enter the value to subtract from the displayed value as the negative error value.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FMF_POSITIVE 4a Enter the value to add to the displayed value as the positive error value.
3f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FIB_RANGE_NEGATIVE ab Click a button to shrink the dialogue box, then use the mouse to select the cell range in the spreadsheet. Click the button again to restore the dialogue box to full size.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FED_RANGE_NEGATIVE 7f Enter the address range from where to obtain the negative error values. Use the Shrink button to select the range from a sheet.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FIB_RANGE_POSITIVE ab Click a button to shrink the dialogue box, then use the mouse to select the cell range in the spreadsheet. Click the button again to restore the dialogue box to full size.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FRB_CONST 41 Displays constant values that you specify in the Parameters area.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FMF_POSITIVE 4a Enter the value to add to the displayed value as the positive error value.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FRB_PERCENT 75 Displays a percentage. The display refers to the corresponding data point. Set the percentage in the Parameters area.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FRB_NONE 1d Does not show any error bars.
3f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FED_RANGE_NEGATIVE 7f Enter the address range from where to obtain the negative error values. Use the Shrink button to select the range from a sheet.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FRB_RANGE 6d Click Cell Range and then specify a cell range from which to take the positive and negative error bar values.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FRB_POSITIVE 1f Shows only positive error bars.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FMF_NEGATIVE 51 Enter the value to subtract from the displayed value as the negative error value.
1f CHART2_SCH_ERROR_BARS_FROM_DATA d4 For a chart with its own data, the error bar values can be entered in the chart data table. The Data Table dialogue box shows additional columns titled Positive x- or y-Error-Bars and Negative x- or y-Error-Bars.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FRB_NONE 1d Does not show any error bars.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2Ftp_ErrorBars 4d Use the x- or y-Error Bars dialogue box to display error bars for 2-D charts.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuYErrorBars 4d Use the x- or y-Error Bars dialogue box to display error bars for 2-D charts.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FRB_NEGATIVE 1f Shows only negative error bars.
3c modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FCB_SYN_POS_NEG bf Enable to use the positive error values also as negative error values. You can only change the value of the "Positive (+)" box. That value gets copied to the "Negative (-)" box automatically.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FIB_RANGE_NEGATIVE ab Click a button to shrink the dialogue box, then use the mouse to select the cell range in the spreadsheet. Click the button again to restore the dialogue box to full size.
3f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FIB_RANGE_POSITIVE ab Click a button to shrink the dialogue box, then use the mouse to select the cell range in the spreadsheet. Click the button again to restore the dialogue box to full size.
41 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars 4d Use the x- or y-Error Bars dialogue box to display error bars for 2-D charts.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FRB_POSITIVE 1f Shows only positive error bars.
31 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FRB_PERCENT 75 Displays a percentage. The display refers to the corresponding data point. Set the percentage in the Parameters area.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FLB_FUNCTION 2e Select a function to calculate the error bars.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FRB_CONST 41 Displays constant values that you specify in the Parameters area.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FRB_RANGE 6d Click Cell Range and then specify a cell range from which to take the positive and negative error bar values.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fdlg_InsertErrorBars%2FRB_FUNCTION 2e Select a function to calculate the error bars.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FRB_FUNCTION 2e Select a function to calculate the error bars.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ErrorBars%2FLB_FUNCTION 2e Select a function to calculate the error bars.
23 .uno%3AInsertTrendlineEquationAndR2 91 To show the trend line equation, select the trend line in the chart, right-click to open the context menu, and choose Insert Trend Line Equation.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuMeanValues 91 To show the trend line equation, select the trend line in the chart, right-click to open the context menu, and choose Insert Trend Line Equation.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flabel9 2a Name of y variable in trend line equation.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flabel6 2a Name of x variable in trend line equation.
41 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2FshowCorrelationCoefficient 3e Shows the coefficient of determination next to the trend line.
2c modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Fpower 1c A power trend line is shown.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flogarithmic 22 A logarithmic trend line is shown.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flinear 1d A linear trend line is shown.
31 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Fpolynomial 35 A polynomial trend line is shown with a given degree.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flabel8 2e Trend line is extrapolated for lower x-values.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuTrendlines 50 Trend lines can be added to all 2-D chart types except for Pie and Stock charts.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2FinterceptValue 23 Value of intercept if it is forced.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flabel3 20 Degree of polynomial trend line.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Fexponential 23 An exponential trend line is shown.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2FTP_TRENDLINE 50 Trend lines can be added to all 2-D chart types except for Pie and Stock charts.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2FmovingAverage 39 A moving average trend line is shown with a given period.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flabel4 43 Number of points to calculate average of moving average trend line.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flabel5 1d Name of trend line in legend.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flabel7 2f Trend line is extrapolated for higher x-values.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2FsetIntercept 5f For linear, polynomial and exponential trend lines, intercept value is forced to a given value.
1e .uno%3AInsertTrendlineEquation 91 To show the trend line equation, select the trend line in the chart, right-click to open the context menu, and choose Insert Trend Line Equation.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2FshowEquation 35 Shows the trend line equation next to the trend line.
3a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FRB_CONTINUE_LINE 7a For a missing value, the interpolation from the neighbouring values will be shown. This is the default for chart type X-Y.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FRB_DONT_PAINT 67 For a missing value, no data will be shown. This is the default for chart types Column, Bar, Line, Net.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_PolarOptions%2FCT_ANGLE_DIAL 154 Drag the small dot along the circle or click any position on the circle to set the starting angle of a pie or doughnut chart. The starting angle is the mathematical angle position where the first piece is drawn. The value of 90 degrees draws the first piece at the 12 o'clock position. A value of 0 degrees starts at the 3 o'clock position.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_PolarOptions%2FCB_CLOCKWISE af The default direction in which the pieces of a pie chart are ordered is counter-clockwise. Mark the Clockwise direction check box to draw the pieces in the opposite direction.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FRBT_OPT_AXIS_2 89 Changes the scaling of the y-axis. This axis is only visible when at least one data series is assigned to it and the axis view is active.
41 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FCB_INCLUDE_HIDDEN_CELLS 5f Mark this check box to also show values of currently hidden cells within the source cell range.
3b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_PolarOptions%2FNF_STARTING_ANGLE 74 Enter the starting angle in the range 0 to 359 degrees. You can also click the arrows to change the displayed value.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FMT_GAP 33 Defines the spacing between the columns in percent.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FMT_OVERLAP 3b Defines the necessary settings for overlapping data series.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FRB_ASSUME_ZERO 60 For a missing value, the y-value will be shown as zero. This is the default for chart type Area.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FCB_CONNECTOR 8b For "stacked" and "percent" column (vertical bar) charts, mark this check box to connect the column layers that belong together with lines.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FRBT_OPT_AXIS_1 54 This option is active as default. All data series are aligned to the primary y-axis.
3e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FCB_BARS_SIDE_BY_SIDE 58 The bars from different data series are shown as if they were attached only to one axis.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FsecondaryY 40 Adds grid lines that subdivide the y-axis into smaller sections.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FprimaryZ 2b Adds grid lines to the z-axis of the chart.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FInsertGridDialog ae You can divide the axes into sections by assigning grid lines to them. This allows you to get a better overview of the chart, especially if you are working with large charts.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FprimaryX 2b Adds grid lines to the x-axis of the chart.
19 .uno%3AToggleGridVertical 68 The Vertical Grids icon on the Formatting bar toggles the visibility of the grid display for the x-axis.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FsecondaryZ 40 Adds grid lines that subdivide the z-axis into smaller sections.
16 .uno%3AInsertMenuGrids ae You can divide the axes into sections by assigning grid lines to them. This allows you to get a better overview of the chart, especially if you are working with large charts.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FprimaryY 2b Adds grid lines to the y-axis of the chart.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FsecondaryX 40 Adds grid lines that subdivide the x-axis into smaller sections.
1b .uno%3AToggleGridHorizontal 6a The Horizontal Grids icon on the Formatting bar toggles the visibility of the grid display for the y-axis.
16 .uno%3AFormatSelection 1c Formats the selected object.
d .uno%3AZTitle 2e Modifies the properties of the selected title.
d .uno%3AYTitle 57 Modifies the properties of the selected title or the properties of all titles together.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftitlerotationtabpage%2FtextdirLB 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
2b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2Feven 41 Stagger numbers on the axes, odd numbers lower than even numbers.
2b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2Fauto 2b Automatically arranges numbers on the axis.
2b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2Ftile 2a Arranges numbers on the axis side by side.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FbreakCB 14 Allows a text break.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FoverlapCB 39 Specifies that the text in cells may overlap other cells.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FshowlabelsCB 32 Specifies whether to show or hide the axis labels.
2a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2Fodd 42 Staggers numbers on the axis, even numbers lower than odd numbers.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftitlerotationtabpage%2FdialCtrl 45 Clicking anywhere on the wheel defines the variable text orientation.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FtextdirLB 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftitlerotationtabpage%2FstackedCB 33 Assigns vertical text orientation for cell content.
16 .uno%3AToggleAxisDescr 2b Defines the text direction of cell content.
3b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftitlerotationtabpage%2FOrientDegree 33 Allows you to manually enter the orientation angle.
d .uno%3ALegend 3f Defines the border, area and character attributes for a legend.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisB 98 Opens a dialogue box in which you can edit the properties of the secondary y-axis. To insert a secondary y-axis, choose Insert - Axes and select y-Axis.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisA 98 Opens a dialogue box in which you can edit the properties of the secondary x-axis. To insert a secondary x-axis, choose Insert - Axes and select x-Axis.
15 .uno%3ADiagramAxisAll 50 Opens a dialogue box, in which you can edit the properties of the selected axis.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisY 41 Opens the y-Axis dialogue box to change properties of the y-axis.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FLB_MAIN_TIME_UNIT 4d Major interval can be set to show a certain number of days, months, or years.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FMT_MAIN_DATE_STEP 4d Major interval can be set to show a certain number of days, months, or years.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FLB_TIME_RESOLUTION 47 Resolution can be set to show days, months, or years as interval steps.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FLB_AXIS_TYPE 6e For some types of axes, you can select to format an axis as text or date, or to detect the type automatically.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_REVERSE 80 Defines where the lower and where the higher values are displayed at the axis. The unmarked state is the mathematical direction.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_LOGARITHM 42 Specifies that you want the axis to be subdivided logarithmically.
2a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FEDT_MIN 38 Defines the minimum value for the beginning of the axis.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FEDT_STEP_MAIN 37 Defines the interval for the main division of the axes.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FMT_STEPHELP 35 Defines the interval for the subdivision of the axes.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FEDT_ORIGIN 41 Specifies at which position to display the values along the axis.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FLB_HELP_TIME_UNIT 4d Minor interval can be set to show a certain number of days, months, or years.
2a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FEDT_MAX 32 Defines the maximum value for the end of the axis.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_AUTO_ORIGIN 49 You must first unmark the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_AxisPositions%2FLB_PLACE_TICKS 4b Select where to place the marks: at labels, at axis, or at axis and labels.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_AxisPositions%2FCB_MINOR_OUTER 4d Specifies that minor interval marks are placed on the outer side of the axis.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_AxisPositions%2FCB_MINOR_INNER 4d Specifies that minor interval marks are placed on the inner side of the axis.
44 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_AxisPositions%2FEDT_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT 40 Enter the value where the axis line should cross the other axis.
3a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_AxisPositions%2FLB_PLACE_LABELS 63 Select where to place the labels: near axis, near axis (other side), outside start, or outside end.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_AxisPositions%2FCB_TICKS_OUTER 3e Specifies that marks are placed on the outer side of the axis.
43 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_AxisPositions%2FLB_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT 5f Select where to cross the other axis: at start, at end, at a specified value, or at a category.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_AxisPositions%2FCB_TICKS_INNER 3e Specifies that marks are placed on the inner side of the axis.
4d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_AxisPositions%2FEDT_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT_CATEGORY 44 Select the category where the axis line should cross the other axis.
15 .uno%3ADiagramGridAll 39 Opens the Grid dialogue box for defining grid properties.
12 .uno%3ADiagramWall ab Opens the Chart Wall dialogue box, in which you can modify the properties of the chart wall. The chart wall is the "vertical" background behind the data area of the chart.
13 .uno%3ADiagramFloor bf Opens the Chart Floor dialogue box, in which you can modify the properties of the chart floor. The chart floor is the lower area in 3-D charts. This function is only available for 3-D charts.
12 .uno%3ADiagramArea 9f Opens the Chart Area dialogue box, in which you can modify the properties of the chart area. The chart area is the background behind all elements of the chart.
f .uno%3ABackward 37 Sends the selected data series backwards (to the left).
e .uno%3AForward 38 Brings the selected data series forwards (to the right).
3e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsmoothlinesdlg%2FPolynomialsSpinButton 22 Set the degree of the polynomials.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsmoothlinesdlg%2FResolutionSpinbutton 13 Set the resolution.
3a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsmoothlinesdlg%2FSmoothLinesDialog 19 Apply a line curve model.
3b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsmoothlinesdlg%2FSplineTypeComboBox 19 Apply a line curve model.
3a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsteppedlinesdlg%2Fstep_center_y_rb 7f Start to step up vertically to the middle of the y-values, draw a horizontal line and finish by stepping vertically to the end.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsteppedlinesdlg%2Fstep_end_rb 6a Start with horizontal line, step up vertically in the middle of the X values and end with horizontal line.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsteppedlinesdlg%2Fstep_start_rb 3d Start with horizontal line and step up vertically at the end.
3a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsteppedlinesdlg%2Fstep_center_x_rb 39 Start to step up vertically and end with horizontal line.
43 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FBTN_AMBIENT_COLOR 2e Select a colour using the colour dialogue box.
47 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FBTN_LIGHTSOURCE_COLOR 2e Select a colour using the colour dialogue box.
40 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FLB_LIGHTSOURCE 2e Select a colour for the selected light source.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FBTN_LIGHT_8 34 Click to enable or disable the uniform light source.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FBTN_LIGHT_7 34 Click to enable or disable the uniform light source.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FBTN_LIGHT_6 34 Click to enable or disable the uniform light source.
41 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FLB_AMBIENTLIGHT 26 Select a colour for the ambient light.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FBTN_LIGHT_4 34 Click to enable or disable the uniform light source.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FBTN_LIGHT_5 34 Click to enable or disable the uniform light source.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FBTN_LIGHT_2 34 Click to enable or disable the uniform light source.
40 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneGeometry%2FMTR_FLD_Z_ROTATION 57 Sets the rotation of the chart on the z-axis. The preview responds to the new settings.
16 SVX_HID_CTRL3D_HSCROLL 61 Drag the bottom slider to set the horizontal position and direction of the selected light source.
d .uno%3AView3D a7 Opens a dialogue box to edit the properties of a three dimensional view for Column, Bar, Pie, and Area charts. For Line and X-Y (Scatter) charts you can see 3-D lines.
3e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneAppearance%2FCB_ROUNDEDEDGE 18 Edges are rounded by 5%.
39 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneAppearance%2FLB_SCHEME 48 Select a scheme from the list box, or mark any of the check boxes below.
43 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneGeometry%2FCBX_RIGHT_ANGLED_AXES 106 If Right-angled axes is enabled, you can rotate the chart contents only in x- and y-direction, that is, parallel to the chart borders. Right-angled axes is enabled by default for newly created 3-D charts. Pie and Doughnut charts do not support right-angled axes.
41 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneGeometry%2FMTR_FLD_PERSPECTIVE bc Mark the Perspective box to view the chart as through a camera lens. Use the spin button to set the percentage. With a high percentage nearer objects look bigger than more distant objects.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FBTN_LIGHT_3 34 Click to enable or disable the uniform light source.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneGeometry%2FCBX_PERSPECTIVE bc Mark the Perspective box to view the chart as through a camera lens. Use the spin button to set the percentage. With a high percentage nearer objects look bigger than more distant objects.
40 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneGeometry%2FMTR_FLD_Y_ROTATION 57 Sets the rotation of the chart on the y-axis. The preview responds to the new settings.
3a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneAppearance%2FCB_SHADING 3f Applies Gouraud shading if marked, or flat shading if unmarked.
16 SVX_HID_CTRL3D_VSCROLL 5c Drag the right slider to set the vertical height and direction of the selected light source.
40 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneGeometry%2FMTR_FLD_X_ROTATION 57 Sets the rotation of the chart on the x-axis. The preview responds to the new settings.
3e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneAppearance%2FCB_OBJECTLINES 42 Shows borders around the areas by setting the line style to Solid.
17 SVX_HID_CTRL3D_SWITCHER 44 Click to switch between an illumination model of a sphere or a cube.
49 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination 27 Set the light sources for the 3-D view.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_3D_SceneIllumination%2FBTN_LIGHT_1 45 Click to enable or disable the specular light source with highlights.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2FsecondaryXaxis 71 Enter a label for the secondary y-axis. This option is only available for charts that support a secondary y-axis.
2b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Fy 39 Displays grid lines that are perpendicular to the y-axis.
2b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Fx 39 Displays grid lines that are perpendicular to the x-axis.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Fbottom 30 Positions the legend to the bottom of the chart.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Fright 2f Positions the legend to the right of the chart.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Fsubtitle 20 Enter a subtitle for your chart.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2FprimaryXaxis 2a Enter a label for the x-axis (horizontal).
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Ftop 2d Positions the legend to the top of the chart.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Fmaintitle 1d Enter a title for your chart.
2b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Fz 75 Displays grid lines that are perpendicular to the z-axis. This option is only available for three-dimensional charts.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2FprimaryYaxis 28 Enter a label for the y-axis (vertical).
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Fshow 20 Displays a legend in your chart.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2Fleft 2e Positions the legend to the left of the chart.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fwizelementspage%2FprimaryZaxis 59 Enter a label for the z-axis. This option is only available for three-dimensional charts.
12 .uno%3ADiagramType 22 Opens the Chart Type dialogue box.
2b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Fsort 6b Connects points by ascending x-values, even if the order of values is different, in an X-Y scatter diagram.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Flinetype 20 Choose the type of line to draw.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Fpercent 27 Stack series display values as percent.
31 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Fproperties 39 Opens a dialogue box to set the line or curve properties.
2c modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Fontop 31 Stack series display values on top of each other.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Fnolines 3b Set the number of lines for the Column and Line chart type.
2c modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Fstack 28 Displays stacked series for Line charts.
2c modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Fshape 1d Select a shape from the list.
1d CHART2_HID_SCH_WIZARD_ROADMAP 25 Click to go to the named wizard page.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2F3dscheme 1c Select the type of 3-D look.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Ftp_ChartType 25 Click to go to the named wizard page.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2F3dlook 27 Enables a 3-D look for the data values.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Fcharttype 1a Select a basic chart type.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_ChartType%2Fsubtype 2a Select a sub-type of the basic chart type.
42 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_RangeChooser%2FCB_FIRST_COLUMN_ASLABELS 119 For data series in columns: The first column in the range is used as names for data series. For data series in rows: The first column in the range is used as categories. The remaining columns comprise the data columns. If this check box is not marked, all columns are data columns.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_RangeChooser%2FED_RANGE a7 Enter the data range that you want to include in your chart. To minimise this dialogue box while you select the data range in Calc, click the Select data range button.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_RangeChooser%2FIB_RANGE a7 Enter the data range that you want to include in your chart. To minimise this dialogue box while you select the data range in Calc, click the Select data range button.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_RangeChooser%2FRB_DATACOLS df Data series obtain their data from consecutive columns in the selected range. For scatter charts, the first data column will contain x-values for all series. All other data columns are used as y-values, one for each series.
3f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_RangeChooser%2FCB_FIRST_ROW_ASLABELS 10b For data series in columns: The first row in the range is used as names for data series. For data series in rows: The first row in the range is used as categories. The remaining rows comprise the data series. If this check box is not marked, all rows are data series.
11 .uno%3ADataRanges 54 Opens the Data Ranges dialogue box in which you can edit Data Range and Data Series.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_RangeChooser%2FRB_DATAROWS db Data series obtain their data from consecutive rows in the selected range. For scatter charts, the first data series will contain x-values for all series. All other data series are used as y-values, one for each series.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2FBTN_DOWN 36 Moves down the selected entry in the Data Series list.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2FBTN_REMOVE 35 Removes the selected entry from the Data Series list.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2FBTN_ADD 88 Adds a new entry below the current entry in the Data Series list. If an entry is selected, the new data series gets the same chart type.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2FIMB_RANGE_CAT 157 Shows the source range address of the categories (the text strings that you can see on the x-axis of a category chart). For an X-Y chart, the text box contains the source range of the data labels which are displayed for the data points. To minimise this dialogue box while you select the data range in Calc, click the Select data range button.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2FIMB_RANGE_MAIN 105 Shows the source range address from the second column of the Data Range list box. You can change the range in the text box or by dragging in the document. To minimise this dialogue box while you select the data range in Calc, click the Select data range button.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2Ftp_DataSource a8 Shows a list of all data series in the chart. Click an entry to view and edit that data series. Click Add to insert a new series into the list after the selected entry.
31 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2FLB_SERIES a8 Shows a list of all data series in the chart. Click an entry to view and edit that data series. Click Add to insert a new series into the list after the selected entry.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2FLB_ROLE a1 Shows all the data ranges used by the data series that is selected in the Data Series list box. Each data range shows the role name and the source range address.
31 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2FEDT_RANGE 105 Shows the source range address from the second column of the Data Range list box. You can change the range in the text box or by dragging in the document. To minimise this dialogue box while you select the data range in Calc, click the Select data range button.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2FBTN_UP 34 Moves up the selected entry in the Data Series list.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_DataSource%2FEDT_CATEGORIES 157 Shows the source range address of the categories (the text strings that you can see on the x-axis of a category chart). For an X-Y chart, the text box contains the source range of the data labels which are displayed for the data points. To minimise this dialogue box while you select the data range in Calc, click the Select data range button.
11 .uno%3ADataInRows 2a Changes the arrangement of the chart data.
14 .uno%3ADataInColumns 2a Changes the arrangement of the chart data.
10 .uno%3AScaleText 45 Rescales the text in the chart when you change the size of the chart.
15 .uno%3ANewArrangement b6 Moves all chart elements to their default positions inside the current chart. This function does not alter the chart type or any other attributes other than the position of elements.
12 .uno%3AContextType 2c Displays the name of the current chart type.
15 .uno%3AResetDataPoint 31 Resets the selected data point to default format.
17 .uno%3ADeleteYErrorBars 19 Deletes the y-error bars.
16 .uno%3ADeleteDataLabel 20 Deletes the selected data label.
1e .uno%3ADeleteTrendlineEquation 1f Deletes the trendline equation.
17 .uno%3ADeleteDataLabels 18 Deletes all data labels.
16 .uno%3AFormatStockGain 22 Formats the stock gain indicators.
19 .uno%3AResetAllDataPoints 29 Resets all data points to default format.
16 .uno%3ADeleteMinorGrid 17 Deletes the minor grid.
18 .uno%3AInsertObjectChart 10b Creates a chart in the current document. To use a continuous range of cells as the data source for your chart, click inside the cell range, and then choose this command. Alternatively, select some cells and choose this command to create a chart of the selected cells.
17 .uno%3AInsertDataLabels 14 Inserts data labels.
17 .uno%3AFormatDataSeries 18 Formats the data series.
16 .uno%3AFormatMinorGrid 17 Formats the minor grid.
13 .uno%3ADeleteLegend 19 Deletes the chart legend.
16 .uno%3AFormatMajorGrid 17 Formats the major grid.
16 .uno%3AFormatDataPoint 20 Formats the selected data point.
14 .uno%3AInsertR2Value 33 Inserts the coefficient of determination R² value.
11 .uno%3AFormatWall 17 Formats the chart wall.
13 .uno%3AFormatLegend 19 Formats the chart legend.
10 .uno%3ADrawChart 10b Creates a chart in the current document. To use a continuous range of cells as the data source for your chart, click inside the cell range, and then choose this command. Alternatively, select some cells and choose this command to create a chart of the selected cells.
16 .uno%3AFormatChartArea 17 Formats the chart area.
14 .uno%3ADeleteR2Value 16 Deletes the R² value.
12 .uno%3AFormatFloor 18 Formats the chart floor.
12 .uno%3AFormatTitle 1b Formats the selected title.
11 .uno%3AFormatAxis 1a Formats the selected axis.
13 .uno%3AInsertTitles 2c Opens a dialogue box to insert chart titles.
16 .uno%3AInsertMajorGrid 15 Inserts a major grid.
16 .uno%3AFormatDataLabel 20 Formats the selected data label.
16 .uno%3AStarChartDialog 10b Creates a chart in the current document. To use a continuous range of cells as the data source for your chart, click inside the cell range, and then choose this command. Alternatively, select some cells and choose this command to create a chart of the selected cells.
13 SW_HID_INSERT_CHART 10b Creates a chart in the current document. To use a continuous range of cells as the data source for your chart, click inside the cell range, and then choose this command. Alternatively, select some cells and choose this command to create a chart of the selected cells.
17 .uno%3AFormatDataLabels 18 Formats the data labels.
16 .uno%3AFormatMeanValue 1c Formats the mean value line.
16 .uno%3AFormatStockLoss 22 Formats the stock loss indicators.
17 .uno%3AFormatYErrorBars 19 Formats the y-error bars.
1e .uno%3AFormatTrendlineEquation 1f Formats the trendline equation.
16 .uno%3AFormatTrendline 16 Formats the trendline.
17 .uno%3AInsertRemoveAxes 2e Opens a dialogue box to insert or delete axes.
16 .uno%3AInsertAxisTitle 2d Opens a dialogue box to insert an axis title.
11 .uno%3AInsertAxis 27 Opens a dialogue box to insert an axis.
16 .uno%3ADeleteMeanValue 1c Deletes the mean value line.
16 .uno%3ADeleteMajorGrid 17 Deletes the major grid.
16 .uno%3AInsertMinorGrid 15 Inserts a minor grid.
23 .uno%3AInsertTrendlineEquationAndR2 48 Inserts the trendline equation and the coefficient of determination R².
16 .uno%3AInsertDataLabel 1c Inserts a single data label.
11 .uno%3ADeleteAxis 1a Deletes the selected axis.
1b .uno%3AChartElementSelector bf Select the element from the chart that you want to format. The element gets selected in the chart preview. Click Format Selection to open the properties dialogue box for the selected element.
17 HID_TABDLG_STANDARD_BTN 74 Click the Options label to expand the dialogue box to show further options. Click again to restore the dialogue box.
14 HID_TABDLG_RESET_BTN 32 Resets modified values back to the default values.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fautocorrectdialog%2Fok 2a Saves all changes and closes dialogue box.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fautocorrectdialog%2Fcancel 2d Closes dialogue box and discards all changes.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_LISTWIZARD_NEXT a4 Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialogue box settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_GROUPWIZARD_NEXT a4 Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialogue box settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
11 WIZARDS_HID0_NEXT a4 Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialogue box settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
1c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_NEXT a4 Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialogue box settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDNEXT a4 Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialogue box settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
17 SVX_HID_GALLERY_PREVIEW 2c Displays a preview of the current selection.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDNEXT a4 Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialogue box settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
3b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fdefinedatabaserangedialog%2Fassignrb 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fmanagenamesdialog%2Fassign 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
17 DBACCESS_HID_DBWIZ_NEXT a4 Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialogue box settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
39 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconditionalformatdialog%2Frbassign 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconsolidatedialog%2Frbdestarea 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconsolidatedialog%2Frbdataarea 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fnamerangesdialog%2Frbassign2 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fnamerangesdialog%2Frbassign 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
3a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fadvancedfilterdialog%2Frbfilterarea 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fgoalseekdlg%2Fformulabutton 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
3d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fmultipleoperationsdialog%2Fformulasref 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
42 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpivottablelayoutdialog%2Fdestination-button 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fprintareasdialog%2Frbrepeatrow 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
15 SW_HID_MD_GLOS_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fmanagenamesdialog%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
38 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fmultipleoperationsdialog%2Frowref 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
1e WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CANCEL 46 Clicking Cancel closes a dialogue box without saving any changes made.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FBTN_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconsolidatedialog%2Fdelete 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fautocorrectdialog%2Freset 3c Resets modified values back to the tab page previous values.
1e WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CREATE 2a Applies all changes and closes the wizard.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fmultipathdialog%2Fdelete 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fautoformattable%2Fremove 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_0_CMDCANCEL 46 Clicking Cancel closes a dialogue box without saving any changes made.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_LISTWIZARD_CANCEL 46 Clicking Cancel closes a dialogue box without saving any changes made.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CMDCANCEL 46 Clicking Cancel closes a dialogue box without saving any changes made.
1a ui%2Fgradientpage%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDCANCEL 46 Clicking Cancel closes a dialogue box without saving any changes made.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fnamerangesdialog%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
1e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDFINISH 2a Applies all changes and closes the wizard.
2e modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fdialogpage%2Flibrary 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
1b CUI_HID_MEASURE_CTL_PREVIEW 2c Displays a preview of the current selection.
1e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDCANCEL 46 Clicking Cancel closes a dialogue box without saving any changes made.
38 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fadvancedfilterdialog%2Frbcopyarea 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_GROUPWIZARD_CANCEL 46 Clicking Cancel closes a dialogue box without saving any changes made.
2d modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fcatalogdialog%2Finsert 49 Applies the modified or selected values without closing the dialogue box.
13 WIZARDS_HID0_CANCEL 46 Clicking Cancel closes a dialogue box without saving any changes made.
1c WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_CANCEL 46 Clicking Cancel closes a dialogue box without saving any changes made.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
33 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomslideshows%2Fdelete 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fprintareasdialog%2Frbprintarea 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fgoalseekdlg%2Fvarbutton 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
39 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fdefinedatabaserangedialog%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
23 hid%2Fcui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FBTN_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FbuttonBTN_DEL 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fselectpathdialog%2Fdelete 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
23 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Fdelete 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
38 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fmultipleoperationsdialog%2Fcolref 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
2c modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fmacropage%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fprintareasdialog%2Frbrepeatcol 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fdeldouble 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
2a modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Flibpage%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FBTN_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptionsdialog%2Frevert 40 Resets modified values back to the $[officename] default values.
38 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Frbcopyarea 105 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialogue box to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximise icon. Click it to restore the dialogue box to its original size.
2a sw%3APushButton%3ADLG_BIB_BASE%3APB_DELETE 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fdelabbrev 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fgalleryupdateprogress%2FGalleryUpdateProgress 39 Updates the view in the window or in the selected object.
19 HID_GALLERY_MN_BACKGROUND 35 Inserts the selected picture as a background graphic.
1f SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_OPEN_OBJECT 3f Use the Open command to open the selected object in a new task.
19 SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_PASTE 46 Inserts the element that you moved to the clipboard into the document.
1b SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_DESTROY a0 Deletes the current selection. If multiple objects are selected, all will be deleted. In most cases, a confirmation question appears before objects are deleted.
18 SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_COPY 2d Copies the selected element to the clipboard.
1a SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_RENAME 28 Enables a selected object to be renamed.
17 HID_DID_SAVE_PACKED_XML 50 By default, $[officename] loads and saves files in the OpenDocument file format.
11 .uno%3AActiveHelp 53 Enables the display of a brief description of menus and icons at the mouse pointer.
e .uno%3AHelpTip 4f Enables the display of icon names at the mouse pointer and other Help contents.
27 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcompressnone 32 Specifies that you do not wish to use compression.
23 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcolor1rb 1b Exports the file in colour.
23 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Flevel2rb 74 Select the Level 2 option if your output device supports coloured bitmaps, palette graphics and compressed graphics.
27 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcolordepthlb 43 Select the colour depth from 8 bit greyscale or 24 bit true colour.
28 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Ftiffpreviewcb 6a Specifies whether a preview image is exported in the TIFF format together with the actual PostScript file.
2e svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fresolutionmf-nospin 4b Enter the image resolution. Select the measurement units from the list box.
2a svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fheightmf-nospin 15 Specifies the height.
29 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fwidthmf-nospin 20 Specifies the measurement units.
22 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fwidthlb 14 Specifies the width.
23 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcolor2rb 24 Exports the file in greyscale tones.
27 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fresolutionlb 4b Enter the image resolution. Select the measurement units from the list box.
2b svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcompressionjpgnf 79 Sets the quality for the export. Choose from a low quality with minimal file size, up to a high quality and big file size
20 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Frlecb 36 Applies RLE (Run Length Encoding) to the BMP graphics.
23 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fbinarycb 52 Exports the file in binary format. The resulting file is smaller than a text file.
26 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcompresslzw 66 LZW compression is the compression of a file into a smaller file using a table-based lookup algorithm.
2d svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fsavetransparencycb bc Specifies whether to save the background of the picture as transparent. Only objects will be visible in the GIF image. Use the Colour Replacer to set the transparent colour in the picture.
21 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Ftextcb 57 Exports the file in ASCII text format. The resulting file is larger than a binary file.
27 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Finterlacedcb 40 Specifies whether the graphic is to be saved in interlaced mode.
2b svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcompressionpngnf 62 Sets the compression for the export. A high compression means a smaller, but slower to load image.
28 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fepsipreviewcb b6 Specifies whether a monochrome preview graphic in EPSI format is exported together with the PostScript file. This format only contains printable characters from the 7-bit ASCII code.
23 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Flevel1rb 8c Compression is not available at this level. Select the Level 1 option if your PostScript printer does not offer the capabilities of Level 2.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fimoptdialog%2Fcharsetlist 41 Select the character set from the options used for import/export.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fimoptdialog%2Ffixedwidth 2b Exports all data fields with a fixed width.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fimoptdialog%2Fasshown bd Enabled by default, data will be saved as displayed, including applied number formats. If this check box is not marked, raw data content will be saved, as in older versions of the software.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fimoptdialog%2Fquoteall c0 Exports all text cells with leading and trailing quote characters as set in the Text delimiter box. If not checked, only those text cells get quoted that contain the Field delimiter character.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fimoptdialog%2Ftext 44 Choose or enter the text delimiter, which encloses every data field.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fimoptdialog%2Fcharsetdropdown 2c Specifies the character set for text export.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fimoptdialog%2Ffield 41 Choose or enter the field delimiter, which separates data fields.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fcolumntype 5f Choose a column in the preview window and select the data type to be applied the imported data.
3b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fdetectspecialnumbers 9e When this option is enabled, Calc will automatically detect all number formats, including special number formats such as dates, time, and scientific notation.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Ftextdelimiter 5c Select a character to delimit text data. You can can also enter a character in the text box.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fmergedelimiters 3e Combines consecutive delimiters and removes blank data fields.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fspace 30 Separates data delimited by spaces into columns.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fsemicolon 34 Separates data delimited by semicolons into columns.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Ftab 2e Separates data delimited by tabs into columns.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Finputother 88 Separates data into columns using the custom separator that you specify. Note: The custom separator must also be contained in your data.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fcharset b2 When this option is enabled, fields or cells whose values are quoted in their entirety (the first and last characters of the value equal the text delimiter) are imported as text.
3a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2FTextImportCsvDialog 2b Sets the import options for delimited data.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Ftoseparatedby 27 Select the separator used in your data.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fcomma 30 Separates data delimited by commas into columns.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Flanguage 2f Determines how the number strings are imported.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Ffromrow 35 Specifies the row where you want to start the import.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Ftofixedwidth 45 Separates fixed-width data (equal number of characters) into columns.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Fcr 34 Produces a "Carriage Return" as the paragraph break.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Fcrlf 4a Produces a "Carriage Return" and a "Linefeed". This option is the default.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Fcharset 3d Specifies the character set of the file for export or import.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Flf 2d Produces a "Linefeed" as the paragraph break.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Flanguage 78 Specifies the language of the text, if this has not already been defined. This setting is only available when importing.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Ffont 93 By setting a default font, you specify that the text should be displayed in a specific font. The default fonts can only be selected when importing.
15 HID_GALLERY_MN_DELETE 30 Deletes the selected graphic after confirmation.
16 HID_GALLERY_MN_PREVIEW 32 The Preview command displays the selected graphic.
32 cui%2Fui%2Fgallerytitledialog%2FGalleryTitleDialog 2d Assigns a title to a selected Gallery object.
17 HID_GALLERY_MN_ADD_LINK 27 Inserts the selected graphic as a link.
16 HID_GALLERY_MN_ADDMENU 42 Defines how a selected graphic object is inserted into a document.
12 HID_GALLERY_MN_ADD 49 Inserts a copy of the selected graphic object directly into the document.
1e HID_MN_READONLY_SAVEBACKGROUND 30 Allows you to save the background of a Web page.
1a HID_MN_READONLY_GRAPHICOFF 32 Sets all graphics in the document to be invisible.
1b HID_MN_READONLY_COPYGRAPHIC 2b Copies a selected graphic to the clipboard.
1b HID_MN_READONLY_LOADGRAPHIC 64 If you have deactivated the graphics display, choose the Load Graphics command to make them visible.
1b HID_MN_READONLY_SAVEGRAPHIC 43 Opens a dialogue box with which you can save the selected graphics.
18 HID_MN_READONLY_COPYLINK 36 Copies the link at the mouse pointer to the clipboard.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fgallerygeneralpage%2Fname 1f Displays the name of the theme.
b slot%3A5500 4d Creates a new document using an existing template or opens a sample document.
19 private%3Afactory%2Fsmath 34 Creates a new formula document ($[officename] Math).
28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21053 1e Creates a new XForms document.
28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21052 9c Opens the Business Cards dialogue box in which you can set the options for your business cards, and then creates a new text document ($[officename] Writer).
2f service%3Acom.sun.star.sdb.DatabaseWizardDialog 34 Opens the Database Wizard to create a database file.
19 private%3Afactory%2Fsdraw 34 Creates a new drawing document ($[officename] Draw).
28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21051 9b Opens the Labels dialogue box in which you can set the options for your labels, and then creates a new text document for the labels ($[officename] Writer).
16 HID_TBXCONTROL_FILENEW 52 Creates a new $[officename] document. Click the arrow to select the document type.
21 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%2Fweb 1c Creates a new HTML document.
d .uno%3ANewDoc 49 If you want to create a document from a template, choose New - Templates.
2c private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%2FGlobalDocument 1e Creates a new master document.
10 .uno%3AAddDirect 25 Creates a new $[officename] document.
1b private%3Afactory%2Fswriter 33 Creates a new text document ($[officename] Writer).
2b private%3Afactory%2Fsdatabase%3FInteractive 34 Opens the Database Wizard to create a database file.
19 private%3Afactory%2Fscalc 38 Creates a new spreadsheet document ($[officename] Calc).
28 private%3Afactory%2Fsimpress%3Fslot=6686 3c Creates a new presentation document ($[officename] Impress).
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeldialog%2Fok 23 Creates a new document for editing.
13 .uno%3AInsertLabels 43 Allows you to create labels. Labels are created in a text document.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Ftype eb Select the size format that you want to use. The available formats depend on the brand on what you selected in the Brand list. If you want to use a custom label format, select [User], and then click the Format tab to define the format.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Fbrand 2f Select the brand of paper that you want to use.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Fsheet 23 Prints labels on individual sheets.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Ftextview 5a Enter the text that you want to appear on the label. You can also insert a database field.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2FCardMediumPage 3f Specify the label text and choose the paper size for the label.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Faddress 66 Creates a label with your return address. Text that is currently in the Label text box is overwritten.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Fcontinuous 22 Prints labels on continuous paper.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Fdatabase 4b Select the database that you want to use as the data source for your label.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Finsert 86 Select the database field that you want, and then click the arrow to the left of this box to insert the field into the Label text box.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Ftable 55 Select the database table containing the field(s) that you want to use in your label.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsavelabeldialog%2Ftype 1d Enter or select a label type.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsavelabeldialog%2Fbrand 22 Enter or select the desired brand.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fsave 30 Saves the current label or business card format.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fcols 59 Enter the number of labels or business cards that you want to span the width of the page.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Ftop 98 Displays distance from the top edge of the page to the top of the first label or business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fhori 8b Displays the distance between the left edges of adjacent labels or business cards. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2FLabelFormatPage 1d Set paper formatting options.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fwidth 6f Displays the width for the label or the business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fheight 6c Displays the height for the label or business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fvert c8 Displays the distance between the upper edge of a label or a business card and the upper edge of the label or the business card directly below. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Frows 5a Enter the number of labels or business cards that you want to span the height of the page.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fleft a3 Displays the distance from the left edge of the page to the left edge of the first label or business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Fsetup 25 Opens the Printer Setup dialogue box.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ffloatingsync%2Fsync 71 Copies the contents of the top left label or business card to the remaining labels or business cards on the page.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Fentirepage 30 Creates a full page of labels or business cards.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Fcols 59 Enter the number of labels or business cards that you want to have in a row on your page.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2FLabelOptionsPage 6f Sets additional options for your labels or business cards, including text synchronisation and printer settings.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Fsinglelabel 31 Prints a single label or business card on a page.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Frows 58 Enter the number of rows of labels or business cards that you want to have on your page.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Fsynchronize af Allows you to edit a single label or business card and updates the contents of the remaining labels or business cards on the page when you click the Synchronise Labels button.
19 .uno%3AInsertBusinessCard 2a Design and create your own business cards.
1a HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_TYPE dd Select the size format that you want to use. The available formats depend on what you selected in the Brand list. If you want to use a custom size format, select [User], and then click the Format tab to define the format.
1b HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_BRAND 2f Select the brand of paper that you want to use.
1a HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_CONT 2a Prints business cards on continuous paper.
1b HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_SHEET 2b Prints business cards on individual sheets.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardformatpage%2Fautotext 4d Select a business card category, and then click a layout in the Content list.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardformatpage%2FCardFormatPage 2d Define the appearance of your business cards.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardformatpage%2Ftreeview 67 Select a business card category in AutoText - Section box, and then click a layout in the Content list.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fmobile 23 Enter your mobile telephone number.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Flastname2 4a Enter the surname of the person, whom you want to use as a second contact.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Furl 2c Enter the address of your Internet homepage.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Ffirstname2 4b Enter the forename of the person, whom you want to use as a second contact.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fshortname2 4b Enter the initials of the person, whom you want to use as a second contact.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fjob 23 Enter the title of your profession.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fcountry 30 Enter the name of the country in which you live.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fphone 21 Enter your home telephone number.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Furl 36 Enter the address of your company's Internet homepage.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fcompany2 21 Enter additional company details.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fslogan 21 Enter the slogan of your company.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2FBusinessDataPage a6 Contains contact information for business cards that use a layout from a 'Business Card, Work' category. Business card layouts are selected on the Business Cards tab.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fstate 3d Enter the name of the country where your business is located.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fmobile 23 Enter your mobile telephone number.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fphone 25 Enter your business telephone number.
15 HID_FILEOPEN_READONLY 21 Opens the file in read-only mode.
16 HID_FILEDLG_INSERT_BTN 4b Inserts the selected file into the current document at the cursor position.
2e fpicker%2Fui%2Fexplorerfiledialog%2Fnew_folder 15 Creates a new folder.
13 .uno%3AOpenFromCalc 2d Opens a local or remote file, or imports one.
b .uno%3AOpen 2d Opens a local or remote file, or imports one.
18 HID_FILEVIEW_MENU_DELETE 3f To delete a file, right-click the file, and then choose Delete.
18 SVT_HID_FILEOPEN_LEVELUP 57 Move up one folder in the folder hierarchy. Long-click to see the higher level folders.
22 svt%2Fui%2Fquerydeletedialog%2Fall 23 Click to delete all selected files.
14 HID_FILEDLG_STANDARD 3d Displays the files and folders in the folder that you are in.
15 .uno%3AOpenFromWriter 2d Opens a local or remote file, or imports one.
18 HID_FILEVIEW_MENU_RENAME 3f To rename a file, right-click the file, and then choose Rename.
22 svt%2Fui%2Fquerydeletedialog%2Fyes 42 Click to delete the file with the name shown in this dialogue box.
36 fpicker%2Fui%2Fexplorerfiledialog%2FExplorerFileDialog 2d Opens a local or remote file, or imports one.
21 svt%2Fui%2Fquerydeletedialog%2Fno 4e Click to cancel deletion of the file with the name shown in this dialogue box.
14 HID_FILEOPEN_VERSION 5e If there are multiple versions of the selected file, select the version that you want to open.
2d fpicker%2Fui%2Fexplorerfiledialog%2Ffile_name 7a Enter a file name or a path for the file. You can also enter a URL that starts with the protocol name ftp, http, or https.
2d fpicker%2Fui%2Fexplorerfiledialog%2Ffile_type 78 Select the file type that you want to open, or select All Files (*) to display a list of all of the files in the folder.
28 fpicker%2Fui%2Fexplorerfiledialog%2Fopen 1f Opens the selected document(s).
11 .uno%3AOpenRemote 32 Opens a document located in a remote file service.
19 HID_FILEDLG_PATH_FILENAME 27 Enter or select the path from the list.
14 HID_FILEDLG_PATH_BTN 1b Selects the indicated path.
33 SFX2%3ALISTBOX%3ADLG_FILTER_SELECT%3ALB_DLG_LISTBOX 3c Select the import filter for the file that you want to open.
f .uno%3ACloseDoc 38 Closes the current document without exiting the program.
b .uno%3ASave 1b Saves the current document.
11 .uno%3ASaveRemote 32 Saves a document located in a remote file service.
10 .uno%3ASaveACopy 41 Save a copy of the actual document with another name or location.
16 HID_FILESAVE_SELECTION 9f Exports only the selected graphic objects in %PRODUCTNAME Draw and Impress to another format. If this check box is not marked, the entire document is exported.
1d HID_FILESAVE_SAVEWITHPASSWORD 57 Protects the file with a password that must be entered before a user can open the file.
13 HID_FILESAVE_DOSAVE f Saves the file.
15 HID_FILESAVE_FILETYPE 3c Select the file format for the document that you are saving.
14 HID_FILESAVE_FILEURL 42 Enter a file name or a path for the file. You can also enter a URL
15 HID_FILESAVE_FILEVIEW 3d Displays the files and folders in the folder that you are in.
1f SVT_HID_FILESAVE_PLACES_LISTBOX 49 Displays "favourite" places, i.e. shortcuts to local or remote locations.
d .uno%3ASaveAs 5f Saves the current document in a different location, or with a different file name or file type.
35 fpicker%2Fui%2Fexplorerfiledialog%2Fconnect_to_server 85 Opens a dialogue box where you can set up connection to various types of servers, including WebDAV, FTP, SSH, Windows Share and CMIS.
1c HID_FILESAVE_CREATEDIRECTORY 15 Creates a new folder.
1c HID_FILESAVE_CUSTOMIZEFILTER 4e Allows you to set the spreadsheet saving options for some types of data files.
d SID_SAVEASDOC 5f Saves the current document in a different location, or with a different file name or file type.
17 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_DIALOG 5f Saves the current document in a different location, or with a different file name or file type.
14 HID_FILESAVE_LEVELUP 57 Move up one folder in the folder hierarchy. Long-click to see the higher level folders.
f .uno%3AExportTo 5b Saves the current document with a different name and format to a location that you specify.
13 .uno%3AExportAsMenu 2a Export the document in PDF or EPUB formats
1c .uno%3ASetDocumentProperties 78 Displays the properties for the current file, including statistics such as word count and the date the file was created.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Fdescriptioninfopage%2Fkeywords ad Enter the words that you want to use to index the content of your document. Keywords must be separated by commas. A keyword can contain white space characters or semicolons.
34 sfx%2Fui%2Fdescriptioninfopage%2FDescriptionInfoPage 34 Contains descriptive information about the document.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Fdescriptioninfopage%2Fcomments 2d Enter comments to help identify the document.
28 sfx%2Fui%2Fdescriptioninfopage%2Fsubject 61 Enter a subject for the document. You can use a subject to group documents with similar contents.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Fdescriptioninfopage%2Ftitle 1f Enter a title for the document.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fdocumentinfopage%2Freset a3 Resets the editing time to zero, the creation date to the current date and time, and the version number to 1. The modification and printing dates are also deleted.
2e sfx%2Fui%2Fdocumentinfopage%2FDocumentInfoPage 32 Contains basic information about the current file.
28 sfx%2Fui%2Fdocumentinfopage%2Fuserdatacb 78 Saves the user's full name with the file. You can edit the name by choosing Tools - Options - $[officename] - User Data.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fdocumentinfopage%2Fnameed 17 Displays the file name.
2a sfx%2Fui%2Fcustominfopage%2FCustomInfoPage 40 Allows you to assign custom information fields to your document.
1f sfx%2Fui%2Fcustominfopage%2Fadd 2e Click to add a new row to the Properties list.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Fcustominfopage%2Fproperties ad Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fstatisticsinfopage%2Fupdate 17 Updates the statistics.
3e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstatisticsinfopage%2FStatisticsInfoPage 29 Displays statistics for the current file.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fstatisticsinfopage%2FStatisticsInfoPage 29 Displays statistics for the current file.
2b sfx%2Fui%2Fsecurityinfopage%2Frecordchanges 56 Select to enable recording changes. This is the same as Edit - Track Changes - Record.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Fsecurityinfopage%2Fprotect d7 Protects the change recording state with a password. If change recording is protected for the current document, the button is named Unprotect. Click Unprotect and type the correct password to disable the protection.
2e sfx%2Fui%2Fsecurityinfopage%2FSecurityInfoPage 2f Sets password options for the current document.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Fsecurityinfopage%2Freadonly 42 Select to allow this document to be opened in read-only mode only.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Fdocumentfontspage%2FembedFonts 71 Mark this box to embed document fonts into the document file, for portability between different computer systems.
30 sfx%2Fui%2Fdocumentfontspage%2FDocumentFontsPage 2a Embed  document fonts in the current file.
13 .uno%3ATemplateMenu 5a Lets you organise and edit your templates, as well as save the current file as a template.
28 svt%2Fui%2Faddresstemplatedialog%2Fadmin 36 Add a new data source to the Address Book Source list.
18 .uno%3AAddressBookSource 45 Edit the field assignments and the data source for your address book.
29 svt%2Fui%2Faddresstemplatedialog%2Fassign 4e Select the field in the data table that corresponds to the address book entry.
2c svt%2Fui%2Faddresstemplatedialog%2Fdatatable 2c Select the data table for your address book.
2d svt%2Fui%2Faddresstemplatedialog%2Fdatasource 2d Select the data source for your address book.
28 sfx%2Fui%2Fsaveastemplatedlg%2Fdefaultcb 36 The new template will be used as the default template.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Fsaveastemplatedlg%2Fcategorylb 34 Select a category in which to save the new template.
15 .uno%3ASaveAsTemplate 29 Saves the current document as a template.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Fsaveastemplatedlg%2Fname_entry 1e Enter a name for the template.
33 sfx%2Fui%2Fsaveastemplatedlg%2FSaveAsTemplateDialog 29 Saves the current document as a template.
13 .uno%3AOpenTemplate 44 Opens a dialogue box in which you can select a template for editing.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A0 2c Specify how to scale slides in the printout.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AQuality%3ARadioButton%3A1 28 Specifies to print colours as greyscale.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsPrintHidden%3ACheckBox 3f Specifies whether to print the pages that are currently hidden.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsPrintDateTime%3ACheckBox 35 Specifies whether to print the current date and time.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A2 83 Specifies whether to scale down objects that are beyond the margins of the current printer so they fit on the paper in the printer.
34 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsPrintName%3ACheckBox 37 Specifies whether to print the page name of a document.
3a .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ASlidesPerPageOrder%3AListBox 32 Specify how to arrange slides on the printed page.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A1 44 Specifies that you do not want to further scale pages when printing.
29 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fpagespersheetbtn 28 Print multiple pages per sheet of paper.
29 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fpaperspersheetlb 32 Select how many pages to print per sheet of paper.
21 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fpagerows 16 Select number of rows.
25 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fpagemarginsb 3e Select margin between individual pages on each sheet of paper.
26 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fsheetmarginsb 37 Select margin between the printed pages and paper edge.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintFormat%3ARadioButton%3A2 4a Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified factor.
26 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Forientationlb 24 Select the orientation of the paper.
2f .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ABorder%3ACheckBox 3a Applies a thin border to the formula area in the printout.
22 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fcopycount 32 Enter the number of copies that you want to print.
31 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ATitleRow%3ACheckBox 53 Specifies whether you want the name of the document to be included in the printout.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintAnnotationMode%3AListBox 29 Specify where to print comments (if any).
35 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ASlidesPerPage%3AListBox 29 Select how many slides to print per page.
3d .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintAnnotationMode%3AFixedText 29 Specify where to print comments (if any).
20 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Forderlb 2e Select order in which pages are to be printed.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintFormat%3ARadioButton%3A0 3b Prints the formula without adjusting the current font size.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintEmptyPages%3ACheckBox 182 If this option is enabled automatically inserted blank pages are printed. This is best if you are printing double-sided. For example, in a book, a "chapter" paragraph style has been set to always start with an odd numbered page. If the previous chapter ends on an odd page, %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to print that even numbered page.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPageBackground%3ACheckBox 7c Specifies whether to print colours and objects that are inserted to the background of the page (Format - Page - Background).
c .uno%3APrint 83 Prints the current document, selection, or the pages that you specify. You can also set the print options for the current document.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintControls%3ACheckBox 4b Specifies whether the form control fields of the text document are printed.
40 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPicturesAndObjects%3ACheckBox 5d Specifies whether the graphics and drawings or OLE objects of your text document are printed.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintBlackFonts%3ACheckBox 30 Specifies whether to always print text in black.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AQuality%3ARadioButton%3A0 27 Specifies to print in original colours.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintHiddenText%3ACheckBox 3a Enable this option to print text that is marked as hidden.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageContentType%3AListBox 35 Select which parts of the document should be printed.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintFormat%3ARadioButton%3A1 3c Adjusts the formula to the page format used in the printout.
3d .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintTextPlaceholder%3ACheckBox 78 Enable this option to print text placeholders. Disable this option to leave the text placeholders blank in the printout.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintContent%3ARadioButton%3A0 1b Prints the entire document.
34 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AFormulaText%3ACheckBox 5f Specifies whether to include the contents of the Commands window at the bottom of the printout.
2e .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageRange%3AEdit c3 To print a range of pages, use a format like 3-6. To print single pages, use a format like 7;9;11. You can print a combination of page ranges and single pages, by using a format like 3-6;8;10;12.
21 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fbordercb 28 Check to draw a border around each page.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintScale%3ANumericField 4a Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified factor.
21 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fprinters f9 The list box shows the installed printers. Click the printer to use for the current print job. Click the Printer details button to see some information about the selected printer. Click the Properties button to change some of the printer properties.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsIncludeEmptyPages%3ACheckBox 53 If checked, empty pages that have no cell contents or draw objects are not printed.
20 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fcollate 32 Preserves the page order of the original document.
21 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fpagecols 19 Select number of columns.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPaperFromSetup%3ACheckBox 86 For printers with multiple trays this option specifies whether the paper tray used is specified by the system settings of the printer.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintContent%3ARadioButton%3A1 42 Prints only the pages or slides that you specify in the Pages box.
24 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fprinttofile 29 Prints to a file instead of to a printer.
27 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fsingleprintjob 68 Check to not rely on the printer to create collated copies but create a print job for each copy instead.
1e vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fsetup 70 Opens the printer properties dialogue box. The printer properties vary according to the printer that you select.
21 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fexpander 37 Show/Hide detailed information of the selected printer.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintContent%3ARadioButton%3A2 46 Prints only the selected area(s) or object(s) in the current document.
25 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Freverseorder 26 Check to print pages in reverse order.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintLeftRightPages%3AListBox 2d Specify which pages to include in the output.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintProspect%3ACheckBox 44 Select the Brochure option to print the document in brochure format.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AQuality%3ARadioButton%3A2 2e Specifies to print colours as black and white.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintProspectInclude%3AListBox 2a Select which pages of a brochure to print.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A3 a8 Specifies that pages are to be printed in tiled format. If the pages or slides are smaller than the paper, several pages or slides will be printed on one page of paper.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintProspectRTL%3AListBox 5e For brochure printing, you can select a left-to-right order of pages or a right-to-left order.
27 svt%2Fui%2Fprintersetupdialog%2Foptions b1 Opens the Printer Options dialogue box where you can override the global printer options set on the Tools - Options - %PRODUCTNAME Writer - Print panel for the current document.
2a svt%2Fui%2Fprintersetupdialog%2Fproperties 4f Changes the printer settings of your operating system for the current document.
32 svt%2Fui%2Fprintersetupdialog%2FPrinterSetupDialog 34 Select the default printer for the current document.
24 svt%2Fui%2Fprintersetupdialog%2Fname 7a Lists the installed printers on your operating system. To change the default printer, select a printer name from the list.
16 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsMS 80 Opens a new window in your default e-mail program with the current document as an attachment. The Microsoft file format is used.
11 .uno%3ASendToMenu 3f Sends a copy of the current document to different applications.
17 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsOOo 83 Opens a new window in your default e-mail program with the current document as an attachment. The OpenDocument file format is used.
f .uno%3ASendMail 7e Opens a new window in your default e-mail program with the current document as an attachment. The current file format is used.
15 HID_FILESAVE_TEMPLATE 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents.
26 HID_SEND_MASTER_CTRL_PUSHBUTTON_CANCEL b1 Creates a master document from the current Writer document. A new sub-document is created at each occurrence of a chosen paragraph style or outline level in the source document.
b .uno%3AQuit 47 Closes all $[officename] programs and prompts you to save your changes.
e .uno%3ASaveAll 2b Saves all modified $[officename] documents.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fcompare 33 Compare the changes that were made in each version.
22 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fshow 35 Displays the entire comment for the selected version.
14 .uno%3AVersionDialog 89 Saves and organises multiple versions of the current document in the same file. You can also open, delete, and compare previous versions.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fdelete 1d Deletes the selected version.
22 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fsave ae Saves the current state of the document as a new version. If you want, you can also enter comments in the Insert Version Comment dialogue box before you save the new version.
22 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fopen 31 Opens the selected version in a read-only window.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Falways 77 If you have made changes to your document, $[officename] automatically saves a new version when you close the document.
36 sfx%2Fui%2Fversioncommentdialog%2FVersionCommentDialog 83 Enter a comment here when you are saving a new version. If you clicked Show to open this dialogue box, you cannot edit the comment.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fversions 85 Lists the existing versions of the current document, the date and the time they were created, the author and the associated comments.
15 .uno%3ARecentFileList 53 Lists the most recently opened files. To open a file from the list, click its name.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_UNDO a1 Reverses the last command or the last entry you typed. To select the command that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Undo icon on the Standard bar.
b .uno%3AUndo a1 Reverses the last command or the last entry you typed. To select the command that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Undo icon on the Standard bar.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_REDO 9a Reverses the action of the last Undo command. To select the Undo step that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Redo icon on the Standard bar.
b .uno%3ARedo 9a Reverses the action of the last Undo command. To select the Undo step that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Redo icon on the Standard bar.
d .uno%3ARepeat 47 Repeats the last command. This command is available in Writer and Calc.
a .uno%3ACut 32 Removes and copies the selection to the clipboard.
b .uno%3ACopy 26 Copies the selection to the clipboard.
c .uno%3APaste 6f Inserts the contents of the clipboard at the location of the cursor, and replaces any selected text or objects.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fmove_right 0 
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fdatetime 0 
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fnumbers 0 
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fnone 0 
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fmultiply 0 
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Ftext 0 
13 .uno%3APasteSpecial 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Flist 42 Select a format for the clipboard contents that you want to paste.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fsource 2e Displays the source of the clipboard contents.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fcomments 0 
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fadd 0 
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fno_shift 0 
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fformats 0 
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fobjects 0 
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fsubtract 0 
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fdivide 0 
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fmove_down 0 
d .uno%3ASelect 46 Selects the entire content of the current file, frame, or text object.
2b svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fcalcsearchin 9b Searches for the characters that you specify in formulae and in fixed (not calculated) values. For example, you could look for formulae that contain 'SUM'.
27 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fnoformat 70 Click in the Find or the Replace box, and then click this button to remove the search criteria based on formats.
2c svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsoundslikebtn 43 Sets the search options for similar notation used in Japanese text.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsoundslike a4 Lets you specify the search options for similar notation used in Japanese text. Mark this check box, and then click the Sounds button to specify the search options.
2d svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fmatchcharwidth 40 Distinguishes between half-width and full-width character forms.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fregexp 2b Allows you to use wildcards in your search.
30 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Freplace_backwards 5d Search starts at the current cursor position and goes backwards to the beginning of the file.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsearchlist 50 Enter the text that you want to find, or select a previous search from the list.
2a svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Freplacelist 57 Enter the replacement text, or select a recent replacement text or style from the list.
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fmatchcase 3b Distinguishes between upper-case and lower-case characters.
11 .uno%3ADownSearch 3b Click to search the next occurrence in downwards direction.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fwholewords 48 Searches for whole words or cells that are identical to the search text.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Freplaceall 4f Replaces all of the occurrences of the text or format that you want to replace.
23 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fcols 30 Searches from top to bottom through the columns.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Flabel3 5f Shows more or fewer search options. Click this label again to hide the extended search options.
24 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fnotes 4f In Writer, you can select to include the comment text strings in your searches.
13 .uno%3ASearchDialog 3a Finds or replaces text or formats in the current document.
f .uno%3AUpSearch 39 Click to search the next occurrence in upwards direction.
f .uno%3AFindText 50 Type the text to search in the current document. Press Enter to search the text.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Flayout c5 Searches for text formatted with the style that you specify. Select this check box, and then select a style from the Find list. To specify a replacement style, select a style from the Replace list.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fbacksearch 6b Finds and selects the previous occurrence of the text or format that you are searching for in the document.
23 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Frows 2c Searches from left to right across the rows.
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsearchall 89 Finds and selects all instances of the text or the format that you are searching for in the document (only in Writer and Calc documents).
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fselection 29 Searches only the selected text or cells.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsearch 67 Finds and selects the next occurrence of the text or format that you are searching for in the document.
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fallsheets 43 Searches through all of the sheets in the current spreadsheet file.
26 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Freplace 66 Replaces the selected text or format that you searched for, and then searches for the next occurrence.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fsimilaritysearchdialog%2Fshorterfld 53 Enter the number of characters by which a word can be shorter than the search term.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fsimilaritysearchdialog%2Flongerfld 6e Enter the maximum number of characters by which a word can exceed the number of characters in the search term.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fsimilaritysearchdialog%2Fotherfld 48 Enter the number of characters in the search term that can be exchanged.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fsimilaritysearchdialog%2Frelaxbox 53 Searches for a term that matches any combination of the similarity search settings.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsimilarity 8d Find terms that are similar to the Find text. Select this check box, and then click the Similarities button to define the similarity options.
2c svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsimilaritybtn 2a Set the options for the similarity search.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fsearchattrdialog%2FSearchAttrDialog 122 Choose the text attributes that you want to search for. For example, if you search for the Font attribute, all instances of text that do not use the default font are found. All text that has a directly coded font attribute, and all text where a style switches the font attribute, are found.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fformat 69 Finds specific text formatting features, such as font types, font effects, and text flow characteristics.
15 HID_GLBLTREE_UPD_LINK 12 Updates all links.
19 HID_GLBLTREE_INS_NEW_FILE 27 Creates and inserts a new sub-document.
14 HID_GLBLTREE_UPD_SEL 26 Updates the contents of the selection.
16 HID_GLBLTREE_EDIT_LINK 32 Changes the link properties for the selected file.
1b HID_NAVIGATOR_GLOB_TREELIST b8 The Navigator lists the main components of the master document. If you rest the mouse pointer over a name of a sub-document in the list, the full path of the sub-document is displayed.
11 HID_GLBLTREE_EDIT be Edit the contents of the component selected in the Navigator list. If the selection is a file, the file is opened for editing. If the selection is an index, the index dialogue box is opened.
13 HID_GLBLTREEUPD_ALL 15 Updates all contents.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fmoveup 3a Moves the selection up one position in the Navigator list.
15 HID_GLBLTREE_INS_FILE 3c Inserts one or more existing files into the master document.
15 HID_GLBLTREE_INS_TEXT 93 Inserts a new paragraph in the master document in which you can enter text. You cannot insert text next to an existing text entry in the Navigator.
13 HID_GLBLTREE_UPDATE 36 Click and choose the contents that you want to update.
13 HID_GLBLTREE_INSERT 45 Inserts a file, an index, or a new document into the master document.
14 HID_GLBLTREE_UPD_IDX 14 Updates all indexes.
14 HID_GLBLTREE_INS_IDX 41 Inserts an index or a table of contents into the master document.
10 HID_GLBLTREE_DEL 2e Deletes the selection from the Navigator list.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fsave a7 Saves a copy of the contents of the linked files in the master document. This ensures that the current contents are available when the linked files cannot be accessed.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fnavigatorpanel%2Fmovedown 3c Moves the selection down one position in the Navigator list.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fbaselinksdialog%2FBREAK_LINK 99 Breaks the link between the source file and the current document. The most recently updated contents of the source file are kept in the current document.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fbaselinksdialog%2FTB_LINKS 71 Double-click a link in the list to open a file dialogue box in which you can select another object for this link.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fbaselinksdialog%2FAUTOMATIC d1 Automatically updates the contents of the link when you open the file. Any changes made in the source file are then displayed in the file containing the link. Linked graphic files can only be updated manually.
12 .uno%3AManageLinks c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fbaselinksdialog%2FMANUAL 37 Only updates the link when you click the Update button.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fbaselinksdialog%2FUPDATE_NOW 7a Updates the selected link so that the most recently saved version of the linked file is displayed in the current document.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fbaselinksdialog%2FCHANGE_SOURCE 2d Change the source file for the selected link.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Flinkeditdialog%2Fcategory 6c Lists the section that the link refers to in the source file. If you want, you can enter a new section here.
1f sfx%2Fui%2Flinkeditdialog%2Fapp 36 Lists the application that last saved the source file.
20 sfx%2Fui%2Flinkeditdialog%2Ffile 22 Lists the path to the source file.
13 .uno%3AOriginalSize 28 Resizes the object to the original size.
12 .uno%3AObjectMenue 60 Lets you edit a selected object in your file that you inserted with the Insert - Object command.
2d cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fdefaultwidth 27 Applies the default horizontal spacing.
29 cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fborderon 2a Displays the border of the floating frame.
2e cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fdefaultheight 25 Applies the default vertical spacing.
2a cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fborderoff 27 Hides the border of the floating frame.
2e cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fscrollbarauto 5a Mark this option if the currently active floating frame can have a scroll bar when needed.
27 cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fheight dc Enter the amount of vertical space that you want to leave between the top and bottom edges of the floating frame and the contents of the frame. Both documents inside and outside the floating frame must be HTML documents.
3a cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2FInsertFloatingFrameDialog a9 Changes the properties of the selected floating frame. Floating frames work best when they contain an html document, and when they are inserted in another html document.
26 cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fwidth e2 Enter the amount of horizontal space that you want to leave between the right and the left edges of the floating frame and the contents of the frame. Both documents inside and outside the floating frame must be HTML documents.
27 cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fedname 7b Enter a name for the floating frame. The name cannot contain spaces, special characters, or begin with an underscore ( _ ).
2d cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fscrollbaroff 2c Hides the scroll bar for the floating frame.
26 cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fedurl aa Enter the path and the name of the file that you want to display in the floating frame. You can also click the Browse button and locate the file that you want to display.
2c cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fscrollbaron 2f Displays the scroll bar for the floating frame.
2d cui%2Fui%2Finsertfloatingframe%2Fbuttonbrowse 5d Locate the file that you want to display in the selected floating frame, and then click Open.
21 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2Fcontainer 44 Displays the image map, so that you can click and edit the hotspots.
1b svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2Furl 55 Enter the URL for the file that you want to open when you click the selected hotspot.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FImapDialog 93 Allows you to attach URLs to specific areas, called hotspots, on a graphic or a group of graphics. An image map is a group of one or more hotspots.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_SELECT 2f Selects a hotspot in the image map for editing.
1c svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2Ftext 59 Enter the text that you want to display when the mouse rests on the hotspot in a browser.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_OPEN 5b Loads an existing image map in the MAP-CERN, MAP-NCSA or SIP StarView ImageMap file format.
21 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_APPLY 33 Applies the changes that you made to the image map.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_CIRCLE b3 Draws an elliptical hotspot where you drag in the graphic. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_POLY 1bb Draws a polygonal hotspot in the graphic. Click this icon, drag in the graphic, and then click to define one side of the polygon. Move to where you want to place the end of the next side, and then click. Repeat until you have drawn all of the sides of the polygon. When you are finished, double-click to close the polygon. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_POLYDELETE 22 Deletes the selected anchor point.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_FREEPOLY 124 Draws a hotspot that is based on a free-form polygon. Click this icon and move to where you want to draw the hotspot. Drag a free-form line and release to close the shape. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_RECT b3 Draws a rectangular hotspot where you drag in the graphic. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_SAVEAS 53 Saves the image map in the MAP-CERN, MAP-NCSA or SIP StarView ImageMap file format.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_ACTIVE 5e Disables or enables the hyperlink for the selected hotspot. A disabled hotspot is transparent.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_POLYMOVE 43 Lets you move the individual anchor points of the selected hotspot.
21 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_MACRO 53 Lets you assign a macro that runs when you click the selected hotspot in a browser.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_POLYINSERT 43 Adds an anchor point where you click on the outline of the hotspot.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_POLYEDIT 4f Lets you change the shape of the selected hotspot by editing the anchor points.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fimapdialog%2FTBI_PROPERTY 3c Allows you to define the properties of the selected hotspot.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2FdescTV 24 Enter a description for the hotspot.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2Fnameentry 1b Enter a name for the image.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2FframeCB a0 Enter the name of the target frame that you want to open the URL in. You can also select a standard frame name that is recognised by all browsers from the list.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2Ftextentry 59 Enter the text that you want to display when the mouse rests on the hotspot in a browser.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2FIMapDialog 2e Lists the properties for the selected hotspot.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2Furlentry 55 Enter the URL for the file that you want to open when you click the selected hotspot.
12 .uno%3AChangesMenu 48 Lists the commands that are available for tracking changes in your file.
16 .uno%3ATraceChangeMode 4b Tracks each change that is made in the current document by author and date.
13 .uno%3ATrackChanges 4b Tracks each change that is made in the current document by author and date.
1d .uno%3AProtectTraceChangeMode 87 Prevents a user from deactivating the record changes feature, or from accepting or rejecting changes unless the user enters a password.
12 .uno%3AShowChanges 20 Shows or hides recorded changes.
19 .uno%3AShowTrackedChanges 20 Shows or hides recorded changes.
3c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fshowchangesdialog%2FShowChangesDialog 20 Shows or hides recorded changes.
19 cui%2Fui%2Fcomment%2Fedit 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fcomment%2FCommentDialog 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change.
1c .uno%3ACommentChangeTracking 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change.
14 .uno%3ACommentChange 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change.
14 .uno%3AAcceptChanges 22 Accept or reject recorded changes.
33 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fcalcposition 82 Sorts the list in a descending order according to the position of the changes in the document. This is the default sorting method.
31 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fwriterdesc 4a Sorts the list according to the comments that are attached to the changes.
31 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fwriterdate 2e Sorts the list according to the date and time.
32 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fcalccomment 33 Lists the comments that are attached to the change.
2f svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fcalcdate 31 Lists the date and time that the change was made.
31 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fcalcauthor 23 Lists the user who made the change.
31 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fcalcaction 31 Lists the changes that were made in the document.
1a .uno%3ARejectTrackedChange 59 Rejects the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fredlineviewpage%2FRedlineViewPage 24 Accept or reject individual changes.
33 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fwriterauthor 27 Sorts the list according to the Author.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fredlineviewpage%2Fchanges b0 Lists the changes that were recorded in the document. When you select an entry in the list, the change is highlighted in the document. To sort the list, click a column heading.
2d svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Faccept 59 Accepts the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
1a .uno%3AAcceptTrackedChange 59 Accepts the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
2d svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Freject 59 Rejects the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
30 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Facceptall 4a Accepts all of the changes and removes the highlighting from the document.
2f svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fcalcedit 29 Edit the comment for the selected change.
30 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Frejectall 4a Rejects all of the changes and removes the highlighting from the document.
2b svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fundo 2a Reverse the last Accept or Reject command.
33 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fwriteraction 2f Sorts the list according to the type of change.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fcommentedit 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fcomment 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fenddate 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fstartdate 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fauthor 5e Filters the list of changes according to the name of the author that you select from the list.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fdatecond 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
30 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2FRedlineFilterPage 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fstarttime 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fdate 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fendtime 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fstartclock 3e Enters the current date and time into the corresponding boxes.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Factionlist 5e Filters the list of changes according to the type of change that you select in the Action box.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Frange 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter.
38 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fsimplerefdialog%2FSimpleRefDialog 5e Filters the list of changes according to the type of change that you select in the Action box.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fendclock 3e Enters the current date and time into the corresponding boxes.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fauthorlist 5e Filters the list of changes according to the name of the author that you select from the list.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fdotdotdot 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Frangeedit 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Faction 5e Filters the list of changes according to the type of change that you select in the Action box.
15 .uno%3AMergeDocuments 92 Imports changes made to copies of the same document into the original document. Changes made to footnotes, headers, frames and fields are ignored.
17 .uno%3ACompareDocuments 3e Compares the current document with a document that you select.
19 .uno%3ABib%2FDeleteRecord 1b Deletes the current record.
14 .uno%3ABib%2FMapping bd Lets you map the column headings to data fields from a different data source. To define a different data source for your bibliography, click the Data Source button on the record Object Bar.
16 .uno%3ABib%2Fsdbsource 35 Select the data source for the bibliography database.
1b .uno%3ABib%2FstandardFilter 4b Use the Standard Filter to refine and to combine AutoFilter search options.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_YEAR_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_AUTHOR_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_JOURNAL_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_BOOKTITLE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
19 .uno%3ABib%2FremoveFilter 46 To display all of the records in a table, click the Reset Filter icon.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_TITLE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1c SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_ABSOLUTE 4d Type the number of the record that you want to display, and then press Enter.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ANNOTE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_PUBLISHER_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
13 .uno%3ABib%2Fsource 73 Lists the available tables in the current database. Click a name in the list to display the records for that table.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ORGANIZATIONS_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_SERIES_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
13 HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEW 2c Inserts a new record into the current table.
3a modules%2Fsbibliography%2Fui%2Ftoolbar%2FTBC_BT_COL_ASSIGN 47 Insert, delete, edit and organise records in the bibliography database.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_NOTE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
11 SID_FM_DELETEROWS 1c Deletes the selected record.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_CHAPTER_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_MONTH_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_URL_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
19 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_FIRST 24 Go to the first record in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_PREV 27 Go to the previous record in the table.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_IDENTIFIER_POS 6a Enter a short name for the record. The short name appears in the Identifier column in the list of records.
3c modules%2Fsbibliography%2Fui%2Fmappingdialog%2FMappingDialog a1 Select the data field that you want to map to the current Column name. To change the available data fields, select a different data source for your bibliography.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_LAST 23 Go to the last record in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEXT 23 Go to the next record in the table.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_REPORTTYPE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ADDRESS_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
19 .uno%3ABib%2FInsertRecord 2c Inserts a new record into the current table.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_PAGES_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_VOLUME_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_INSTITUTION_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_NUMBER_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_AUTHORITYTYPE_POS a5 Select the type of record that you want to create. $[officename] inserts a number in the Type column of the record that corresponds to the type that you select here.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ISBN_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_SCHOOL_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_EDITION_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_HOWPUBLISHED_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
12 .uno%3ABib%2Fquery 180 Type the information that you want to search for, and then press Enter. To change the filter options for the search, long-click the AutoFilter icon, and then select a different data field. You can use wildcards such as % or * for any number of characters, and _ or ? for one character in your search. To display all of the records in the table, clear this field, and then press Enter.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_EDITOR_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
17 .uno%3ABib%2FautoFilter 96 Long-click to select the data field that you want to search using the term that you entered in the Search Key box. You can only search one data field.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fbookmode 83 In book mode view layout you see two pages side by side as in an open book. The first page is a right page with an odd page number.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fcolumnssb 6c In columns view layout you see pages in a given number of columns side by side. Enter the number of columns.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fsinglepage 56 The single page view layout displays pages beneath each other, but never side by side.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fautomatic 59 The automatic view layout displays pages side by side, as many as the zoom factor allows.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fzoomsb 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2F100pc 29 Displays the document at its actual size.
15 .uno%3AZoom100Percent 29 Displays the document at its actual size.
b .uno%3AZoom 37 Reduces or enlarges the screen display of %PRODUCTNAME.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2FZoomDialog 37 Reduces or enlarges the screen display of %PRODUCTNAME.
1d svx%2Fui%2Fzoommenu%2Foptimal 66 Resizes the display to fit the width of the text in the document at the moment the command is started.
1a svx%2Fui%2Fzoommenu%2Fpage 28 Displays the entire page on your screen.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fcolumns 6c In columns view layout you see pages in a given number of columns side by side. Enter the number of columns.
1b svx%2Fui%2Fzoommenu%2Fwidth 6a Displays the complete width of the document page. The top and bottom edges of the page may not be visible.
19 svx%2Fui%2Fzoommenu%2F100 29 Displays the document at its actual size.
19 .uno%3AFunctionBarVisible 20 Shows or hides the Standard Bar.
1a .uno%3AShowImeStatusWindow 3b Shows or hides the Input Method Engine (IME) status window.
15 .uno%3AToolBarVisible 1d Shows or hides the Tools bar.
17 .uno%3AStatusBarVisible 3f Shows or hides the Status Bar at the bottom edge of the window.
15 .uno%3ATaskBarVisible 3f Shows or hides the Status Bar at the bottom edge of the window.
15 HID_FULLSCREENTOOLBOX 76 In Writer and Calc, you can also use the shortcut keys Ctrl+Shift+J to switch between the normal and full screen mode.
11 .uno%3AFullScreen 89 Shows or hides the menus and toolbars in Writer or Calc. To exit the full screen mode, click the Full Screen button or press the Esc key.
14 HID_COLOR_CTL_COLORS 14c Click the colour that you want to use. To change the fill colour of an object in the current file, select the object and then click a colour. To change the line colour of the selected object, right-click a colour. To change the colour of text in a text object, double-click the text-object, select the text, and then click a colour.
13 .uno%3AColorControl 8e Show or hides the Colour Bar. To modify or change the colour table that is displayed, choose Format - Area, and then click on the Colours tab.
18 .cmd%3ARestoreVisibility ab Choose View - Toolbars - Reset to reset the toolbars to their default context sensitive behaviour. Now some toolbars will be shown automatically, dependent on the context.
18 .uno%3AAvailableToolbars 2b Opens a sub-menu to show and hide toolbars.
16 .uno%3AShowAnnotations 49 Use View - Comments to show or hide all comments (not available in Calc).
1a .uno%3ADeleteAllAnnotation 2c Delete all comments in the current document.
17 .uno%3AInsertAnnotation 4d Inserts a comment around the selected text or at the current cursor position.
11 .uno%3ADeleteNote 1b Delete the current comment.
13 .uno%3ADeleteAuthor 3b Delete all comments by this author in the current document.
17 .uno%3ADeleteAnnotation 1b Delete the current comment.
15 .uno%3ADeleteAllNotes 2c Delete all comments in the current document.
22 .uno%3ADeleteAllAnnotationByAuthor 3b Delete all comments by this author in the current document.
b .uno%3AScan 2b Inserts a scanned image into your document.
12 .uno%3ATwainSelect 29 Selects the scanner that you want to use.
14 .uno%3ATwainTransfer 88 Scans an image, and then inserts the result into the document. The scanning dialogue box is provided by the manufacturer of the scanner.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fspecialcharacters%2Ffontlb 4c Select a font to display the special characters that are associated with it.
17 HID_CHARMAP_CTL_SHOWSET 4e Click the special character(s) that you want to insert, and then click Insert.
36 cui%2Fui%2Fspecialcharacters%2FSpecialCharactersDialog 5a Allows a user to insert characters from the range of symbols found in the installed fonts.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fspecialcharacters%2Fsubsetlb 2f Select a Unicode category for the current font.
13 .uno%3AInsertSymbol 5a Allows a user to insert characters from the range of symbols found in the installed fonts.
d .uno%3ABullet 5a Allows a user to insert characters from the range of symbols found in the installed fonts.
16 HID_FILEDLG_PREVIEW_CB 30 Displays a preview of the selected graphic file.
13 HID_FILEDLG_LINK_CB 2c Inserts the selected graphic file as a link.
14 .uno%3AInsertGraphic 5e Inserts an image into the current document with optimal page wrapping and centred on the line.
1b HID_FILEOPEN_IMAGE_TEMPLATE 27 Select the frame style for the graphic.
11 .uno%3AObjectMenu 66 Inserts an embedded object into your document, including formulas, 3-D models, charts and OLE objects.
2b cui%2Fui%2Finsertoleobject%2Fcreatefromfile 2c Creates an OLE object from an existing file.
22 cui%2Fui%2Finsertoleobject%2Ftypes 34 Select the type of document that you want to create.
13 .uno%3AInsertObject 6c Inserts an OLE object into the current document. The OLE object is inserted as a link or an embedded object.
23 cui%2Fui%2Finsertoleobject%2Furlbtn 3d Locate the file that you want to insert, and then click Open.
22 cui%2Fui%2Finsertoleobject%2Furled 5f Enter the name of the file that you want to link or embed, or click Search, to locate the file.
26 cui%2Fui%2Finsertoleobject%2Fcreatenew 42 Creates a new OLE object based on the object type that you select.
1b .uno%3AInsertObjectStarMath 2c Inserts a formula into the current document.
20 .uno%3AInsertObjectFloatingFrame 87 Inserts a floating frame into the current document. Floating frames are used in HTML documents to display the contents of another file.
1c .uno%3AViewDataSourceBrowser 6a Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME and lets you manage the contents of the databases.
11 .uno%3ADataImport 6a Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME and lets you manage the contents of the databases.
12 .uno%3AGraphicMenu 57 The sub-menu presents various sources that an image, audio or video can be insert from.
16 .uno%3AResetAttributes 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection.
1d .uno%3AStandardTextAttributes 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection.
11 .uno%3ASetDefault 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection.
11 .uno%3AFontDialog 45 Changes the font and the font formatting for the selected characters.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fctlsizelb 6c Enter or select the font size that you want to apply. For scalable fonts, you can also enter decimal values.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fctlstylelb 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2FCharNamePage 3b Specify the formatting and the font that you want to apply.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fctllanglb 9d Sets the language that the spell checker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fctlfontnamelb 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list.
2a cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Findividualwordscb 3d Applies the selected effect only to words and ignores spaces.
22 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Feffectslb 2f Select the font effects that you want to apply.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Ffontcolorlb 98 Sets the colour for the selected text. If you select Automatic, the text colour is set to black for light backgrounds and to white for dark backgrounds.
21 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Frelieflb e1 Select a relief effect to apply to the selected text. The embossed relief makes the characters appear as if they are raised above the page. The engraved relief makes the characters appear as if they are pressed into the page.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2FEffectsPage 2e Specify the font effects that you want to use.
10 .uno%3AFontColor d2 Click to apply the current font colour to the selected characters. You can also click here, and then drag a selection to change the text colour. Click the arrow next to the icon to open the Font colour toolbar.
21 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Fshadowcb 4b Adds a shadow that casts below and to the right of the selected characters.
29 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Funderlinecolorlb 26 Select the colour for the underlining.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Fblinkingcb 4b Makes the selected characters blink. You cannot change the blink frequency.
c .uno%3AColor d2 Click to apply the current font colour to the selected characters. You can also click here, and then drag a selection to change the text colour. Click the arrow next to the icon to open the Font colour toolbar.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Foverlinelb 7b Select the overlining style that you want to apply. To apply the overlining to words only, select the Individual Words box.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Fpositionlb 2c Specify where to display the emphasis marks.
22 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Foutlinecb 5b Displays the outline of the selected characters. This effect does not work with every font.
21 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Fhiddencb 1e Hides the selected characters.
f .uno%3AOverline 81 Overlines or removes overlining from the selected text. If the cursor is not in a word, the new text that you enter is overlined.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Femphasislb 53 Select a character to display over or below the entire length of the selected text.
28 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Foverlinecolorlb 25 Select the colour for the overlining.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Fstrikeoutlb 33 Select a strikethrough style for the selected text.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Funderlinelb 7d Select the underlining style that you want to apply. To apply the underlining to words only, select the Individual Words box.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fcommented 50 Enter a comment for the selected number format, and then click outside this box.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fsourceformat 4b Uses the same number format as the cells containing the data for the chart.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fcurrencylb 71 Select a currency, and then scroll to the top of the Format list to view the formatting options for the currency.
1e .uno%3ATableNumberFormatDialog 38 Specify the formatting options for the selected cell(s).
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fcategorylb 56 Select a category from the list, and then select a formatting style in the Format box.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fformatlb 48 Select how you want the content of the selected cell(s) to be displayed.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fengineering 56 With scientific format, Engineering notation ensures that exponent is a multiple of 3.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fdecimalsed 3c Enter the number of decimal places that you want to display.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fdenominatored 5e With fraction format, enter the number of places for the denominator that you want to display.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fleadzerosed 4b Enter the maximum number of zeros to display in front of the decimal point.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fadd 4a Adds the number format code that you entered to the user-defined category.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fnegnumred 33 Changes the font colour of negative numbers to red.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fthousands 6c Inserts a separator between thousands. The type of separator that is used depends on your language settings.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fformatted 5c Displays the number format code for the selected format. You can also enter a custom format.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Flanguagelb 100 Specifies the language setting for the selected fields. With the language set to Automatic, $[officename] automatically applies the number formats associated with the system default language. Select any language to fix the settings for the selected fields.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fdelete 23 Deletes the selected number format.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fedit 2d Adds a comment to the selected number format.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Ftargetfrmlb 71 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Fvisitedlb b5 Select a formatting style to use for visited links from the list. To add or modify a style in this list, close this dialogue box and click the Styles icon on the Formatting toolbar.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Furled 4c Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Furlpb 3e Locate the file that you want to link to, and then click Open.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Ftexted 3a Enter the text that you want to display for the hyperlink.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Funvisitedlb b7 Select a formatting style to use for unvisited links from the list. To add or modify a style in this list, close this dialogue box and click the Styles icon on the Formatting toolbar.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Feventpb 3c Specify an event that triggers when you click the hyperlink.
19 .uno%3AInsertHyperlinkDlg 38 Assigns a new hyperlink or edits the selected hyperlink.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Fnameed 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fpairkerning 4c Automatically adjust the character spacing for specific letter combinations.
e .uno%3ASpacing 42 Specifies the spacing between the characters of the selected text.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2F270deg 35 Rotates the selected text to the right by 90 degrees.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2F90deg 34 Rotates the selected text to the left by 90 degrees.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2F0deg 22 Does not rotate the selected text.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fscalewidthsb 66 Enter the percentage of the font width by which to horizontally stretch or compress the selected text.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fsuperscript 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and raises the text above the baseline.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2FPositionPage 43 Specify the position, scaling, rotation and spacing for characters.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fnormal 2c Removes superscript or subscript formatting.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fautomatic 6a Automatically sets the amount by which the selected text is raised or lowered in relation to the baseline.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fsubscript 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and lowers the text below the baseline.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fkerningsb 42 Specifies the spacing between the characters of the selected text.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fraiselowersb 9e Enter the amount by which you want to raise or to lower the selected text in relation to the baseline. One hundred percent is equal to the height of the font.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Ffittoline 86 Stretches or compresses the selected text so that it fits between the line that is above the text and the line that is below the text.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Ffontsizesb 50 Enter the amount by which you want to reduce the font size of the selected text.
24 cui%2Fui%2Ftwolinespage%2Fendbracket 83 Select the character to define the end of the double-lined area. If you want to choose a custom character, select Other Characters.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftwolinespage%2FTwoLinesPage 7f Sets the options for double-line writing for Asian languages. Select the characters in your text, and then choose this command.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftwolinespage%2Fstartbracket 85 Select the character to define the start of the double-lined area. If you want to choose a custom character, select Other Characters.
22 cui%2Fui%2Ftwolinespage%2Ftwolines 5a Allows you to write in double lines in the area that you selected in the current document.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fasiantypography%2FcheckApplySpacing 3c Inserts a space between Asian, Latin and complex characters.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fasiantypography%2FcheckHangPunct 8b Prevents commas and full stops from breaking the line. Instead, these characters are added to the end of the line, even in the page margin.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fasiantypography%2FAsianTypography f8 Set the typographic options for cells or paragraphs in Asian language files. To enable Asian language support, choose Language Settings - Languages in the Options dialogue box, and then mark the Enabled check box in the Asian language support area.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fasiantypography%2FcheckForbidList 89 Prevents the characters in the list from starting or ending a line. The characters are relocated to either the previous or the next line.
10 .uno%3AEditStyle 4c Modifies the format of the current paragraph, such as indents and alignment.
16 .uno%3AParagraphDialog 4c Modifies the format of the current paragraph, such as indents and alignment.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FcomboLB_LINEDIST 4a Specify the amount of space to leave between lines of text in a paragraph.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_BOTTOMDIST 51 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave below the selected paragraph(s).
38 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FcheckCB_CONTEXTUALSPACING 94 Makes any space specified before or after this paragraph not be applied when the preceding and following paragraphs are of the same paragraph style.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_LEFTINDENT 184 Enter the amount of space that you want to indent the paragraph from the page margin. If you want the paragraph to extend into the page margin, enter a negative number. In Left-to-Right languages, the left edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the left page margin. In Right-to-Left languages, the right edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the right page margin.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FParaIndentSpacing 3d Sets the indenting and the spacing options for the paragraph.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_TOPDIST 51 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave above the selected paragraph(s).
31 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_RIGHTINDENT 184 Enter the amount of space that you want to indent the paragraph from the page margin. If you want the paragraph to extend into the page margin, enter a negative number. In Left-to-Right languages, the right edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the right page margin. In Right-to-Left languages, the left edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the left page margin.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_FLINEINDENT 12a Indents the first line of a paragraph by the amount that you enter. To create a hanging indent enter a positive value for "Before text" and a negative value for "First line". To indent the first line of a paragraph that uses numbering or bullets, choose "Format - Bullets and Numbering - Position".
2f cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FcheckCB_REGISTER 14d Aligns the baseline of each line of text to a vertical document grid, so that each line is the same height. To use this feature, you must first activate the Register-true option for the current page style. To do this, choose Format - Page, click on the Page tab, and then mark the Register-true check box in the Layout settings area.
34 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_LINEDISTMETRIC 2c Enter the value to use for the line spacing.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FcheckCB_AUTO 80 Automatically indents a paragraph according to the font size and the line spacing. The setting in the First Line box is ignored.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FbuttonBTN_DELALL 80 Removes all of the tab stops that you defined under Position. Sets Left tab stops at regular intervals as the default tab stops.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FbuttonBTN_NEW 3c Adds the tab stop that you defined to the current paragraph.
37 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_FILLCHAR_OTHER 56 Allows you to specify a character to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop.
3c cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_FILLCHAR_UNDERSCORE 41 Draws a line to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_FILLCHAR_POINTS 3c Fills the empty space to the left of the tab stop with dots.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FED_TABPOS fa Select a tab stop type, enter a new measurement, and then click New. If you want, you can also specify the measurement units to use for the tab (cm for centimetre, or " for inches). Existing tabs to the left of the first tab that you set are removed.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FParagraphTabsPage 2e Set the position of a tab stop in a paragraph.
3a cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_FILLCHAR_DASHLINE 3e Fills the empty space to the left of the tab stop with dashes.
34 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_FILLCHAR_NO 5c Inserts no fill characters, or removes existing fill characters to the left of the tab stop.
35 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_TABTYPE_LEFT 53 Aligns the left edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the right.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FentryED_TABTYPE_DECCHAR 4e Enter a character that you want the decimal tab to use as a decimal separator.
37 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_TABTYPE_CENTER 2e Aligns the centre of the text to the tab stop.
36 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_TABTYPE_RIGHT 63 Aligns the right edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the left of the tab stop.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_TABTYPE_DECIMAL 67 Aligns the decimal separator of a number to the centre of the tab stop and text to the left of the tab.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fmergeadjacent 9c Merges two different border styles of adjacent cells in a Writer table into one border style. This property is valid for a whole table in a Writer document.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fmergewithnext 5e Merges the border style and the shadow style of the current paragraph with the next paragraph.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fdistancemf 1e Enter the width of the shadow.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fshadows 2e Click a shadow style for the selected borders.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fshadowcolorlb 1f Select a colour for the shadow.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fbottommf 65 Enter the distance that you want to have between the bottom border and the contents of the selection.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fpresets 2a Select a predefined border style to apply.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fleftmf 63 Enter the distance that you want to have between the left border and the contents of the selection.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Flinestylelb 6b Click the border style that you want to apply. The style is applied to the borders selected in the preview.
1c cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fsync 5f Applies the same spacing to contents setting to all four borders when you enter a new distance.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Ftopmf 62 Enter the distance that you want to have between the top border and the contents of the selection.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2FBorderPage 43 Sets the border options for the selected objects in Writer or Calc.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Flinecolorlb 47 Select the line colour that you want to use for the selected border(s).
1f cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Frightmf 64 Enter the distance that you want to have between the right border and the contents of the selection.
18 SVX_HID_POPUP_COLOR_CTRL 74 Click a colour. Click No Fill to remove a background or highlighting colour. Click Automatic to reset a font colour.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Ftilerb 53 Repeats the graphic so that it covers the entire background of the selected object.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Farearb 4b Stretches the graphic to fill the entire background of the selected object.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2FBackgroundPage 25 Set the background colour or graphic.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fselectlb 35 Select the type of background that you want to apply.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Flink 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fpositionrb 43 Select this option, and then click a location in the position grid.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fbrowse 52 Locate the graphic file that you want to use as a background, and then click Open.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fbackgroundcolorset 64 Click the colour that you want to use as a background. To remove a background colour, click No Fill.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Ftablelb 40 Select the area that you want to apply the background colour to.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fshowpreview 34 Displays or hides a preview of the selected graphic.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FcomboLB_VERTALIGN 85 Select an alignment option for oversized or undersized characters in the paragraph relative to the rest of the text in the paragraph.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FcheckCB_SNAP 61 Aligns the paragraph to a text grid. To activate the text grid, choose Format - Page - Text Grid.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FcheckCB_EXPAND 74 If the last line of a justified paragraph consists of one word, the word is stretched to the width of the paragraph.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FradioBTN_LEFTALIGN 2d Aligns the paragraph to the left page margin.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FParaAlignPage 44 Sets the alignment of the paragraph relative to the margins of page.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FradioBTN_RIGHTALIGN 2e Aligns the paragraph to the right page margin.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Ftextdirectionlb 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FradioBTN_CENTERALIGN 32 Centres the contents of the paragraph on the page.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FcomboLB_LASTLINE 39 Specify the alignment for the last line in the paragraph.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FradioBTN_JUSTIFYALIGN 3f Aligns the paragraph to the left and to the right page margins.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Forigsize 32 Returns the selected graphic to its original size.
1c cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Fheight 28 Enter a height for the selected graphic.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Fheightzoom 39 Enter the height of the selected graphic as a percentage.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Fkeepscale 68 Maintains the original scale of the graphic when you crop, so that only the size of the graphic changes.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2FCropPage 5c Trims or scales the selected graphic. You can also restore the graphic to its original size.
1b cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Fwidth 27 Enter a width for the selected graphic.
1c cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Fbottom 151 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the bottom of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space below the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the vertical scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the vertical scale of the graphic.
19 cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Ftop 14e If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the top of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space above the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the vertical scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the vertical scale of the graphic.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Fkeepsize 123 Maintains the original size of the graphic when you crop, so that only the scale of the graphic changes. To reduce the scale of the graphic, select this option and enter negative values in the cropping boxes. To increase the scale of the graphic, enter positive values in the cropping boxes.
1a cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Fleft 161 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the left edge of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space to the left of the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the horizontal scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the horizontal scale of the graphic.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Fwidthzoom 39 Enter the width for the selected graphic as a percentage.
1b cui%2Fui%2Fcroppage%2Fright 163 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the right edge of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space to the right of the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the horizontal scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the horizontal scale of the graphic.
21 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fdesc 3c Describes the relevant formatting used in the current style.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fnamerw a7 Displays the name of the selected style. If you are creating or modifying a custom style, enter a name for the style. You cannot change the name of a predefined style.
2c sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2FManageStylePage 27 Set the options for the selected style.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fnextstyle 102 Select an existing style that you want to follow the current style in your document. For paragraph styles, the next style is applied to the paragraph that is created when you press Enter. For page styles, the next style is applied when a new page is created.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fcategory 7f Displays the category for the current style. If you are creating or modifying a new style, select 'Custom Style' from the list.
27 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fautoupdate b0 Updates the style when you apply direct formatting to a paragraph using this style in your document. The formatting of all paragraphs using this style is automatically updated.
27 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Flinkedwith 69 Select an existing style that you want to base the new style on, or select none to define your own style.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboLayoutFormat 51 Select the page numbering format that you want to use for the current page style.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboPageLayout 60 Specify whether the current style should show odd pages, even pages, or both odd and even pages.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FradiobuttonLandscape 4e Displays and prints the current document with the paper oriented horizontally.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinMargRight e8 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the document text. If you are using the Mirrored page layout, enter the amount of space to leave between the outer text margin and the outer edge of the page.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FradiobuttonPortrait 4c Displays and prints the current document with the paper oriented vertically.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinHeight 61 Displays the height of the selected paper format. To define a custom format, enter a height here.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinWidth 5f Displays the width of the selected paper format. To define a custom format, enter a width here.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FPageFormatPage 73 Allows you to define page layouts for single and multiple-page documents, as well as a numbering and paper formats.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinMargTop 5c Enter the amount of space to leave between the upper edge of the page and the document text.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboPaperTray ea Select the paper source for your printer. If you want, you can assign different paper trays to different page styles. For example, assign a different tray to the First Page style and load the tray with your company's letterhead paper.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboPageFormat 81 Select a predefined paper size, or create a custom format by entering the dimensions for the paper in the Height and Width boxes.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinMargLeft e7 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the document text. If you are using the Mirrored page layout, enter the amount of space to leave between the inner text margin and the inner edge of the page.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinMargBot 5c Enter the amount of space to leave between the lower edge of the page and the document text.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcheckbuttonVert 0 
2d cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcheckRegisterTrue 43 Aligns the text on the selected Page Style to a vertical page grid.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboRegisterStyle dd Select the Paragraph Style that you want to use as a reference for lining up the text on the selected Page style. The height of the font that is specified in the reference style sets the spacing of the vertical page grid.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcheckAdaptBox 86 Resizes the drawing objects so that they fit on the paper format that you select. The arrangement of the drawing objects is preserved.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboTextFlowBox 40 Select the text direction that you want to use in your document.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcheckbuttonHorz 0 
2a svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FbuttonEdit 0 
2c svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckAutofit 51 Automatically adjusts the height of the header to fit the content that you enter.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FspinHeight 2e Enter the height that you want for the header.
2f svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckDynSpacing 76 Overrides the Spacing setting, and allows the header to expand into the area between the header and the document text.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FbuttonMore 4e Defines a border, a background colour, or a background pattern for the header.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FspinSpacing 80 Enter the amount of space that you want to maintain between the bottom edge of the header and the top edge of the document text.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckHeaderOn 28 Adds a header to the current page style.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckSameLR 2a Even and odd pages share the same content.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckSameFP 30 First and even/odd pages share the same content.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FHFFormatPage 7b Adds a header to the current page style. A header is an area in the top page margin, in which you can add text or graphics.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FspinMargLeft 60 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left page margin and the left edge of the header.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FspinMargRight 62 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right page margin and the right edge of the header.
12 HID_SC_FOOTER_EDIT 0 
19 SVX_HID_FOOTER_BUTTONMORE 4e Defines a border, a background colour, or a background pattern for the footer.
1e SVX_HID_FOOTER_CHECKDYNSPACING 71 Overrides the Spacing setting and allows the footer to expand into the area between the footer and document text.
1b SVX_HID_FOOTER_CHECKAUTOFIT 4c Automatically adjusts the height of the footer to fit the content you enter.
19 SVX_HID_FOOTER_SPINHEIGHT 29 Enter the height you want for the footer.
1a SVX_HID_FOOTER_SPINSPACING 80 Enter the amount of space that you want to maintain between the bottom edge of the document text and the top edge of the footer.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckFooterOn 28 Adds a footer to the current page style.
15 SC_HID_SC_FOOTER_EDIT 18 Add or edit footer text.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FHFFormatPage 7b Adds a footer to the current page style. A footer is an area in the bottom page margin, where you can add text or graphics.
1c SVX_HID_FOOTER_SPINMARGRIGHT 67 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the right edge of the footer.
1a SVX_HID_FOOTER_CHECKSAMEFP 30 First and even/odd pages share the same content.
1a SVX_HID_FOOTER_CHECKSAMELR 2a Even and odd pages share the same content.
1b SVX_HID_FOOTER_SPINMARGLEFT 65 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the left edge of the footer.
1b .uno%3AChangeCaseToKatakana 3d Changes the selected Asian characters to Katakana characters.
1b .uno%3AChangeCaseToHiragana 3d Changes the selected Asian characters to Hiragana characters.
1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToHalfWidth 3f Changes the selected Asian characters to half-width characters.
1d .uno%3AChangeCaseToToggleCase 30 Toggles case of all selected Western characters.
1a SID_TRANSLITERATE_SENTENCE 57 Changes the first letter of the selected Western characters to an upper-case character.
18 .uno%3ATransliterateMenu 86 Changes the case of characters in the selection, or if the cursor is in a word, changes the case of all of the characters in the word.
18 .uno%3AChangeCaseToUpper 41 Changes the selected Western characters to upper-case characters.
1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToFullWidth 3f Changes the selected Asian characters to full-width characters.
18 SID_TRANSLITERATE_TOGGLE 30 Toggles case of all selected Western characters.
1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToTitleCase 68 Changes the first character of every word of the selected Western characters to an upper-case character.
1c SID_TRANSLITERATE_CAPITALIZE 68 Changes the first character of every word of the selected Western characters to an upper-case character.
1f .uno%3AChangeCaseToSentenceCase 57 Changes the first letter of the selected Western characters to an upper-case character.
18 .uno%3AChangeCaseToLower 41 Changes the selected Western characters to lower-case characters.
30 svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2Fpositionlb 2d Select where you want to place the ruby text.
2e svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FRight4ED 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FLeft4ED 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here.
11 .uno%3ARubyDialog 54 Allows you to add comments above Asian characters to serve as a pronunciation guide.
2e svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2Fadjustlb 32 Select the horizontal alignment for the Ruby text.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2Fstyles 5e Opens the Styles deck of the Sidebar where you can select a character style for the ruby text.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2Fstylelb 2b Select a character style for the ruby text.
15 .uno%3AAlignFrameMenu 34 Aligns selected objects with respect to one another.
10 .uno%3AAlignLeft a1 Aligns the left edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the left edge of the object is aligned to the left page margin.
1c .uno%3AAlignHorizontalCenter a7 Horizontally centres the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the centre of the object is aligned to the horizontal centre of the page.
11 .uno%3AAlignRight a4 Aligns the right edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Impress or Draw, the right edge of the object is aligned to the right page margin.
f .uno%3AAlignTop ab Vertically aligns the top edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the top edge of the object is aligned to the upper page margin.
1a .uno%3AAlignVerticalCenter a3 Vertically centres the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the centre of the object is aligned to the vertical centre of the page.
12 .uno%3AAlignBottom b1 Vertically aligns the bottom edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the bottom edge of the object is aligned to the lower page margin.
10 .uno%3AAlignDown b1 Vertically aligns the bottom edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the bottom edge of the object is aligned to the lower page margin.
f .uno%3ALeftPara 39 Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the left page margin.
10 .uno%3ARightPara 3a Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the right page margin.
11 .uno%3ACenterPara 2e Centres the selected paragraph(s) on the page.
12 .uno%3AJustifyPara cd Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the left and the right page margins. If you want, you can also specify the alignment options for the last line of a paragraph by choosing Format - Paragraph - Alignment.
11 .uno%3AMergeCells 45 Combines the contents of the selected table cells into a single cell.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fsplitcellsdialog%2Fprop 27 Splits cells into rows of equal height.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fsplitcellsdialog%2Fcountnf 55 Enter the number of rows or columns that you want to split the selected cell(s) into.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fsplitcellsdialog%2Fhori 60 Splits the selected cell(s) into the number of rows that you specify in the Split cell into box.
10 .uno%3ASplitCell 65 Splits the cell or group of cells horizontally or vertically into the number of cells that you enter.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fsplitcellsdialog%2Fvert 63 Splits the selected cell(s) into the number of columns that you specify in the Split cell into box.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fsplitcellsdialog%2FSplitCellsDialog 65 Splits the cell or group of cells horizontally or vertically into the number of cells that you enter.
12 .uno%3ACellVertTop 3c Aligns the contents of the cell to the top edge of the cell.
15 .uno%3ACellVertCenter 44 Centres the contents of the cell between top and bottom of the cell.
15 .uno%3ACellVertBottom 3f Aligns the contents of the cell to the bottom edge of the cell.
b .uno%3ABold 9c Makes the selected text bold. If the cursor is in a word, the entire word is made bold. If the selection or word is already bold, the formatting is removed.
d .uno%3AItalic a2 Makes the selected text italic. If the cursor is in a word, the entire word is made italic. If the selection or word is already italic, the formatting is removed.
16 .uno%3AUnderlineDouble 2c Underlines the selected text with two lines.
10 .uno%3AUnderline 39 Underlines or removes underlining from the selected text.
10 .uno%3AStrikeout 57 Draws a line through the selected text, or if the cursor is in a word, the entire word.
f .uno%3AShadowed 56 Adds a shadow to the selected text, or if the cursor is in a word, to the entire word.
15 .uno%3ADistributeRows 60 Adjusts the height of the selected rows to match the height of the tallest row in the selection.
12 .uno%3ASuperScript 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and raises the text above the baseline.
10 .uno%3ASubScript 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and lowers the text below the baseline.
12 .uno%3ALineSpacing 4a Specify the amount of space to leave between lines of text in a paragraph.
11 .uno%3ASpacePara1 52 Applies single line spacing to the current paragraph. This is the default setting.
12 .uno%3ASpacePara15 45 Sets the line spacing of the current paragraph to one and half lines.
11 .uno%3ASpacePara2 3c Sets the line spacing of the current paragraph to two lines.
18 .uno%3ADistributeColumns 63 Adjusts the width of the selected columns to match the width of the widest column in the selection.
1f sfx%2Fui%2Fnewstyle%2Fstylename 1f Enter a name for the new Style.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fstringinput%2Fedit 37 Enter a name for the new AutoFormat, and then click OK.
18 HID_SD_NAMEDIALOG_OBJECT 50 Enter a name for the selected object. The name will be visible in the Navigator.
13 .uno%3ARenameObject 60 Assigns a name to the selected object, so that you can quickly find the object in the Navigator.
1d .uno%3AObjectTitleDescription 9c Assigns a title and a description to the selected object. These are accessible for accessibility tools and as alternative tags when you export the document.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fobjecttitledescdialog%2Fdesc_entry e3 Enter a description text. The long description text can be entered to describe a complex object or group of objects to users with screen reader software. The description is visible as an alternative tag for accessibility tools.
35 cui%2Fui%2Fobjecttitledescdialog%2Fobject_title_entry 7c Enter a title text. This short name is visible as an alternative tag in HTML format. Accessibility tools can read this text.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fobjecttitledescdialog%2FObjectTitleDescDialog 9c Assigns a title and a description to the selected object. These are accessible for accessibility tools and as alternative tags when you export the document.
11 .uno%3AFormatLine 32 Sets the formatting options for the selected line.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_CAP_STYLE 52 Select the style of the line end caps. The caps are added to inner dashes as well.
21 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_COLOR 1d Select a colour for the line.
10 .uno%3ALineWidth 99 Select the width for the line. You can append a measurement unit. A zero line width results in a hairline with a width of one pixel of the output medium.
26 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_EDGE_STYLE 91 Select the shape to be used at the corners of the line. In case of a small angle between lines, a mitred shape is replaced with a bevelled shape.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FCB_SYMBOL_RATIO 53 Maintains the proportions of the symbol when you enter a new height or width value.
11 .uno%3AXLineColor 1d Select a colour for the line.
26 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_LINE_STYLE 2b Select the line style that you want to use.
29 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMB_SYMBOL_BITMAP 3b Select the symbol style that you want to use in your chart.
11 .uno%3AXLineStyle 2b Select the line style that you want to use.
2b cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_LINE_WIDTH 99 Select the width for the line. You can append a measurement unit. A zero line width results in a hairline with a width of one pixel of the output medium.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_END_STYLE 41 Select the arrowhead that you want to apply to the selected line.
24 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLineTabPage 93 Set the formatting options for the selected line or the line that you want to draw. You can also add arrowheads to a line, or change chart symbols.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FTSB_CENTER_END 4e Places the centre of the arrowhead(s) on the endpoint(s) of the selected line.
2d cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMTR_LINE_TRANSPARENT 71 Enter the transparency of the line, where 100% corresponds to completely transparent and 0% to completely opaque.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMF_SYMBOL_WIDTH 1d Enter a width for the symbol.
29 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMF_SYMBOL_HEIGHT 1e Enter a height for the symbol.
2a cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_END_WIDTH 20 Enter a width for the arrowhead.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FCBX_SYNCHRONIZE 8a Automatically updates both arrowhead settings when you enter a different width, select a different arrowhead style,or centre an arrowhead.
26 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FBTN_SAVE 4b Saves the current list of line styles, so that you can load it again later.
26 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FBTN_LOAD 1e Imports a list of line styles.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FBTN_MODIFY 8a Updates the selected line style using the current settings. To change the name of the selected line style, enter a new name when prompted.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fnamedialog%2FNameDialog d Enter a name.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FBTN_ADD 34 Creates a new line style using the current settings.
2d cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FCBX_SYNCHRONIZE 45 Automatically adjusts the entries relative to the length of the line.
c HID_LINE_DEF 2c Edit or create dashed or dotted line styles.
2e cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FMTR_FLD_LENGTH_2 1d Enter the length of the dash.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FLB_TYPE_2 38 Select the combination of dashes and dots that you want.
2e cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FMTR_FLD_DISTANCE 48 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between dots or dashes.
2b cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FLB_LINESTYLES 31 Select the style of line that you want to create.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FNUM_FLD_2 50 Enter the number of times that you want a dot or a dash to appear in a sequence.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FBTN_SAVE 46 Saves the current list of arrow styles, so that you can load it later.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FEDT_NAME 2e Displays the name of the selected arrow style.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FBTN_LOAD 1f Imports a list of arrow styles.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FLineEndPage 1c Edit or create arrow styles.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FLB_LINEENDS 39 Choose a predefined arrow style symbol from the list box.
24 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FBTN_ADD 5d To define a custom arrow style, select a drawing object in the document, and then click here.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FBTN_MODIFY 2d Changes the name of the selected arrow style.
11 .uno%3AFormatArea 38 Sets the fill properties of the selected drawing object.
10 .uno%3AFillStyle 4e Select the type of fill that you want to apply to the selected drawing object.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2Fbtnhatch 3f Fills the object with a hatching pattern selected on this page.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2Fbtnnone 20 Do not fill the selected object.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2Fbtnpattern 48 Fills the object with a simple two-colour pattern selected on this page.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FAreaTabPage 35 Set the fill options for the selected drawing object.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2Fbtncolor 35 Fills the object with a colour selected on this page.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2Fbtnbitmap 3d Fills the object with a bitmap pattern selected on this page.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2Fbtngradient 37 Fills the object with a gradient selected on this page.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fmodify 80 Applies the current gradient properties to the selected gradient. If you want, you can save the gradient under a different name.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcolortomtr 72 Enter the intensity for the colour in the To box, where 0% corresponds to black, and 100 % to the selected colour.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcolortolb 31 Select a colour for the endpoint of the gradient.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fadd 6f Adds a custom gradient to the current list. Specify the properties of your gradient, and then click this button
26 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcolorfrommtr 74 Enter the intensity for the colour in the From box, where 0% corresponds to black, and 100 % to the selected colour.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcolorfromlb 38 Select a colour for the beginning point of the gradient.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fgradienttypelb 2b Select the gradient that you want to apply.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fbordermtr 9f Enter the amount by which you want to adjust the area of the endpoint colour on the gradient. The endpoint colour is the colour that is selected in the To box.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2FGradientPage 42 Set the properties of a gradient, or save and load gradient lists.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcenterymtr cb Enter the vertical offset for the gradient, where 0% corresponds to the current vertical location of the endpoint colour in the gradient. The endpoint colour is the colour that is selected in the To box.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcenterxmtr cf Enter the horizontal offset for the gradient, where 0% corresponds to the current horizontal location of the endpoint colour in the gradient. The endpoint colour is the colour that is selected in the To box.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fanglemtr 31 Enter a rotation angle for the selected gradient.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fmodify 87 Applies the current hatching properties to the selected hatching pattern. If you want, you can save the pattern under a different name.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fdistancemtr 48 Enter the amount of space that you want to have between the hatch lines.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2FHatchPage 4a Set the properties of a hatching pattern, or save and load hatching lists.
1a cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fadd 80 Adds a custom hatching pattern to the current list. Specify the properties of your hatching pattern, and then click this button.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fanglemtr 54 Enter the rotation angle for the hatch lines, or click a position in the angle grid.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Flinetypelb 34 Select the type of hatch lines that you want to use.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Flinecolorlb 25 Select the colour of the hatch lines.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FBTN_IMPORT 80 Locate the bitmap that you want to import, and then click Open. The bitmap is added to the end of the list of available bitmaps.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FBitmapTabPage 95 Select a bitmap that you want to use as a fill pattern, or create your own pixel pattern. You can also import bitmaps, and save or load bitmap lists.
11 .uno%3AFillShadow c9 Adds a shadow to the selected object. If the object already has a shadow, the shadow is removed. If you click this icon when no object is selected, the shadow is added to the next object that you draw.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fshadowtabpage%2FTSB_SHOW_SHADOW 2d Adds a shadow to the selected drawing object.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fshadowtabpage%2FCTL_POSITION 28 Click where you want to cast the shadow.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fshadowtabpage%2FShadowTabPage 55 Add a shadow to the selected drawing object, and define the properties of the shadow.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fshadowtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_DISTANCE 52 Enter the distance that you want the shadow to be offset from the selected object.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fshadowtabpage%2FLB_SHADOW_COLOR 1f Select a colour for the shadow.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fshadowtabpage%2FMTR_SHADOW_TRANSPARENT 64 Enter a percentage from 0% (opaque) to 100% (transparent) to specify the transparency of the shadow.
35 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_START_VALUE 7b Enter a transparency value for the beginning point of the gradient, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.
30 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_BORDER 6b Enter the amount by which you want to adjust the transparent area of the gradient. The default value is 0%.
33 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_END_VALUE 74 Enter a transparency value for the endpoint of the gradient, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.
2f cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_ANGLE 28 Enter a rotation angle for the gradient.
32 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_CENTER_Y 2b Enter the vertical offset for the gradient.
2e cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FRBT_TRANS_OFF 1e Turns off colour transparency.
37 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FLB_TRGR_GRADIENT_TYPES 40 Select the type of transparency gradient that you want to apply.
32 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_CENTER_X 2d Enter the horizontal offset for the gradient.
31 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FRBT_TRANS_LINEAR 8d Turns on colour transparency. Select this option, and then enter a number in the box, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.
30 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRANSPARENT 6f Adjusts the transparency of the current fill colour. Enter a number between 0% (opaque) and 100% (transparent).
34 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FTransparencyTabPage 50 Set the transparency options for the fill that you apply to the selected object.
33 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FRBT_TRANS_GRADIENT 75 Applies a transparency gradient to the current fill colour. Select this option, and then set the gradient properties.
2b cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_FULL_WIDTH 48 Anchors the text to the full width of the drawing object or text object.
2b cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_BOTTOM 7a Enter the amount of space to leave between the bottom edge of the drawing or text object and the lower border of the text.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_TOP 77 Enter the amount of space to leave between the top edge of the drawing or text object and the upper border of the text.
2a cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_RIGHT 79 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the drawing or text object and the right border of the text.
2e cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_AUTOGROW_SIZE 56 Resizes a custom shape to fit the text that you enter after double-clicking the shape.
2e cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_WORDWRAP_TEXT 59 Wraps the text that you add after double-clicking a custom shape to fit inside the shape.
2f cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTextAttributesPage 59 Sets the layout and anchoring properties for text in the selected drawing or text object.
29 cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FCTL_POSITION 36 Click where you want to place the anchor for the text.
2f cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_AUTOGROW_WIDTH 61 Expands the width of the object to the width of the text, if the object is smaller than the text.
2c cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_FIT_TO_SIZE 46 Resizes the text to fit the entire area of the drawing or text object.
29 cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_LEFT 77 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the drawing or text object and the left border of the text.
30 cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_AUTOGROW_HEIGHT 63 Expands the height of the object to the height of the text, if the object is smaller than the text.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_CONTOUR 54 Adapts the text flow so that it matches the contours of the selected drawing object.
16 .uno%3ATransformDialog 37 Resizes, moves, rotates, or slants the selected object.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FTSB_AUTOGROW_HEIGHT 63 Expands the height of the object to the height of the text, if the object is smaller than the text.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FTSB_SIZEPROTECT 26 Prevents you from resizing the object.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FCBX_SCALE 3a Maintains proportions when you resize the selected object.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FTSB_AUTOGROW_WIDTH 61 Expands the width of the object to the width of the text, if the object is smaller than the text.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FCTL_SIZERECT 7d Click a base point in the grid, and then enter the new size dimensions for the selected object in the Width and Height boxes.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_POS_X 6f Enter the horizontal distance that you want to move the object relative to the base point selected in the grid.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_POS_Y 6d Enter the vertical distance that you want to move the object relative to the base point selected in the grid.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FCTL_POSRECT f2 Click a base point in the grid, and then enter the amount that you want to shift the object relative to the base point that you selected in the Position Y and Position X boxes. The base points correspond to the selection handles on an object.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FPositionAndSize 25 Resizes or moves the selected object.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FTSB_POSPROTECT 44 Prevents changes to the position or the size of the selected object.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_WIDTH 26 Enter a width for the selected object.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_HEIGHT 27 Enter a height for the selected object.
25 cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FNF_ANGLE 48 Enter the number of degrees that you want to rotate the selected object.
26 cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FCTL_ANGLE 3f Click to specify the rotation angle in multiples of 45 degrees.
25 cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FCTL_RECT 2e Click where you want to place the pivot point.
2a cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_POS_Y 4d Enter the vertical distance from the top edge of the page to the pivot point.
25 cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FRotation 1c Rotates the selected object.
2a cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_POS_X 50 Enter the horizontal distance from the left edge of the page to the pivot point.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fslantcornertabpage%2FMTR_FLD_ANGLE 22 Enter the angle of the slant axis.
34 cui%2Fui%2Fslantcornertabpage%2FSlantAndCornerRadius 4a Slants the selected object, or rounds the corners of a rectangular object.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fslantcornertabpage%2FMTR_FLD_RADIUS 49 Enter the radius of the circle that you want to use to round the corners.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fcalloutpage%2Foptimal 3d Click here to display a single-angled line in an optimal way.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fcalloutpage%2Fposition 56 Select where you want to extend the callout line from, in relation to the callout box.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fcalloutpage%2Flength 73 Enter the length of the callout line segment that extends from the callout box to the inflection point of the line.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fcalloutpage%2Fvalueset 47 Click the Callout style that you want to apply to the selected callout.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fcalloutpage%2Fspacing 6a Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the end of the callout line, and the callout box.
f .uno%3AFlipMenu 36 Flips the selected object horizontally, or vertically.
11 .uno%3AMirrorVert 3b Flips the selected object(s) vertically from top to bottom.
1d .uno%3AObjectMirrorHorizontal 3d Flips the selected object(s) horizontally from left to right.
15 .uno%3AObjectPosition 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s).
13 .uno%3ABringToFront 64 Moves the selected object to the top of the stacking order, so that it is in front of other objects.
17 .uno%3AObjectForwardOne 5e Moves the selected object up one level, so that it is closer to the top of the stacking order.
e .uno%3AForward 5e Moves the selected object up one level, so that it is closer to the top of the stacking order.
14 .uno%3AObjectBackOne 63 Moves the selected object down one level, so that it is closer to the bottom of the stacking order.
f .uno%3ABackward 63 Moves the selected object down one level, so that it is closer to the bottom of the stacking order.
11 .uno%3ASendToBack 66 Moves the selected object to the bottom of the stacking order, so that it is behind the other objects.
1c .uno%3ASetObjectToForeground 2b Moves the selected object in front of text.
1c .uno%3ASetObjectToBackground 26 Moves the selected object behind text.
11 .uno%3AAnchorMenu 33 Sets the anchoring options for the selected object.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToPage 2e Anchors the selected item to the current page.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToPara 33 Anchors the selected item to the current paragraph.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorAtChar 29 Anchors the selected item to a character.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToChar 29 Anchors the selected item to a character.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToCell 24 Anchors the selected item to a cell.
17 .uno%3ASetAnchorToFrame 33 Anchors the selected item to the surrounding frame.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToChar c0 Anchors the selected item as a character in the current text. If the height of the selected item is greater than the current font size, the height of the line containing the item is increased.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorAsChar c0 Anchors the selected item as a character in the current text. If the height of the selected item is greater than the current font size, the height of the line containing the item is increased.
1d .uno%3AToggleObjectBezierMode 39 Lets you change the shape of the selected drawing object.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fdistancey 53 Enter the vertical distance between the text characters and the edge of the shadow.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fslant a2 Adds a slant shadow to the text in the selected object. Click this button, and then enter the dimensions of the shadow in the Distance X and the Distance Y boxes.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fnoshadow 38 Removes the shadow effects that you applied to the text.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fvertical 9c Adds a shadow to the text in the selected object. Click this button, and then enter the dimensions of the shadow in the Distance X and the Distance Y boxes.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Frotate 4c Uses the top or the bottom edge of the selected object as the text baseline.
21 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fhori 36 Horizontally slants the characters in the text object.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fdistancex 55 Enter the horizontal distance between the text characters and the edge of the shadow.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fupright 97 Uses the top or the bottom edge of the selected object as the text baseline and preserves the original vertical alignment of the individual characters.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Forientation 9c Reverses the text flow direction, and flips the text horizontally or vertically. To use this command, you must first apply a different baseline to the text.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Findent 6c Enter the amount of space to leave between the beginning of the text baseline and the beginning of the text.
f .uno%3AFontWork 6c Edits Fontwork effects of the selected object that has been created with the previous Fontwork dialogue box.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fautosize 38 Resizes the text to fit the length of the text baseline.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fcolor 24 Select a colour for the text shadow.
16 HID_FONTWORK_CTL_FORMS 42 Click the shape of the baseline that you want to use for the text.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Ftextcontour 44 Shows or hides the borders of the individual characters in the text.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Foff 1c Removes baseline formatting.
21 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fvert 34 Vertically slants the characters in the text object.
21 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fleft 35 Aligns the text to the left end of the text baseline.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fcenter 26 Centres the text on the text baseline.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fright 36 Aligns the text to the right end of the text baseline.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fdistance 75 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the text baseline and the base of the individual characters.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingfontwork%2Fcontour 45 Shows or hides the text baseline or the edges of the selected object.
10 .uno%3AGroupMenu 61 Groups keep together selected objects, so that they can be moved or formatted as a single object.
12 .uno%3AFormatGroup 4a Groups the selected objects, so that they can be moved as a single object.
14 .uno%3AFormatUngroup 38 Breaks apart the selected group into individual objects.
11 .uno%3AEnterGroup a1 Opens the selected group, so that you can edit the individual objects. If the selected group contains nested group, you can repeat this command on the subgroups.
11 .uno%3ALeaveGroup 54 Exits the group, so that you can no longer edit the individual objects in the group.
25 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTSB_AUTO c7 $[officename] automatically determines the amount of time to wait before repeating the effect. To manually assign the delay period, unmark this check box, and then enter a value in the Automatic box.
2b cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_AMOUNT 3b Enter the number of increments by which to scroll the text.
2a cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FNUM_FLD_COUNT 47 Enter the number of times that you want the animation effect to repeat.
2a cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_DELAY 3d Enter the amount of time to wait before repeating the effect.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FLB_EFFECT 8f Select the animation effect that you want to apply to the text in the selected drawing object. To remove an animation effect, select No Effect.
25 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FBTN_LEFT 20 Scrolls text from right to left.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FBTN_RIGHT 20 Scrolls text from left to right.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTSB_PIXEL 23 Measures increment value in pixels.
2c cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTSB_STOP_INSIDE 31 Text remains visible after the effect is applied.
2a cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTextAnimation 44 Adds an animation effect to the text in the selected drawing object.
23 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FBTN_UP 20 Scrolls text from bottom to top.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTSB_ENDLESS 9c Plays the animation effect continuously. To specify the number of times to play the effect, unmark this check box, and enter a number in the Continuous box.
2d cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTSB_START_INSIDE 49 Text is visible and inside the drawing object when the effect is applied.
25 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FBTN_DOWN 20 Scrolls text from top to bottom.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Frowheightdialog%2Fdefault c1 Adjusts the row height to the size based on the default template. Existing contents may be shown vertically cropped. The height no longer increases automatically when you enter larger contents.
38 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Frowheightdialog%2FRowHeightDialog 3c Changes the height of the current row, or the selected rows.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Frowheightdialog%2Fvalue 2a Enter the row height that you want to use.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fcolwidthdialog%2Fdefault 41 Automatically adjusts the column width based on the current font.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fcolwidthdialog%2FColWidthDialog 41 Changes the width of the current column, or the selected columns.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fcolwidthdialog%2Fvalue 2c Enter the column width that you want to use.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FspinIndentFrom 44 Indents from the left edge of the cell by the amount that you enter.
f .uno%3AAlignTop 3e Aligns the contents of the cell to the upper edge of the cell.
11 .uno%3AAlignRight 2d Aligns the contents of the cell to the right.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcheckShrinkFitCellSize aa Reduces the apparent size of the font so that the contents of the cell fit into the current cell width. You cannot apply this command to a cell that contains line breaks.
11 .uno%3AAlignBlock 4a Aligns the contents of the cell to the left and to the right cell borders.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2Fdialcontrol 2e Click in the dial to set the text orientation.
10 .uno%3AAlignLeft 2c Aligns the contents of the cell to the left.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FCellAlignPage 56 Sets the alignment options for the content of the current cell, or the selected cells.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcomboboxHorzAlign 52 Select the horizontal alignment option that you want to apply to the cell content.
13 .uno%3AAlignVCenter 2e Sets the text orientation of the cell content.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcomboboxVertAlign 32 Aligns the cell content to the bottom of the cell.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FspinDegrees a2 Enter the rotation angle for the text in the selected cell(s). A positive number rotates the text to the left and a negative number rotates the text to the right.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2Freferences 3b Specify the cell edge from which to write the rotated text.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcheckVertStack 17 Aligns text vertically.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcheckWrapTextAuto 66 Wraps text onto another line at the cell border. The number of lines depends on the width of the cell.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcheckHyphActive 3c Enables word hyphenation for text wrapping to the next line.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcheckAsianMode 133 Aligns Asian characters one below the other in the selected cell(s). If the cell contains more than one line of text, the lines are converted to text columns that are arranged from right to left. Western characters in the converted text are rotated 90 degrees to the right. Asian characters are not rotated.
1c SVX_HID_GRID_NUMBEROFRECORDS b7 Displays the number of records. For example, "Record 7 of 9(2)" indicates that two records (2) are selected in a table containing 9 records, and that the cursor is in record number 7.
19 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_FIRST 24 Go to the first record in the table.
1b DBACCESS_HID_CTL_TABBROWSER 87 Select database records. Drag-and-drop rows or cells to the document to insert contents. Drag-and-drop column headers to insert fields.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_PREV 27 Go to the previous record in the table.
17 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEW 2c Inserts a new record into the current table.
1c SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_ABSOLUTE 4d Type the number of the record that you want to display, and then press Enter.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEXT 23 Go to the next record in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_LAST 23 Go to the last record in the table.
17 HID_BROWSER_TABLEFORMAT 1c Formats the selected row(s).
18 HID_BROWSER_COLUMNFORMAT 1f Formats the selected column(s).
f .uno%3AWindow3D 42 Specifies the properties of 3-D object(s) in the current document.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fdoublesided 62 Closes the shape of a 3-D object that was created by extruding a freeform line (Convert - To 3-D).
29 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fobjspecific 81 Renders the 3-D surface according to the shape of the object. For example, a circular shape is rendered with a spherical surface.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fdiagonal 53 Enter the amount by which you want to round the corners of the selected 3-D object.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fscaleddepth 68 Enter the amount by which to increase or decrease the area of the front side of the selected 3-D object.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Finvertnormals 19 Inverts the light source.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fspherical 1d Renders a smooth 3-D surface.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fveri 50 Enter the number of vertical segments to use in the selected 3-D rotation object
26 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fgeometry 10f Adjusts the shape of the selected 3-D object. You can only modify the shape of a -3D object that was created by converting a 2-D object. To convert a 2-D object to 3-D, select the object, right-click, and then choose Convert - To 3-D, or Convert - To 3-D Rotation Object.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fflat 24 Renders the 3-D surface as polygons.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fangle 46 Enter the angle in degrees to rotate the selected 3-D rotation object.
2e svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fdoublesidedillum 8f Lights the object from the outside and the inside. To use an ambient light source, click this button, and then click the Invert Normals button.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fhori 53 Enter the number of horizontal segments to use in the selected 3-D rotation object.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fdepth 69 Enter the extrusion depth for the selected 3-D object. This option is not valid for 3-D rotation objects.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fslant 3b Enter an angle from 0 to 90 degrees for casting the shadow.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ffocal 81 Enter the focal length of the camera, where a small value corresponds to a "fisheye" lens, and a large value to a telephoto lens.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fdistance 55 Enter the distance to leave between the camera and the centre of the selected object.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fshadow 36 Adds or removes a shadow from the selected 3-D object.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Frepresentation 40 Sets the shading and shadow options for the selected 3-D object.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fmode 138 Select the shading method that you want to use. Flat shading assigns a single colour to a single polygon on the surface of the object. Gouraud shading blends colours across the polygons. Phong shading averages the colour of each pixel based on the pixels that surround it, and requires the most processing power.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fambientcolor 26 Select a colour for the ambient light.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Flightcolor1 2d Select a colour for the current light source.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Flight 34 Define the light source for the selected 3-D object.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Flight8 d3 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a colour for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the colour of the surrounding light, by selecting a colour from the Ambient light box.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexfilter 37 Blurs the texture slightly to remove unwanted speckles.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexcircley 3f Wraps the vertical axis of the texture pattern around a sphere.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexcirclex 41 Wraps the horizontal axis of the texture pattern around a sphere.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexobjy 4c Automatically adjusts the texture based on the shape and size of the object.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexparallelx 34 Applies the texture parallel to the horizontal axis.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftextype 28 Converts the texture to black and white.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexparallely 32 Applies the texture parallel to the vertical axis.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexture 121 Sets the properties of the surface texture for the selected 3-D object. This feature is only available after you apply a surface texture to the selected object. To quickly apply a surface texture, open the Gallery, hold down Shift+Ctrl, and then drag an image onto the selected 3-D object.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexcolor 1f Converts the texture to colour.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexmodulate 7f Applies the texture with shading. To define the shading options for the texture, click the Shading button in this dialogue box.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexreplace 24 Applies the texture without shading.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ftexobjx 4c Automatically adjusts the texture based on the shape and size of the object.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fintensity 2b Enter the intensity of the specular effect.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fspeccolor 36 Select the colour that you want the object to reflect.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fmaterial 31 Changes the colouring of the selected 3-D object.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fillumcolor 2b Select the colour to illuminate the object.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Fobjcolor 37 Select the colour that you want to apply to the object.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fdocking3deffects%2Ffavorites 5b Select a predefined colour scheme, or select User-defined to define a custom colour scheme.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fdistributionpage%2Fverbottom 6d Distributes the selected objects, so that the bottom edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fdistributionpage%2Fvertop 6a Distributes the selected objects, so that the top edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fdistributionpage%2Fvernone 2b Does not distribute the objects vertically.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fdistributionpage%2Fhornone 2d Does not distribute the objects horizontally.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fdistributionpage%2Fhorleft 6b Distributes the selected objects, so that the left edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fdistributionpage%2Fhorcenter 73 Distributes the selected objects, so that the horizontal centres of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fdistributionpage%2Fvercenter 71 Distributes the selected objects, so that the vertical centres of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
1a .uno%3ADistributeSelection 9d Distributes three or more selected objects evenly along the horizontal axis or the vertical axis. You can also evenly distribute the spacing between objects.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fdistributionpage%2Fhordistance 66 Distributes the selected objects horizontally, so that the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fdistributionpage%2Fverdistance 64 Distributes the selected objects vertically, so that the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fdistributionpage%2Fhorright 6c Distributes the selected objects, so that the right edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
15 .uno%3ATextAttributes 59 Sets the layout and anchoring properties for text in the selected drawing or text object.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fundo 74 Click to undo the last change in the current sentence. Click again to undo the previous change in the same sentence.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fchangeall 49 Replaces all occurrences of the unknown word with the current suggestion.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fignorerule 74 While performing a grammar check, click Ignore Rule to ignore the rule that is currently flagged as a grammar error.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fadd 33 Adds the unknown word to a user-defined dictionary.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Foptions 75 Opens a dialogue box, in which you can select the user-defined dictionaries, and set the rules for checking spelling.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fautocorrect 72 Adds the current combination of the incorrect word and the replacement word to the AutoCorrect replacements table.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fignoreall 7f Skips all occurrences of the unknown word until the end of the current %PRODUCTNAME session and continues with the spell check.
1f .uno%3ASpellingAndGrammarDialog a0 Checks the document or the current selection for spelling errors. If a grammar checking extension is installed, the dialogue box also checks for grammar errors.
f .uno%3ASpelling a0 Checks the document or the current selection for spelling errors. If a grammar checking extension is installed, the dialogue box also checks for grammar errors.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2FSpellingDialog a0 Checks the document or the current selection for spelling errors. If a grammar checking extension is installed, the dialogue box also checks for grammar errors.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fignore 3a Skips the unknown word and continues with the spell check.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Flanguagelb 34 Specifies the language to use to check the spelling.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fsentence 8f Displays the sentence with the misspelt word highlighted. Edit the word or the sentence, or click one of the suggestions in the text box below.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fsuggestionslb 82 Lists suggested words to replace the misspelled word. Select the word that you want to use, and then click Correct or Correct All.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fchange 88 Replaces the unknown word with the current suggestion. If you changed more than just the misspelt word, the entire sentence is replaced.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fspellingdialog%2Fcheckgrammar 54 Mark Check grammar to work first on all spelling errors, then on all grammar errors.
17 .uno%3AMoreDictionaries 3d Opens the default browser on the dictionaries extension page.
1d .uno%3ASetLanguageAllTextMenu ab Opens a sub-menu. Choose a language for all text. Choose None to exclude all text from spell checking and hyphenation.Choose More to open a dialogue box with more options.
1f .uno%3ASetLanguageParagraphMenu c5 Opens a sub-menu. Choose a language for the current paragraph. Choose None to exclude the current paragraph from spell checking and hyphenation.Choose More to open a dialogue box with more options.
13 .uno%3ALanguageMenu 46 Opens a sub-menu from which you can choose language-specific commands.
1f .uno%3ASetLanguageSelectionMenu bd Opens a sub-menu. Choose a language for the selected text. Choose None to exclude the selected text from spell checking and hyphenation.Choose More to open a dialogue box with more options.
30 svx%2Fui%2Fchineseconversiondialog%2Fcommonterms a3 Converts words with two or more characters that are in the list of common terms. After the list is scanned, the remaining text is converted character by character.
32 svx%2Fui%2Fchineseconversiondialog%2Ftotraditional b3 Converts simplified Chinese text characters to traditional Chinese text characters. Click OK to convert the selected text. If no text is selected, the whole document is converted.
2e svx%2Fui%2Fchineseconversiondialog%2Feditterms 5a Opens the Edit Dictionary dialogue box in which you can edit the list of conversion terms.
31 svx%2Fui%2Fchineseconversiondialog%2Ftosimplified b3 Converts traditional Chinese text characters to simplified Chinese text characters. Click OK to convert the selected text. If no text is selected, the whole document is converted.
18 .uno%3AChineseConversion 8a Converts the selected Chinese text from one Chinese writing system to the other. If no text is selected, the entire document is converted.
3c svx%2Fui%2Fchineseconversiondialog%2FChineseConversionDialog 8a Converts the selected Chinese text from one Chinese writing system to the other. If no text is selected, the entire document is converted.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fchinesedictionary%2Fdelete 3c Removes the selected user-defined entry from the dictionary.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fchinesedictionary%2Fadd 77 Adds the term to the conversion dictionary. If the term is already in the dictionary, the new term receives precedence.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fchinesedictionary%2Fmapping 36 Enter the text that you want to replace the Term with.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fchinesedictionary%2Fproperty 27 Defines the class of the selected term.
36 svx%2Fui%2Fchinesedictionary%2FChineseDictionaryDialog 22 Edit the Chinese conversion terms.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fchinesedictionary%2Fmodify 2e Saves the modified entry to the database file.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fchinesedictionary%2Ftradtosimple 33 Converts traditional Chinese to simplified Chinese.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fchinesedictionary%2Fsimpletotrad 33 Converts simplified Chinese to traditional Chinese.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fchinesedictionary%2Fterm 3e Enter the text that you want to replace with the Mapping term.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fchinesedictionary%2Freverse 62 Automatically adds the reverse mapping direction to the list for each modification that you enter.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2Falternatives c8 Click an entry in the Alternatives list to copy the related term to the "Replace with" text box. Double-click an entry to copy the related term to the "Current word" text box and to look up that term.
1b cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2Fleft 3d Recalls the previous contents of the "Current word" text box.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2Flangcb 24 Select a language for the thesaurus.
10 .uno%3AThesaurus 53 Opens a dialogue box to replace the current word with a synonym, or a related term.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2Freplaceed af The word or words in the "Replace with" text box will replace the original word in the document when you click the Replace button. You can also type text directly in this box.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2Fwordcb b6 Displays the current word, or the related term that you selected by double-clicking a line in the Alternatives list. You can also type text directly in this box to look up your text.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingcolorreplace%2Fcolor5 48 Select the colour to replace the transparent areas in the current image.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingcolorreplace%2Fcolor4 99 Lists the available replacement colours. To modify the current list of colours, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colours tab.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingcolorreplace%2Fpipette a7 Displays the colour in the selected image that directly underlies the current mouse pointer position. This features only works if the Colour Replacer tool is selected.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingcolorreplace%2Fcbx5 50 Replaces transparent areas in the current image with the colour that you select.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingcolorreplace%2Fcbx4 74 Select this check box to replace the current Source colour with the colour that you specify in the Replace with box.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingcolorreplace%2Freplace 76 Replaces the selected source colours in the current image with the colours that you specify in the Replace with boxes.
1a SVX_HID_BMPMASK_CTL_QCOL_1 b3 Displays the colour in the selected image that you want to replace. To set the source colour, click here, click the Colour Replacer, and then click a colour in the selected image.
e .uno%3ABmpMask 67 Opens the Colour Replacer dialogue box, where you can replace colours in bitmap and meta file graphics.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdockingcolorreplace%2Ftol4 d7 Set the tolerance for replacing a source colour in the source image. To replace colours that are similar to the colour that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colours, enter a higher value.
15 .uno%3AAutoCorrectDlg 3e Sets the options for automatically replacing text as you type.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fapplyautofmtpage%2Fedit 29 Modifies the selected AutoCorrect option.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fapplyautofmtpage%2FApplyAutoFmtPage 56 Select the options for automatically correcting errors as you type, and then click OK.
20 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Fnew 33 Adds or replaces an entry in the replacement table.
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Forigtext 272 Enter the word, abbreviation or word part that you want to replace while you type. Wildcard character sequence .* in the end of word results the replacement of the word before arbitrary suffixes, too. Wildcard character sequence .* before the word results the replacement after arbitrary prefixes, too. For example, the pattern "i18n.*" with the replacement text "internationalization" finds and replaces "i18ns" with "internationalizations", or the pattern ".*..." with the replacement text "…" finds and replaces three dots in "word..." with the typographically correct precomposed Unicode horizontal ellipsis ("word…").
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Ftextonly 85 Saves the entry in the With box without formatting. When the replacement is made, the text uses the same format as the document text.
2c cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2FAcorReplacePage 6e Edits the replacement table for automatically correcting or replacing words or abbreviations in your document.
24 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Fnewtext f3 Enter the replacement text, graphic, frame, or OLE object that you want to replace the text in the Replace box. If you have selected text, a graphic, a frame, or an OLE object in your document, the relevant information is already entered here.
24 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Ftabview 13b Lists the entries for automatically replacing words, abbreviations or word parts while you type. To add an entry, enter text in the Replace and With boxes, and then click New. To edit an entry, select it, change the text in the With box, and then click Replace. To delete an entry, select it, and then click Delete.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fautocorrectdialog%2Flang 4f Select the language for which you want to create or edit the replacement rules.
2a cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2FAcorExceptPage 6d Specify the abbreviations or letter combinations that you do not want $[officename] to correct automatically.
26 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fautodouble 134 Automatically adds abbreviations or words that start with two capital letters to the corresponding list of exceptions. This feature only works if the Correct TWo INitial CApitals option or the Capitalise first letter of every sentence option are selected in the [T] column onOptions tab of this dialogue box.
26 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fdoublelist b3 Lists the words or abbreviations that start with two initial capitals that are not automatically corrected. All words which start with two capital letters are listed in the field.
22 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fabbrev d9 Type an abbreviation followed by a full stop, and then click New. This prevents $[officename] from automatically capitalising the first letter of the word that comes after the full stop at the end of the abbreviation.
26 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fabbrevlist 3d Lists the abbreviations that are not automatically corrected.
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fnewdouble 31 Adds the current entry to the list of exceptions.
22 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fdouble ce Type the word or abbreviation that starts with two capital letters that you do not want $[officename] to change to one initial capital. For example, enter PC to prevent $[officename] from changing PC to Pc.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fenddouble 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current closing quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fdefaultsingle 32 Resets the quotation marks to the default symbols.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fendsingle 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current closing quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fdefaultdouble 32 Resets the quotation marks to the default symbols.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fstartdouble 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current opening quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Flist 5a Select to apply the replacements while you type [T], or when you modify existing text [M].
2d cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fsinglereplace 83 Automatically replaces the default system symbol for the given type of quotation marks with the special character that you specify.
32 cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2FApplyLocalizedPage 72 Specify the AutoCorrect options for quotation marks and for options that are specific to the language of the text.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fchecklist 5a Select to apply the replacements while you type [T], or when you modify existing text [M].
2d cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fdoublereplace 83 Automatically replaces the default system symbol for the given type of quotation marks with the special character that you specify.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fstartsingle 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current opening quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply.
17 HID_LINGU_PARA_LANGUAGE 7e Changes the language setting for the paragraph that contains the highlighted word, if the word is found in another dictionary.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fspellmenu%2Fspelldialog 22 Opens the Spellcheck dialogue box.
11 HID_LINGU_REPLACE 67 Click the word to replace the highlighted word. Use the AutoCorrect sub-menu for permanent replacement.
28 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fspellmenu%2Fadd 37 Adds the highlighted word to a user-defined dictionary.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fspellmenu%2Fignoreall 46 Ignores all instances of the highlighted word in the current document.
12 HID_LINGU_AUTOCORR ad To always replace the highlighted word, click a word in the list. The word pair is stored in the replacement table under Tools - AutoCorrect - AutoCorrect Options - Replace.
17 HID_LINGU_WORD_LANGUAGE 63 Changes the language settings for the highlighted word, if the word is found in another dictionary.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fwordcompletionpage%2Fentries ec Lists the collected words. The list is valid until you close the current document. To make the list available to other documents in the current session, unmark "When closing a document, remove the words collected from it from the list".
2a cui%2Fui%2Fwordcompletionpage%2Fmaxentries 55 Enter the maximum number of words that you want to store in the Word Completion list.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fwordcompletionpage%2Fdelete 41 Removes the selected word or words from the Word Completion list.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fwordcompletionpage%2Fappendspace 49 If you do not add punctuation after the word, $[officename] adds a space.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fwordcompletionpage%2Fshowastip 2a Displays the completed word as a Help Tip.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fwordcompletionpage%2Fminwordlen 5c Enter the minimum word length for a word to become eligible for the word completion feature.
32 cui%2Fui%2Fwordcompletionpage%2Fenablewordcomplete 92 Stores frequently used words, and automatically completes a word after you type three letters that match the first three letters of a stored word.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fwordcompletionpage%2Fcollectwords 87 Adds the frequently used words to a list. To remove a word from the Word Completion list, select the word, and then click Delete Entry.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fwordcompletionpage%2Fwhenclosing f3 When marked, the list is cleared upon closing the current document. When cleared, makes the current Word Completion list available to other documents after you close the current document. The list remains available until you exit %PRODUCTNAME.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fwordcompletionpage%2Facceptwith 4c Select the key that you want to use to accept the automatic word completion.
34 cui%2Fui%2Fsmarttagoptionspage%2FSmartTagOptionsPage 5b When you have installed at least one Smart Tag extension, you will see the Smart Tags page.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fsmarttagoptionspage%2Fproperties 78 To configure a Smart Tag, select the name of the Smart Tag, then click Properties. Not all Smart Tags can be configured.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fsmarttagoptionspage%2Fmain 43 Enables Smart Tags to be evaluated and shown in your text document.
d HID_NUM_RESET 5c Removes the numbering or bullets from the current paragraph or from the selected paragraphs.
14 .uno%3AOutlineBullet 69 Adds numbering or bullets to the current paragraph, and lets you edit format of the numbering or bullets.
20 .uno%3ABulletsAndNumberingDialog 69 Adds numbering or bullets to the current paragraph, and lets you edit format of the numbering or bullets.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fpickbulletpage%2Fvalueset 2c Click the bullet style that you want to use.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fpickbulletpage%2FPickBulletPage 38 Displays the different bullet styles that you can apply.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fpicknumberingpage%2Fvalueset 2f Click the numbering style that you want to use.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fpicknumberingpage%2FPickNumberingPage 3b Displays the different numbering styles that you can apply.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpickoutlinepage%2Fvalueset 2d Click the outline style that you want to use.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fpickoutlinepage%2FPickOutlinePage 8e Displays the different styles that you can apply to a hierarchical list. $[officename] supports up to nine outline levels in a list hierarchy.
11 .uno%3ASetOutline 8e Displays the different styles that you can apply to a hierarchical list. $[officename] supports up to nine outline levels in a list hierarchy.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpickgraphicpage%2Flinkgraphics 6c If enabled, the graphics are inserted as links. If not enabled, the graphics are embedded into the document.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fpickgraphicpage%2FPickGraphicPage 4f Displays the different graphics that you can use as bullets in a bulleted list.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpickgraphicpage%2Fvalueset 33 Click the graphics that you want to use as bullets.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fkeepratio 2e Maintains the size proportions of the graphic.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Forientlb 2c Select the alignment option for the graphic.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fbitmap 50 Select the graphic, or locate the graphic file that you want to use as a bullet.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fbullet 55 Opens the Special Characters dialogue box, from which you can select a bullet symbol.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fstartat 32 Enter a new starting number for the current level.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fnumfmtlb 31 Select a numbering style for the selected levels.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fcharstyle 45 Select the Character Style that you want to use in the numbered list.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Flevellb 47 Select the level(s) that you want to define the formatting options for.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fheightmf 1f Enter a height for the graphic.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fwidthmf 1e Enter a width for the graphic.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fprefix 4c Enter a character or the text to display in front of the number in the list.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fsuffix a0 Enter a character or the text to display behind the number in the list. If you want to create a numbered list that uses the style "1.)", enter ".)" in this box.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fallsame 4f Increases the numbering by one as you go down each level in the list hierarchy.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fsublevels dd Enter the number of previous levels to include in the numbering style. For example, if you enter "2" and the previous level uses the "A, B, C..." numbering style, the numbering scheme for the current level becomes: "A.1".
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Findentatmf 6f Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the numbering symbol and the left edge of the text.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Fstandard 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Fnumdistmf 78 Enter the minimum amount of space to leave between the right edge of the numbering symbol and the left edge of the text.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Frelative 4f Indents the current level relative to the previous level in the list hierarchy.
32 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Fnumfollowedbylb 53 Select the element that will follow the numbering: a tab stop, a space, or nothing.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Falignedatmf 5b Enter the distance from the left page margin at which the numbering symbol will be aligned.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Flevellb 2c Select the level(s) that you want to modify.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Fnumalignlb 124 Set the alignment of the numbering symbols. Select "Left" to align the numbering symbol to start directly at the "Aligned at" position. Select "Right" to align the symbol to end directly before the "Aligned at" position. Select "Centred" to centre the symbol around the "Aligned at" position.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Fatmf 6e If you select a tab stop to follow the numbering, you can enter a non-negative value as the tab stop position.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Findentatmf 80 Enter the distance from the left page margin to the beginning of all lines in the numbered paragraph that follow the first line.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fscriptorganizer%2Fdelete 2a Prompts you to delete the selected script.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fscriptorganizer%2Frun 41 To run a script, select a script in the list, and then click Run.
32 cui%2Fui%2Fscriptorganizer%2FScriptOrganizerDialog 83 Select a macro or script from "user", "share", or an open document. To view the available macros or scripts, double-click an entry.
2a modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Flibpage%2Fimport 65 Locate the $[officename] Basic library that you want to add to the current list, and then click Open.
2c modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Flibpage%2Fpassword 37 Assigns or edits the password for the selected library.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fscriptorganizer%2Fedit 3a Opens the default script editor for your operating system.
28 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Flibpage%2Fedit 51 Opens the $[officename] Basic editor so that you can modify the selected library.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fscriptorganizer%2Frename 4a Opens a dialogue box where you can change the name of the selected script.
33 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fassign 74 Opens the Customise dialogue box, where you can assign the selected macro to a menu command, a toolbar, or an event.
2c modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Flibpage%2Flocation 60 Select the application or the document containing the macro libraries that you want to organise.
30 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Frun 20 Runs or saves the current macro.
36 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Flibraries ab Lists the libraries and the modules where you can open or save your macros. To save a macro with a particular document, open the document, and then open this dialogue box.
33 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fdelete 33 Creates a new macro, or deletes the selected macro.
27 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Flibpage%2Fnew 16 Creates a new library.
33 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fmacros 52 Lists the macros that are contained in the module selected in the Macro from list.
12 .uno%3AMacroDialog 28 Opens a dialogue box to organise macros.
3a modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fmacronameedit 67 Displays the name of the selected macro. To create or to change the name of a macro, enter a name here.
2b modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Flibpage%2Flibrary 56 Lists the existing macro libraries for the current application and any open documents.
31 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fedit 59 Starts the $[officename] Basic editor and opens the selected macro or dialog for editing.
37 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fnewlibrary 2a Saves the recorded macro in a new library.
35 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fnewlibdialog%2FNewLibDialog 1c Enter a name for the script.
2e modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fmodulepage%2Flibrary 26 Lists the existing macros and dialogs.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fscriptorganizer%2Fcreate 15 Creates a new script.
36 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fnewmodule 29 Saves the recorded macro in a new module.
30 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fdialogpage%2Fnewdialog 2a Opens the editor and creates a new dialog.
2b modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fmodulepage%2Fedit 2f Opens the selected macro or dialog for editing.
35 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Forganize 28 Lets you manage modules or dialog boxes.
30 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fmodulepage%2Fnewmodule 2a Opens the editor and creates a new module.
2d modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fdialogpage%2Fdelete 57 Lets you manage the macro libraries for the current application and any open documents.
27 .uno%3AMacroOrganizer%3FTabId%3Ashort=1 32 Opens the Dialogs tab page of the Macro Organiser.
f .uno%3ARunMacro 36 Opens a dialogue box with which you can start a macro.
15 .uno%3AMacroSignature 74 Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your macros. You can also use the dialogue box to view certificates.
14 .uno%3AStopRecording 18 Stops recording a macro.
14 .uno%3AMacroRecorder 14 Records a new macro.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fpasswd%2FnewpassEntry 2e Enter a new password for the selected library.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fpasswd%2FconfirmpassEntry 33 Re-enter the new password for the selected library.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fpasswd%2FPasswordDialog 2e Protects the selected library with a password.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fpasswd%2FoldpassEntry 34 Enter the current password for the selected library.
44 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer%3FScriptOrganizer.Language%3Astring=BeanShell 37 Opens a dialogue box in which you can organise scripts.
16 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer 5b Opens a sub-menu with links to dialogue boxes in which you can organise macros and scripts.
45 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer%3FScriptOrganizer.Language%3Astring=JavaScript 37 Opens a dialogue box in which you can organise scripts.
33 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fimportlibdialog%2Freplace 43 Replaces a library that has the same name with the current library.
3b modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fimportlibdialog%2FImportLibDialog 6d Enter a name or the path to the library that you want to append. You can also select a library from the list.
2f modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fimportlibdialog%2Fref 6d Adds the selected library as a read-only file. The library is reloaded each time that you start %PRODUCTNAME.
12 .uno%3ALoadToolBox 59 Customises $[officename] menus, shortcut keys, toolbars, and macro assignments to events.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fmenuassignpage%2Fsavein 4a Select the application or open document to which you want to add the menu.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fmenuassignpage%2Fadd b5 Opens the Add Commands dialogue box. Select the command that you want to add to the menu, and then click Add. You can also drag-and-drop the command into the Customise dialogue box.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fmenuassignpage%2Fdown 2a Moves the selected item down one position.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fmenuassignpage%2Ftoplevellist 33 Select the menu and sub-menu that you want to edit.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fmenuassignpage%2Ftoplevelbutton 7a Opens the New Menu dialogue box in which you can enter the name of a new menu as well as select the location for the menu.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fmenuassignpage%2FMenuAssignPage 47 Customises and saves current menu layouts as well as creates new menus.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fmenuassignpage%2Fmodify 2f Opens a menu that contains additional commands.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fmenuassignpage%2Fentries 6c Displays a list of the available menu commands for the selected menu in the current application or document.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fmenuassignpage%2Fmenuedit 2a Opens a sub-menu with additional commands.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fmenuassignpage%2Fup 28 Moves the selected item up one position.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fmovemenu%2Fmenuname 76 Enter a name for the menu. To specify a letter in the name as an accelerator key, enter a tilde (~) before the letter.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fmovemenu%2FMoveMenuDialog 6e Moves the selected menu entry up one position or down one position in the menu when you click an arrow button.
22 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Freset 32 Resets modified values back to the default values.
21 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Fsave 4c Saves the current shortcut key configuration, so that you can load it later.
21 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Fload 4b Replaces the shortcut key configuration with one that was previously saved.
21 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Fkeys 46 Displays the shortcut keys that are assigned to the selected function.
23 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Foffice 49 Displays shortcut keys that are common to all $[officename] applications.
23 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Fchange 6c Assigns the key combination selected in the Shortcut keys list to the command selected in the Function list.
25 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Fcategory 63 Lists the available function categories. To assign shortcuts to Styles, open the "Styles" category.
2c cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2FAccelConfigPage 5d Assigns or edits the shortcut keys for $[officename] commands, or $[officename] Basic macros.
23 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Fdelete 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
23 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Fmodule 41 Displays shortcut keys for the current $[officename] application.
26 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Fshortcuts be Lists the shortcut keys and the associated commands. To assign or modify the shortcut key for the command selected in the Function list, click a shortcut in this list, and then click Modify.
25 cui%2Fui%2Faccelconfigpage%2Ffunction dd Select a function that you want to assign a shortcut key to, click a key combination in the Shortcut keys list, and then click Modify. If the selected function already has a shortcut key, it is displayed in the Keys list.
15 CUI_HID_SVX_DESCFIELD 32 Displays a short description of the given command.
14 CUI_HID_SVX_TEXTONLY 10 Shows text only.
18 CUI_HID_SVX_ICONSANDTEXT 15 Shows icons and text.
1b CUI_HID_SVX_TOPLEVELLISTBOX 24 Select the toolbar you want to edit.
1a CUI_HID_SVX_CONFIG_TOOLBAR 2a Lets you customise $[officename] toolbars.
1c CUI_HID_SVX_NEW_TOOLBAR_ITEM 7e Opens the Add Commands dialogue box. Select any command, then click Add to insert the command into the Customise dialogue box.
13 CUI_HID_SVX_SAVE_IN 3d Select the location for loading and saving the configuration.
15 CUI_HID_SVX_ICONSONLY 11 Shows icons only.
1a CUI_HID_SVX_MODIFY_TOOLBAR 23 The Toolbar button opens a sub-menu
1b CUI_HID_SVX_UP_TOOLBAR_ITEM 27 Moves the selected item up in the list.
18 CUI_HID_SVX_REMOVEBUTTON 3a Deletes the selected command without any further question.
1d CUI_HID_SVX_DOWN_TOOLBAR_ITEM 29 Moves the selected item down in the list.
19 CUI_HID_SVX_ADD_SEPARATOR 39 Inserts a separator line under the current toolbar entry.
17 CUI_HID_SVX_NEW_TOOLBAR 76 Opens the Name dialogue box, where you can enter the name of a new toolbar and select the location of the new toolbar.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fnewtoolbardialog%2Fedit 27 Select the location of the new toolbar.
17 CUI_HID_SVX_RESETBUTTON 54 Restores the selected toolbar to its original state after you agree to the question.
1f HID_SVX_CONFIG_TOOLBAR_CONTENTS 5c Displays a list of commands for the selected toolbar of the current application or document.
1f CUI_HID_SVX_MODIFY_TOOLBAR_ITEM 22 The Modify button opens a sub-menu
2c cui%2Fui%2Ficonselectordialog%2FIconSelector a4 Adds new icons to the list of icons. You will see a file open dialogue box that imports the selected icon or icons into the internal icon directory of %PRODUCTNAME.
2c cui%2Fui%2Ficonselectordialog%2FdeleteButton 58 Click to remove the selected icon from the list. Only user-defined icons can be removed.
2c cui%2Fui%2Ficonselectordialog%2FimportButton a4 Adds new icons to the list of icons. You will see a file open dialogue box that imports the selected icon or icons into the internal icon directory of %PRODUCTNAME.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fmacroassignpage%2Fdelete 34 Deletes the macro assignment for the selected event.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feventsconfigpage%2Fmacro 41 Opens the Macro Selector to assign a macro to the selected event.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fmacroassignpage%2Fassign 41 Opens the Macro Selector to assign a macro to the selected event.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feventsconfigpage%2Fdelete 34 Deletes the macro assignment for the selected event.
1e CUI_HID_MACRO_HEADERTABLISTBOX b1 The big list box lists the events and the assigned macros. After you selected the location in the Save In list box, select an event in the big list box. Then click Assign Macro.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fmacroassignpage%2FMacroAssignPage 6d Assigns macros to program events. The assigned macro runs automatically every time the selected event occurs.
12 .uno%3ATableEvents 6d Assigns macros to program events. The assigned macro runs automatically every time the selected event occurs.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fmacroassigndialog%2FMacroAssignDialog 6d Assigns macros to program events. The assigned macro runs automatically every time the selected event occurs.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fmacroassignpage%2Fassignments b1 The big list box lists the events and the assigned macros. After you selected the location in the Save In list box, select an event in the big list box. Then click Assign Macro.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feventsconfigpage%2Fsavein 59 Select first where to save the event binding, in the current document or in %PRODUCTNAME.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feventsconfigpage%2Fevents b1 The big list box lists the events and the assigned macros. After you selected the location in the Save In list box, select an event in the big list box. Then click Assign Macro.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fhelp 2d Displays the help page for this dialogue box.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fopen 53 Displays an Open dialogue box to open a filter from an XSLT filter package (*.jar).
26 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fsave 5c Displays a Save as dialogue box to save the selected file as an XSLT filter package (*.jar).
2c filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Ffilterlist 3a Select one or more filters, then click one of the buttons.
1c .uno%3AOpenXMLFilterSettings 85 Opens the XML Filter Settings dialogue box, in which you can create, edit, delete and test filters to import and to export XML files.
27 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fclose 18 Closes the dialogue box.
25 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fnew 33 Opens a dialogue box with the name of a new filter.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fedit 38 Opens a dialogue box with the name of the selected file.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Ftest 38 Opens a dialogue box with the name of the selected file.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fdelete 4a Deletes the selected file after you confirm the dialogue box that follows.
35 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2Finterfacename 54 Enter the name that you want to display in the File type box in file dialogue boxes.
33 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2Fdescription 1b Enter a comment (optional).
31 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2Fextension 99 Enter the file extension to use when you open a file without specifying a filter. $[officename] uses the file extension to determine which filter to use.
3f filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2FXmlFilterTabPageGeneral 34 Enter or edit general information for an XML filter.
32 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2Ffiltername 3c Select the application that you want to use with the filter.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Ftempimport 7b Enter the name of the template that you want to use for importing. In the template, styles are defined to display XML tags.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Fxsltimport 6b If this is an import filter, enter the file name of the XSLT stylesheet that you want to use for importing.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Fxsltexport 6b If this is an export filter, enter the file name of the XSLT stylesheet that you want to use for exporting.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Fbrowsetemp 24 Opens a file selection dialogue box.
4d filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2FXmlFilterTabPageTransformation 31 Enter or edit file information for an XML filter.
32 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Fdoc 22 Enter the DOCTYPE of the XML file.
21 HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_RECENT 42 Re-opens the document that was last opened with this dialogue box.
21 HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_BROWSE 65 Opens a file selection dialogue box. The selected file is opened using the current XML import filter.
29 HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_DISPLAY_SOURCE 59 Opens the XML source of the selected document in your default XML editor after importing.
22 HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_EXPORT_CURRENT 57 Displays the file name of the template that you entered on the Transformation tab page.
2b FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_EXPORT_XSLT_FILE 5a Displays the file name of the XSLT filter that you entered on the Transformation tab page.
21 HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_EXPORT_BROWSE a0 Locate the file that you want to apply the XML export filter to. The XML code of the transformed file is opened in your default XML editor after transformation.
1c HID_XML_SOURCE_FILE_VALIDATE 37 Validates the contents of the XML Filter output window.
1c HID_XML_FILTER_OUTPUT_WINDOW 28 Lists the test results of an XML filter.
1a HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_CLOSE 18 Closes the dialogue box.
36 cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaoptdialog%2FHangulHanjaOptDialog 2c Opens the Hangul/Hanja Options dialogue box.
1b HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_CHANGE 5d Replaces the selection with the suggested characters or word according to the format options.
42 SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_RB_HANJA_HANGUL_BRACKETED 43 The Hangul part will be displayed in brackets after the Hanja part.
3e SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_RB_HANJA_HANGUL_BELOW 44 The Hangul part will be displayed as ruby text below the Hanja part.
3d SVX_CHECKBOX_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_CB_REPLACE_BY_CHARACTER 75 Mark this check box to move character-by-character through the selected text. If not marked, full words are replaced.
2f SVX_PUSHBUTTON_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_PB_FIND 57 Finds your Hangul input in the dictionary and replaces it with the corresponding Hanja.
1a HID_HANGULDLG_EDIT_NEWWORD 3e Displays the first replacement suggestion from the dictionary.
1c .uno%3AHangulHanjaConversion 4f Converts the selected Korean text from Hangul to Hanja or from Hanja to Hangul.
34 SVX_CHECKBOX_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_CB_HANGUL_ONLY 41 Mark this check box to convert only Hangul. Do not convert Hanja.
33 SVX_LISTBOX_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_LB_SUGGESTIONS 36 Displays all available replacements in the dictionary.
14 HID_SPELLDLG_SETWORD 1f Displays the current selection.
3e SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_RB_HANJA_HANGUL_ABOVE 44 The Hangul part will be displayed as ruby text above the Hanja part.
3e SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_RB_HANGUL_HANJA_ABOVE 44 The Hanja part will be displayed as ruby text above the Hangul part.
1e HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_IGNOREALL 86 No changes will be made to the current selection, and every time that the same selection is detected it will be skipped automatically.
1e HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_CHANGEALL af Replaces the selection with the suggested characters or word according to the format options. Every time that the same selection is detected it will be replaced automatically.
42 SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_RB_HANGUL_HANJA_BRACKETED 43 The Hanja part will be displayed in brackets after the Hangul part.
3e SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_RB_HANGUL_HANJA_BELOW 44 The Hanja part will be displayed as ruby text below the Hangul part.
33 SVX_CHECKBOX_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_CB_HANJA_ONLY 41 Mark this check box to convert only Hanja. Do not convert Hangul.
3d SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_RB_SIMPLE_CONVERSION 41 The original characters are replaced by the suggested characters.
1b HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_IGNORE 6d No changes will be made to the current selection. The next word or character will be selected for conversion.
33 cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaoptdialog%2Fautoreplaceunique 4b Automatically replaces words that only have one suggested word replacement.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaoptdialog%2Fnew 50 Opens the New dictionary dialogue box, in which you can create a new dictionary.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaadddialog%2Fentry 20 Enter a name for the dictionary.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaoptdialog%2Fshowrecentfirst 60 Shows the replacement suggestion that you selected the last time as the first entry on the list.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaoptdialog%2Fignorepost 56 Ignores positional characters at the end of Korean words when you search a dictionary.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaoptdialog%2Fedit 60 Opens the Edit Custom Dictionary dialogue box in which you can edit any user-defined dictionary.
36 cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaadddialog%2FHangulHanjaAddDialog ad Lists all user-defined dictionaries. Mark the check box next to the dictionary that you want to use. Unmark the check box next to the dictionary that you do not want to use.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaoptdialog%2Fdelete 2d Deletes the selected user-defined dictionary.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaeditdictdialog%2Fnew 3a Adds the current replacement definition to the dictionary.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaeditdictdialog%2Fedit1 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaeditdictdialog%2Fdelete 1b Deletes the selected entry.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaeditdictdialog%2Fbook 39 Select the user-defined dictionary that you want to edit.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fhangulhanjaeditdictdialog%2Foriginal 79 Select the entry in the current dictionary that you want to edit. If you want, you can also type a new entry in this box.
12 .uno%3ASpellDialog 19 Checks spelling manually.
10 .uno%3ANewWindow 44 Opens a new window that displays the contents of the current window.
2e xmlsec%2Fui%2Fdigitalsignaturesdialog%2Fremove 68 Removes the selected signature from the list. Removes all subsequent signatures as well, in case of PDF.
10 .uno%3ASignature 76 Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your document. You can also use the dialogue box to view certificates.
32 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fdigitalsignaturesdialog%2Fsignatures 36 Lists the digital signatures for the current document.
2c xmlsec%2Fui%2Fdigitalsignaturesdialog%2Fview 28 Opens the View Certificate dialogue box.
3f xmlsec%2Fui%2Fdigitalsignaturesdialog%2FDigitalSignaturesDialog 76 Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your document. You can also use the dialogue box to view certificates.
35 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fdigitalsignaturesdialog%2Fadescompliant 4e Prefers creating XAdES signatures for ODF and OOXML, PAdES signatures for PDF.
2c xmlsec%2Fui%2Fdigitalsignaturesdialog%2Fsign 2a Opens the Select Certificate dialogue box.
25 desktop%2Fui%2Fupdatedialog%2FINSTALL 5a When you click the Install button the Download and Installation dialogue box is displayed.
2a desktop%2Fui%2Fupdatedialog%2FDESCRIPTIONS 9b While checking for updates, you see a progress indicator. Wait for some messages to show up in the dialogue box, or click Cancel to abort the update check.
28 desktop%2Fui%2Fupdatedialog%2FUPDATE_ALL 92 By default, only the downloadable extensions are shown in the dialogue box. Mark Show all Updates to see also other extensions and error messages.
2a desktop%2Fui%2Fupdatedialog%2FUpdateDialog ec Click the Check for Updates button in the Extension Manager to check for online updates for all installed extensions. To check for online updates for only the selected extension, right-click to open the context menu, then choose Update.
38 desktop%2Fui%2Fupdateinstalldialog%2FUpdateInstallDialog ec Click the Check for Updates button in the Extension Manager to check for online updates for all installed extensions. To check for online updates for only the selected extension, right-click to open the context menu, then choose Update.
10 .uno%3AInsertLRM 92 Inserts a text direction mark that affects the text direction of any text following the mark. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
1d .uno%3AInsertNonBreakingSpace 4c Inserts a space that will keep bordering characters together on line breaks.
10 .uno%3AInsertRLM 92 Inserts a text direction mark that affects the text direction of any text following the mark. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
19 .uno%3AFormattingMarkMenu 6d Opens a sub-menu to insert special formatting marks like non-breaking space, soft hyphen, and optional break.
11 .uno%3AInsertZWSP a9 Inserts an invisible space within a word that will insert a line break once it becomes the last character in a line. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
13 .uno%3AInsertZWNBSP 94 Inserts an invisible space within a word that will keep the word together at the end of a line. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
17 .uno%3AInsertHardHyphen 4d Inserts a hyphen that will keep bordering characters together on line breaks.
17 .uno%3AInsertSoftHyphen 89 Inserts an invisible optional hyphen within a word that will appear and create a line break once it becomes the last character in a line.
18 SVX_HID_GALLERY_NEWTHEME 56 Adds a new theme to the Gallery and lets you choose the files to include in the theme.
16 SVX_HID_GALLERY_WINDOW 52 To insert a Gallery object, select the object, and then drag it into the document.
19 SVX_HID_GALLERY_THEMELIST 3c Click a theme to view the objects associated with the theme.
e .uno%3AGallery 70 Opens the Gallery deck of the Sidebar, where you can select images and audio clips to insert into your document.
18 SVX_HID_GALLERY_ICONVIEW 2e Displays the contents of the Gallery as icons.
18 SVX_HID_GALLERY_LISTVIEW 55 Displays the contents of the Gallery as small icons, with title and path information.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fgalleryfilespage%2Ffiles 8b Lists the available files. Select the file(s) that you want to add, and then click Add. To add all of the files in the list, click Add All.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fgalleryfilespage%2Fadd 2f Adds the selected file(s) to the current theme.
13 HID_GALLERY_PREVIEW 28 Displays a preview of the selected file.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fgalleryfilespage%2Ffiletype 2d Select the type of file that you want to add.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fgalleryfilespage%2Ffindfiles 52 Locate the directory containing the files that you want to add, and then click OK.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fgalleryfilespage%2Faddall 37 Adds all of the files in the list to the current theme.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fgalleryfilespage%2Fpreview 31 Displays or hides a preview of the selected file.
f .uno%3AGridMenu 26 Sets the display properties of a grid.
b .uno%3Axxxx 75 Toggle the visibility of grid points and guide lines to help object moving and precise position in the current sheet.
15 .uno%3AHelplinesFront 45 Displays the snap lines in front of the objects on the slide or page.
13 .uno%3AHelplinesUse 45 Displays the snap lines in front of the objects on the slide or page.
14 .uno%3ASnapLinesMenu 2d Specifies the display options for snap lines.
17 .uno%3AHelplinesVisible 45 Displays the snap lines in front of the objects on the slide or page.
14 .uno%3AAVMediaPlayer 85 Opens the Media Player window in which you can preview movie and sound files as well as insert these files into the current document.
25 vnd.sun.star.findbar%3AFocusToFindbar 5f Toggle the visibility of the Find toolbar to search for text or navigate a document by element.
e .uno%3ASidebar a3 The Sidebar is a vertical graphical user interface that primarily provides contextual properties, style management, document navigation and media gallery features.
14 .uno%3AInsertAVMedia 31 Inserts a video or audio file into your document.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_DLG f2 Checks for available updates to your version of %PRODUCTNAME. If a newer version is available, you can choose to download the update. After downloading, if you have write permissions for the installation directory, you can install the update.
21 SFX2_HID_DLG_CHECKFORONLINEUPDATE f2 Checks for available updates to your version of %PRODUCTNAME. If a newer version is available, you can choose to download the update. After downloading, if you have write permissions for the installation directory, you can install the update.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_CANCEL 3b Aborts the download and deletes the partly downloaded file.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_RESUME 1c Continues a paused download.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_INSTALL 1f Installs the downloaded update.
26 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_DOWNLOAD2 9e Downloads and saves the update files to the desktop or a folder of your choice. Select the folder in %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update in the Options dialogue box.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_DOWNLOAD 9e Downloads and saves the update files to the desktop or a folder of your choice. Select the folder in %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update in the Options dialogue box.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_PAUSE 40 Pauses the download. Later click Resume to continue downloading.
26 desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2Fuser 42 Filter extensions only available for the currently logged in user.
2c desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2Foptionsbtn 5d Select an installed extension, then click to open the Options dialogue box for the extension.
2b desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2Fupdatebtn de Click to check for online updates of all installed extensions. To check for updates of the selected extension only, choose the Update command from the context menu. The check for availability of updates starts immediately.
2d DESKTOP_HID_EXTENSION_MANAGER_LISTBOX_DISABLE 46 Select the extension that you want to disable, and then click Disable.
28 desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2Fshared 3b Filter extensions available for all users of this computer.
2c DESKTOP_HID_EXTENSION_MANAGER_LISTBOX_ENABLE 44 Select the extension that you want to enable, and then click Enable.
2f desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2Fgetextensions 33 You can find a collection of extensions on the Web.
29 desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2Fbundled a9 Bundled extensions are installed by the system administrator using the operating system specific installer packages. These can not be installed, updated or removed here.
28 desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2Faddbtn 1e Click Add to add an extension.
38 desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2FExtensionManagerDialog 5c The Extension Manager adds, removes, disables, enables, and updates %PRODUCTNAME extensions.
2c desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2Fextensions 81 Select the extension that you want to remove, enable, or disable. For some extensions, you can also open an Options dialogue box.
34 desktop%2Fui%2Fshowlicensedialog%2FShowLicenseDialog 87 Read the licence. Click the Scroll Down button to scroll down if necessary. Click Accept to continue the installation of the extension.
2b desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2Fremovebtn 44 Select the extension that you want to remove, and then click Remove.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fexpander 38 Click to show or hide the file sharing password options.
26 uui%2Fui%2Fpassword%2FconfirmpassEntry 16 Re-enter the password.
20 sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fconfirm2ed 16 Re-enter the password.
1d sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fpass1ed 2e Type a password. A password is case-sensitive.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2FPasswordDialog 2e Type a password. A password is case-sensitive.
1d sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fpass2ed 2e Type a password. A password is case-sensitive.
20 sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fconfirm1ed 16 Re-enter the password.
13 SC_HID_PASSWD_TABLE 2e Type a password. A password is case-sensitive.
22 uui%2Fui%2Fpassword%2FnewpassEntry 2e Type a password. A password is case-sensitive.
27 uui%2Fui%2Fmasterpassworddlg%2Fpassword 2e Type a password. A password is case-sensitive.
39 uui%2Fui%2Fsetmasterpassworddlg%2FSetMasterPasswordDialog 43 Assign a master password to protect the access to a saved password.
2b uui%2Fui%2Fsetmasterpassworddlg%2Fpassword2 1d Re-enter the master password.
2b uui%2Fui%2Fsetmasterpassworddlg%2Fpassword1 55 Type a master password to prevent unauthorised users from accessing stored passwords.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fsafemodedialog%2FSafeModeDialog b0 Safe mode is a mode where %PRODUCTNAME temporarily starts with a fresh user profile and disables hardware acceleration. It helps to restore a non-working %PRODUCTNAME instance.
23 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsignpage%2Fcontact 44 Allows you to optionally select a Time Stamping Authority (TSA) URL.
22 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsignpage%2Fselect 2a Opens the Select Certificate dialogue box.
2a filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fenablea11y 41 Select this option to enable text access for accessibility tools.
2a filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fenablecopy 41 Select this option to enable copying of content to the clipboard.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fchangeinsdel 3a Only inserting, deleting, and rotating pages is permitted.
2a filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fchangenone 28 No changes of the content are permitted.
20 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsignpage%2Fcert 4a Allows you to select a certificate to be used for signing this PDF export.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fprinthigh 2f The document can be printed in high resolution.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fprintlow 66 The document can only be printed in low resolution (150 dpi). Not all PDF readers honour this setting.
2b filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fsetpassword 3b Click to open a dialogue box where you enter the passwords.
2f filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2FPdfSecurityPage 3b Click to open a dialogue box where you enter the passwords.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fopenpdf c2 Cross-document links are opened with the PDF reader application that currently shows the document. The PDF reader application must be able to handle the specified file type inside the hyperlink.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fdefault 6c Links from your PDF document to other documents will be handled as it is specified in your operating system.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fexporturl 81 Mark this check box to export URLs to other documents as relative URLs in the file system. See "relative hyperlinks" in the Help.
27 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsignpage%2Fpdfsignpage 4a Allows you to select a certificate to be used for signing this PDF export.
23 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fexport 146 The bookmarks (targets of references) in PDF files can be defined as rectangular areas. Additionally, bookmarks to named objects can be defined by their names. Enable the check box to export the names of objects in your document as valid bookmark targets. This allows you to link to those objects by name from other documents.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2FPdfLinksPage 146 The bookmarks (targets of references) in PDF files can be defined as rectangular areas. Additionally, bookmarks to named objects can be defined by their names. Enable the check box to export the names of objects in your document as valid bookmark targets. This allows you to link to those objects by name from other documents.
2b filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fwindow 4d Select this option to hide the reader's controls when the document is active.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fdisplay 6a Select this option to generate a PDF file that is shown with the document title in the reader's title bar.
2b filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fcenter 5d Select this option to generate a PDF file that is shown in a reader window centred on screen.
2b filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fresize 66 Select this option to generate a PDF file that is shown in a window displaying the whole initial page.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsignpage%2Fpassword 60 Enter the password used for protecting the private key associated with the selected certificate.
23 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fpdfa ea Converts to the PDF/A-1a format. This is defined as an electronic document file format for long term preservation. All fonts that were used in the source document will be embedded into the generated PDF file. PDF tags will be written.
2d filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fchangecomment 38 Only commenting and filling in form fields is permitted.
27 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fcomments 44 Select to export comments of Writer and Calc documents as PDF notes.
22 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsignpage%2Freason 44 Allows you to optionally select a Time Stamping Authority (TSA) URL.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fchangeany 33 All changes are permitted, except extracting pages.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fopeninternet 94 Cross-document links are opened with the Internet browser. The Internet browser must be able to handle the specified file type inside the hyperlink.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fresolution 2c Select the target resolution for the images.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fopen 75 Select this option to generate a PDF file that is shown in a full screen reader window in front of all other windows.
2b filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fjpegcompress ca Selects a JPEG compression of images. With a high quality level, almost all pixels are preserved. With a low quality level, some pixels get lost and artefacts are introduced, but file sizes are reduced.
2f filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Freduceresolution 50 Select to resample or down-size the images to a lower number of pixels per inch.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsignpage%2Flocation 44 Allows you to optionally select a Time Stamping Authority (TSA) URL.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fsinglelayout 48 Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows one page at a time.
1f filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsignpage%2Ftsa 44 Allows you to optionally select a Time Stamping Authority (TSA) URL.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fforms 60 Choose to create a PDF form. This can be filled out and printed by the user of the PDF document.
31 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fvisiblelevel 69 Select this option to show bookmark levels down to the selected level when the reader opens the PDF file.
31 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fallbookmarks 52 Select this option to show all bookmark levels when the reader opens the PDF file.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fbookmarks ef Select to export bookmarks of Writer documents as PDF bookmarks. Bookmarks are created for all outline paragraphs (Tools - Chapter Numbering) and for all table of contents entries for which you did assign hyperlinks in the source document.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fquality 2f Specify the quality level for JPEG compression.
2a filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fchangeform 29 Only filling in form fields is permitted.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fembed 68 This setting enables you to export the document as a .pdf file containing two file formats: PDF and ODF.
2f filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Flosslesscompress 43 Selects a lossless compression of images. All pixels are preserved.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Frange 26 Exports the pages you type in the box.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fpages 26 Exports the pages you type in the box.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fselection 1e Exports the current selection.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Ftoolbar 4c Select this option to hide the reader's toolbar when the document is active.
27 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2FPdfViewPage 4c Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows only the page contents.
25 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Ftagged 46 Select to write PDF tags. This can increase file size by huge amounts.
34 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fvisiblebookmark 69 Select this option to show bookmark levels down to the selected level when the reader opens the PDF file.
22 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fall 5c Exports all defined print ranges. If no print range is defined, exports the entire document.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fallowdups 9c Allows you to use the same field name for multiple fields in the generated PDF file. If disabled, field names will be exported using generated unique names.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fmenubar 4d Select this option to hide the reader's menu bar when the document is active.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Femptypages 191 If switched on, automatically inserted blank pages are exported to the PDF file. This is best if you are printing the PDF file double-sided. Example: In a book a chapter paragraph style is set to always start with an odd numbered page. If the previous chapter ends on an odd page, %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to export that even numbered page or not.
25 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fformat 3f Select the format of submitting forms from within the PDF file.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fpageonly 4c Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows only the page contents.
23 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Foutline 53 Select to generate a PDF file that shows a bookmarks palette and the page contents.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fdefaultlayout 76 Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows the pages according to the layout setting of the reader software.
22 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fthumbs 60 Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows a thumbnails palette and the page contents.
20 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fpage 4d Select this option to show the given page when the reader opens the PDF file.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffitdefault c3 Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows the page contents without zooming. If the reader software is configured to use a zoom factor by default, the page shows with that zoom factor.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffitwidth 6d Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows the page zoomed to fit the width of the reader's window.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fconvert d1 Mark this check box to convert the URLs referencing other ODF files to PDF files with the same name. In the referencing URLs the extensions .odt, .odp, .ods, .odg, and .odm are converted to the extension .pdf.
22 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffitvis 86 Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows the text and graphics on the page zoomed to fit the width of the reader's window.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Feffects 4c Select to export Impress slide transition effects to respective PDF effects.
23 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffitzoom 3e Select a given zoom factor when the reader opens the PDF file.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fprintnone 27 Printing the document is not permitted.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2FPdfUserInterfacePage 66 Select this option to generate a PDF file that is shown in a window displaying the whole initial page.
22 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffitwin 6e Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows the page zoomed to fit entirely into the reader's window.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fcontfacinglayout a2 Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows pages side by side in a continuous column. For more than two pages, the first page is displayed on the right.
27 FILTER_EDIT_RID_PDF_EXPORT_DLG_ED_PAGES 45 Saves the current file to Portable Document Format (PDF) version 1.4.
20 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fzoom 3e Select a given zoom factor when the reader opens the PDF file.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fcontlayout 5b Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows pages in a continuous vertical column.
27 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffirstonleft 10f Select this option to generate a PDF file that shows pages side by side in a continuous column. For more than two pages, the first page is displayed on the left. You must enable support for complex text layout on Language settings - Languages in the Options dialogue box.
17 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsPDF ac Shows the Export as PDF dialogue box, exports the current document to Portable Document Format (PDF), and then opens an e-mail sending window with the PDF as an attachment.
23 uui%2Fui%2Fmacrowarnmedium%2Fcancel 2d Does not allow macros in the document to run.
33 uui%2Fui%2Fmacrowarnmedium%2FalwaysTrustCheckbutton 3d Adds the current macro source to the list of trusted sources.
2c uui%2Fui%2Fmacrowarnmedium%2FviewSignsButton 36 Opens a dialogue box where you can view the signature.
1f uui%2Fui%2Fmacrowarnmedium%2Fok 25 Allows macros in the document to run.
23 SFX2_HID_WARNING_SECURITY_HYPERLINK 6c Enable or disable the macros. Choose %PRODUCTNAME - Security in the Options dialogue box to set the options.
2c uui%2Fui%2Fmacrowarnmedium%2FMacroWarnMedium 6c Enable or disable the macros. Choose %PRODUCTNAME - Security in the Options dialogue box to set the options.
33 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fselectcertificatedialog%2Fdescription 21 Type a purpose for the signature.
30 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fselectcertificatedialog%2Fviewcert 5a Opens the View Certificate dialogue box in which you can examine the selected certificate.
3f xmlsec%2Fui%2Fselectcertificatedialog%2FSelectCertificateDialog 51 Select the certificate that you want to digitally sign the current document with.
32 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fselectcertificatedialog%2Fsignatures 51 Select the certificate that you want to digitally sign the current document with.
e .uno%3AWebHtml 95 Creates a temporary copy of the current document in HTML format, opens the system default Web browser, and displays the HTML file in the Web browser.
20 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_EDIT 5c Opens a dialogue box to edit the selected item (element, attribute, submission, or binding).
24 svx%2Fui%2Fxformspage%2FTBI_ITEM_ADD 76 Opens a dialogue box to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
1f SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_ADD 76 Opens a dialogue box to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
27 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_ADD_ELEMENT 76 Opens a dialogue box to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2Fmodelsadd 45 Opens the Add Model dialogue box in which you can add an XForm model.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2FDataNavigator 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fxformspage%2FTBI_ITEM_EDIT 5c Opens a dialogue box to edit the selected item (element, attribute, submission, or binding).
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2Fmodelslist 2e Selects the XForms model that you want to use.
2e svx%2Fui%2Fxformspage%2FTBI_ITEM_ADD_ATTRIBUTE 76 Opens a dialogue box to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fxformspage%2FTBI_ITEM_ADD_ELEMENT 76 Opens a dialogue box to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2Finstancesremove 42 Deletes the current instance. You cannot delete the last instance.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2Finstancesdetails 2d Switches the display to show or hide details.
18 .uno%3AShowDataNavigator 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document.
1f svx%2Fui%2Fxformspage%2Ftoolbar 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2Fmodelsbutton 28 Adds, renames and removes XForms models.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fxformspage%2FTBI_ITEM_REMOVE 47 Deletes the selected item (element, attribute, submission, or binding).
20 svx%2Fui%2Faddmodeldialog%2Fname f Enter the name.
22 svx%2Fui%2Faddmodeldialog%2Fmodify d4 When enabled, the document status will be set to "modified" when you change any form control that is bound to any data in the model. When not enabled, such a change does not set the document status to "modified".
25 svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2Fmodelsedit 21 Renames the selected Xform model.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2Fmodelsremove 43 Deletes the selected XForm model. You cannot delete the last model.
1d svx%2Fui%2Fxformspage%2Fitems 34 Lists the items that belong to the current instance.
29 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_ADD_ATTRIBUTE 76 Opens a dialogue box to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2Finstances 43 This button has sub-menus to add, to edit, and to remove instances.
22 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_REMOVE 47 Deletes the selected item (element, attribute, submission, or binding).
27 svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2Finstancesadd 39 Opens a dialogue box in which you can add a new instance.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fdatanavigator%2Finstancesedit 42 Opens a dialogue box in which you can modify the current instance.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CALCULATION 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Fcalculate 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Fdatatype 2b Select the data type for the selected item.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Freadonlycond 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_REQUIRED 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Fvalue 2c Enter a default value for the selected item.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Frequired 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Frelevantcond 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
30 svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2FAddDataItemDialog 48 Adds a new item or edits the selected item in the XForms Data Navigator.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Fname 1b Enter the name of the item.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Frequiredcond 1e Declares the item as relevant.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_RELEVANT 1e Declares the item as relevant.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Frelevant 1e Declares the item as relevant.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Fconstraint 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Fconstraintcond 1f Declares the item as read-only.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fadddataitemdialog%2Freadonly 1f Declares the item as read-only.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CONSTRAINT 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_READONLY 1f Declares the item as read-only.
24 svx%2Fui%2Faddconditiondialog%2Fedit 57 Opens the Form Namespaces dialogue box in which you can add, edit or delete namespaces.
32 svx%2Fui%2Faddconditiondialog%2FAddConditionDialog 68 Add a condition in this sub-dialogue box of the Add Item / Edit Item dialogue box of the Data Navigator.
29 svx%2Fui%2Faddconditiondialog%2Fcondition 12 Enter a condition.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fnamespacedialog%2Fdelete 1f Deletes the selected namespace.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fnamespacedialog%2Fnamespaces 34 Lists the currently defined namespaces for the form.
21 svx%2Fui%2Fnamespacedialog%2Fedit 1d Edits the selected namespace.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fnamespacedialog%2Fadd 21 Adds a new namespace to the list.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_LENGTH 30 Specifies the number of characters for a string.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MIN_EXCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an exclusive lower bound for values.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MAX_EXCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an exclusive upper bound for values.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MAX_LENGTH 38 Specifies the maximum number of characters for a string.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_RELEVANT 1e Declares the item as relevant.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_REQUIRED 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BIND_EXPRESSION 77 Enter the DOM node to bind the control model to. Click the ... button for a dialogue box to enter the XPath expression.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XML_DATA_MODEL 43 Select a model from the list of all models in the current document.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BINDING_NAME d1 Select or enter the name of a binding. Selecting the name of an existing binding associates the binding with the form control. Entering a new name creates a new binding and associates it with the form control.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_READONLY 1f Declares the item as read-only.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CONSTRAINT 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CALCULATION 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_DATA_TYPE 41 Select a data type which the control should be validated against.
24 EXTENSIONS_UID_PROP_REMOVE_DATA_TYPE 5a Select a user-defined data type and click the button to delete the user-defined data type.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_TOTAL_DIGITS 5b Specifies the maximum total number of digits that values of the decimal data type can have.
27 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_FRACTION_DIGITS 66 Specifies the maximum total number of fractional digits that values of the decimal data type can have.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MIN_INCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an inclusive lower bound for values.
21 EXTENSIONS_UID_PROP_ADD_DATA_TYPE b5 Click the button to open a dialogue box in which you can enter the name of a new user-defined data type. The new data type inherits all facets from the currently selected data type.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_WHITESPACES f3 Specifies how whitespaces are to be handled when a string of the current data type is being processed. Possible values are Preserve, Replace, and Collapse. The semantics follow the definition at http://www.w3.org/TR/xmlschema-2/#rf-whiteSpace.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_PATTERN 12a Specifies a regular expression pattern. Strings validated against the data type must conform to this pattern to be valid. The XSD data type syntax for regular expressions is different from the regular expression syntax used elsewhere in %PRODUCTNAME, for example in the Find & Replace dialogue box.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MAX_INCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an inclusive upper bound for values.
13 .uno%3APrintDefault 68 Click the Print File Directly icon to print the active document with the current default print settings.
16 .uno%3AVerticalCaption 1ab Draws a line that ends in a rectangular callout with vertical text direction from where you drag in the current document. Drag a handle of the callout to resize the callout. To add text, click the edge of the callout, and then type or paste your text. To change a rectangular callout to a rounded callout, drag the largest corner handle when the pointer changes to a hand. Only available when Asian language support is enabled.
12 .uno%3ADrawCaption 176 Draws a line that ends in a rectangular callout with horizontal text direction from where you drag in the current document. Drag a handle of the callout to resize the callout. To add text, click the edge of the callout, and then type or paste your text. To change a rectangular callout to a rounded callout, drag the largest corner handle when the pointer changes to a hand.
a .uno%3APie 17e Draws a filled shape that is defined by the arc of an oval and two radius lines in the current document. To draw an ellipse pie, drag an oval to the size you want, and then click to define the first radius line. Move your pointer to where you want to place the second radius line and click. You do not need to click on the oval. To draw a circle pie, hold down Shift while you drag.
18 .uno%3AFreeline_Unfilled bf Draws a free-form line where you drag in the current document. To end the line, release the mouse button. To draw a closed shape, release the mouse button near the starting point of the line.
13 .uno%3AVerticalText 14a Draws a text box with vertical text direction where you click or drag in the current document. Click anywhere in the document, and then type or paste your text. You can also move the cursor to where you want to add the text, drag a text box, and then type or paste your text. Only available when Asian language support is enabled.
10 .uno%3ACircleCut 1a6 Draws a filled shape that is defined by the arc of a circle and a diameter line in the current document. To draw a circle segment, drag a circle to the size you want, and then click to define the starting point of the diameter line. Move your pointer to where you want to place the endpoint of the diameter line and click. You do not need to click on the circle. To draw an ellipse segment, hold down Shift while you drag.
b .uno%3ALine 82 Draws a straight line where you drag in the current document. To constrain the line to 45 degrees, hold down Shift while you drag.
11 .uno%3AInsertDraw 79 Click to open or close the Drawing bar, with which you can add shapes, lines, text, and callouts to the current document.
e .uno%3AEllipse ad Draws an oval where you drag in the current document. Click where you want to draw the oval, and drag to the size you want. To draw a circle, hold down Shift while you drag.
13 .uno%3AText_Marquee ca Inserts animated text with horizontal text direction into the current document. Drag a text frame, and then type or paste your text. To assign an animation effect, choose Format - Text - Text Animation.
f .uno%3ADrawText e1 Draws a text box with horizontal text direction where you drag in the current document. Drag a text box to the size you want anywhere in the document, and then type or paste your text. Rotate the text box to get rotated text.
a .uno%3AArc 145 Draws an arc in the current document. To draw an arc, drag an oval to the size you want, and then click to define the starting point of the arc. Move your pointer to where you want to place the endpoint and click. You do not need to click on the oval. To draw an arc that is based on a circle, hold down Shift while you drag.
b .uno%3ARect c3 Draws a rectangle where you drag in the current document. To draw a square, hold down Shift while you drag. Click where you want to place a corner of the rectangle, and drag to the size you want.
17 .uno%3APolygon_Unfilled 125 Draws a line composed of a series of straight line segments. Drag to draw a line segment, click to define the endpoint of the line segment, and then drag to draw a new line segment. Double-click to finish drawing the line. To create a closed shape, double-click the starting point of the line.
16 .uno%3ABezier_Unfilled 15d Draws a smooth Bézier curve. Click where you want the curve to start, drag, release, and then move the pointer to where you want the curve to end and click. Move the pointer and click again to add a straight line segment to the curve. Double-click to finish drawing the curve. To create a closed shape, double-click the starting point of the curve.
13 .uno%3AMoreControls 20 Opens the More Controls toolbar.
c .uno%3ALabel 24 Creates a field for displaying text.
f .uno%3AComboBox 14 Creates a combo box.
11 .uno%3APushbutton 16 Creates a push button.
f .uno%3ACheckBox 14 Creates a check box.
b .uno%3AEdit 13 Creates a text box.
16 .uno%3AFormDesignTools 1e Opens the Form Design toolbar.
e .uno%3AListBox 13 Creates a list box.
15 .uno%3AFormattedField 1a Creates a formatted field.
d .uno%3AConfig 55 The Form Controls toolbar contains tools that you need to create an interactive form.
12 .uno%3ARadioButton 19 Creates an option button.
19 .uno%3AConvertToFormatted 3b The selected control is transformed into a formatted field.
16 .uno%3AConvertToButton 32 The selected control is transformed into a button.
15 .uno%3AConvertToRadio 3a The selected control is transformed into an option button.
18 .uno%3AChangeControlType 6a Calls a sub-menu from which you can choose a control type to replace the control selected in the document.
15 .uno%3AConvertToFixed 31 The selected control is transformed into a label.
14 .uno%3AConvertToList 34 The selected control is transformed into a list box.
14 .uno%3AConvertToEdit 34 The selected control is transformed into a text box.
15 .uno%3AConvertToCombo 35 The selected control is transformed into a combo box.
1b .uno%3AConvertToFileControl 3a The selected control is transformed into a file selection.
18 .uno%3AConvertToImageBtn 39 The selected control is transformed into an image button.
14 .uno%3AConvertToDate 36 The selected control is transformed into a date field.
17 .uno%3AConvertToNumeric 39 The selected control is transformed into a numeric field.
18 .uno%3AConvertToCurrency 3a The selected control is transformed into a currency field.
18 .uno%3AConvertToCheckBox 35 The selected control is transformed into a check box.
14 .uno%3AConvertToTime 36 The selected control is transformed into a time field.
17 .uno%3AConvertToPattern 39 The selected control is transformed into a pattern field.
1c .uno%3AConvertToImageControl 3a The selected control is transformed into an image control.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fshowcoldialog%2FShowColDialog 84 In the Show Columns dialogue box you can select the columns to be shown. Hold down the Shift or Ctrl key to select multiple entries.
10 SID_FM_DELETECOL 26 Deletes the currently selected column.
10 SID_FM_INSERTCOL 49 Calls a sub-menu to select a data field to adopt it in the table control.
10 SID_FM_CHANGECOL 60 Opens a sub-menu to select a data field to replace the data field selected in the table control.
e SID_FM_HIDECOL 1a Hides the selected column.
12 SID_FM_SHOWALLCOLS 2a Click All if you want to show all columns.
f SID_FM_SHOWCOLS 45 Calls a sub-menu from which you can choose the columns to show again.
14 SID_FM_SHOWCOLS_MORE 24 Calls the Show Columns dialogue box.
18 .uno%3AControlProperties 46 Opens a dialogue box for editing the properties of a selected control.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ORIENTATION 50 Specifies the horizontal or vertical orientation for a scrollbar or spin button.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VISIBLESIZE bb Specifies the size of scrollbar thumb in "value units". A value of ("Scroll value max." minus "Scroll value min." ) / 2 would result in a thumb which occupies half of the background area.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ENABLE_VISIBLE 68 Defines whether the control will be visible in live mode. In design mode, the control is always visible.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_FILTERSORT 5f Specifies to show or hide the filtering and sorting items in a selected Navigation Bar control.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_NAVIGATION 54 Specifies to show or hide the navigation items in a selected Navigation Bar control.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_POSITION 55 Specifies to show or hide the positioning items in a selected Navigation Bar control.
13 HID_PROP_SCALEIMAGE 31 Resizes the image to fit the size of the control.
c HID_PROP_TAG 4d Specifies additional information or a descriptive text for the control field.
13 HID_PROP_TIMEFORMAT 37 You can define the desired format for the time display.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LINEEND_FORMAT 5e For text fields, select the line end code to be used when writing text into a database column.
10 HID_PROP_TIMEMAX 54 Determines a time which can not be exceeded by another value introduced by the user.
10 HID_PROP_DATEMAX 54 Determines a date which can not be exceeded by another value introduced by the user.
17 HID_PROP_STRINGITEMLIST 105 Defines the list entries visible in the document. Open this list and type your text. Use Shift+Enter for a new line. With list and combo boxes, you can define the list entries that will be visible in the document. Open the List entries field and type your text.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SPININCREMENT 58 Determines intervals to add or subtract with each activation of the spin button control.
11 HID_PROP_HELPTEXT 5b Provides the option of entering a help text that will be displayed as a tip on the control.
15 HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEMAX 68 Defines a value for the control field which can not be exceeded by another value introduced by the user.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VISUALEFFECT 66 Specifies whether Check boxes and Option buttons are displayed in a 3-D look (default) or a flat look.
12 HID_PROP_IMAGE_URL 6f The Graphics property specifies the graphic's path and file name that you want to have displayed on the button.
15 HID_PROP_STRICTFORMAT 5b If the strict format function is activated (Yes), only the allowed characters are accepted.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_POSITIONY 3e Defines the Y position of the control, relative to the anchor.
11 HID_PROP_EDITMASK 75 Defines the edit mask. By specifying a character code you can determine what the user can enter in the control field.
12 HID_PROP_VALUESTEP 21 Determines spin button intervals.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_FOCUSONCLICK 5e If you set this option to "Yes", the Push Button receives the focus when you click the button.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ICONSIZE 52 Specifies whether the icons in a selected Navigation Bar should be small or large.
13 HID_PROP_MAXTEXTLEN 41 Defines the maximum number of characters that the user can enter.
18 HID_PROP_BACKGROUNDCOLOR 30 Sets the background colour of the control field.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_MULTILINE cf Allows you to use line breaks and formatting in a control field, such as a text box or label. To manually enter a line break, press the Enter key. Select "Multi-line with formatting" to enter formatted text.
11 HID_PROP_DROPDOWN 43 Specifies whether the combo box should drop-down (Yes) or not (No).
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ANCHOR_TYPE 2b Defines where the control will be anchored.
19 HID_PROP_CURRSYM_POSITION 65 Determines if the currency symbol is displayed before or after the number when using currency fields.
e HID_PROP_WIDTH 31 Sets the column width in the table control field.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SYMBOLCOLOR 54 Specifies the colour for symbols on controls, for example the arrows on a scrollbar.
26 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_RECORDACTIONS 50 Specifies to show or hide the action items in a selected Navigation Bar control.
15 HID_PROP_AUTOCOMPLETE 2d Assigns the AutoFill function to a combo box.
10 HID_PROP_ENABLED 69 If a control field has the property "Enabled" (Yes), the form user will be able to use the control field.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BLOCKINCREMENT 5e Specify the value to add or subtract when the user clicks next to the slider on the scrollbar.
15 HID_PROP_CONTROLLABEL 32 Specifies the source for the label of the control.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HEIGHT 22 Defines the height of the control.
10 HID_PROP_HSCROLL 37 Adds the scrollbar type that you specify to a text box.
13 HID_PROP_BUTTONTYPE 51 The Action property determines the action that occurs when you activate a button.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_POSITIONX 3e Defines the X position of the control, relative to the anchor.
f HID_PROP_REPEAT 8c Specifies if the action of a control such as a spin button or a scrollbar repeats when you click the control and hold the mouse button down.
11 HID_PROP_TABINDEX 75 The Tab order property determines the order in which the controls are focused in the form when you press the Tab key.
15 HID_PROP_REPEAT_DELAY 3d Specifies the delay in milliseconds between repeating events.
15 HID_PROP_HIDDEN_VALUE 3f You can enter the data that is inherited by the hidden control.
12 HID_PROP_PRINTABLE 50 Specifies whether you want the control field to appear in a document's printout.
15 HID_PROP_RECORDMARKER 73 Specifies whether the first column is displayed with row labels, in which the current record is marked by an arrow.
13 HID_PROP_DATEFORMAT 3f Here you can determine the desired format for the date readout.
18 HID_PROP_DEFAULT_CHECKED 42 Specifies whether an option or a check box is selected by default.
14 HID_PROP_LITERALMASK 76 Defines the literal mask. The literal mask contains the initial values and is always visible after downloading a form.
17 HID_PROP_MULTISELECTION 36 Allows you to select more than one item in a list box.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_WIDTH 21 Defines the width of the control.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TEXTTYPE cf Allows you to use line breaks and formatting in a control field, such as a text box or label. To manually enter a line break, press the Enter key. Select "Multi-line with formatting" to enter formatted text.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TOGGLE 122 Specifies if a Push Button behaves as a Toggle Button. If you set Toggle to "Yes", you can switch between the "selected" and "not selected" control states when you click the button or press the spacebar while the control has the focus. A button in the "selected" state appears "pressed in".
f HID_PROP_BORDER 62 Determines if the field's border should be displayed "Without frame", with a "3-D look" or "Flat".
29 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HIDEINACTIVESELECTION 6c Specifies whether a text selection on a control remains selected when a the focus is no longer on a control.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BORDERCOLOR 55 Specifies the border colour for controls that have the Border property set to "flat".
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_DATE 16 Sets the default date.
11 HID_PROP_TRISTATE 77 Specifies whether a check box can also represent ZERO values of a linked database apart from the TRUE and FALSE values.
10 HID_PROP_DATEMIN 33 Determines the earliest date that a user can enter.
10 HID_PROP_HELPURL 83 Specifies a batch label in URL spelling which refers to a help document and which can be called with the help of the control field.
15 HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEMIN 67 You can determine here a value for the control field to prevent the user from entering a smaller value.
1b HID_PROP_DEFAULT_SELECT_SEQ 3a Specifies the list box entry to mark as the default entry.
10 HID_PROP_TIMEMIN 32 Determines the minimum time that a user can enter.
12 HID_PROP_ROWHEIGHT 32 Specifies the row height of a table control field.
19 HID_PROP_DECIMAL_ACCURACY 4c Determines the number of digits displayed to the right of the decimal point.
d HID_PROP_NAME 9f On the Properties tab page, this option specifies the name for the control field. On the Form Properties tab page, this option specifies the name for the form.
11 HID_PROP_READONLY 49 Determines if the control is read-only (Yes) or if it can be edited (No).
19 HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEDEFAULT 2d Sets the default value for the control field.
18 HID_PROP_SCROLLVALUE_MAX 31 Specify the maximum value of a scrollbar control.
1c HID_PROP_DEFAULT_SCROLLVALUE 29 Sets the default value for the scrollbar.
15 HID_PROP_TARGET_FRAME 6b Specifies the target frame to display the document that is opened by the "Open document / web page" action.
18 HID_PROP_SCROLLVALUE_MIN 31 Specify the minimum value of a scrollbar control.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LINEINCREMENT 5a Specify the value to add or subtract when the user clicks the arrow icon on the scrollbar.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_TIME 16 Sets the default time.
12 HID_PROP_LINECOUNT 8d Specifies how many lines should be displayed in the drop-down list. This setting is only active if you chose "Yes" in the "Drop-down" option.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TEXT 34 Sets the default text for a text box or a combo box.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_WORDBREAK 24 Displays text on more than one line.
16 HID_PROP_NAVIGATIONBAR 59 Specifies whether to display the navigation bar on the lower border of the table control.
17 HID_PROP_DEFAULT_BUTTON 73 The Default button property specifies that the corresponding button will be operated when you press the Return key.
d HID_PROP_SPIN 6e The "Yes" option transforms the control field into a spin button, where corresponding arrow buttons are added.
10 HID_PROP_TABSTOP 55 The Tab stop property determines if a control field can be selected with the tab key.
18 HID_PROP_SHOWTHOUSANDSEP 1e Inserts a thousands separator.
12 HID_PROP_ECHO_CHAR b5 If the text box is used as a password input, enter the ASCII-code of the display character. This character is displayed instead of the characters typed by the user for the password.
e HID_PROP_LABEL 55 The Label property sets the label of the control field that is displayed in the form.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_WHEEL_BEHAVIOR 165 Sets whether the value changes when the user scrolls a mouse wheel. Never: No change of the value. When focused: (default) The value changes when the control has the focus and the wheel is pointing at the control and gets scrolled. Always: The value changes when the wheel is pointing at the control and gets scrolled, no matter which control has the focus.
13 HID_PROP_TARGET_URL 59 Specifies the URL address that opens when you click an "Open document / web page" button.
e HID_PROP_ALIGN 4f Specifies the alignment option for text or graphics that are used on a control.
47 modules%2Fspropctrlr%2Fui%2Flabelselectiondialog%2FLabelSelectionDialog 63 Mark the No assignment check box to remove the link between a control and the assigned label field.
17 HID_PROP_CURRENCYSYMBOL 3e You can enter a character or a string for the currency symbol.
12 HID_PROP_FORMATKEY 5a Specifies the format code for the control. Click the ... button to select the format code.
d HID_PROP_FONT 3a Select the font for the text that is in the control field.
18 HID_PROP_LIST_CELL_RANGE 5a Enter a cell range that contains the entries for a list box or combo box on a spreadsheet.
1b HID_PROP_CELL_EXCHANGE_TYPE 4a Select the mode of linking a list box with a linked cell on a spreadsheet.
13 HID_PROP_BOUND_CELL 84 Specifies the reference to a linked cell on a spreadsheet. The live state or contents of the control are linked to the cell content.
16 HID_PROP_EMPTY_IS_NULL c9 Defines how an empty string input should be handled. If set to Yes, an input string of length zero will be treated as a value NULL. If set to No, any input will be treated as-is without any conversion.
17 HID_PROP_LISTSOURCETYPE 3e Determines the data to fill the lists in list and combo boxes.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_UNCHECKEDREFVALUE 112 Check boxes and radio buttons in spreadsheets can be bound to cells in the current document. If the control is enabled, the value you enter in Reference value (on) is copied to the cell. If the control is disabled, the value from Reference value (off) is copied to the cell.
17 HID_PROP_FILTERPROPOSAL ff While designing your form, you can set the "Filter proposal" property for each text box in the Data tab of the corresponding Properties dialogue box. In subsequent searches in the filter mode, you can select from all information contained in these fields.
16 HID_PROP_CONTROLSOURCE 49 Specifies the field of the data source table to which the control refers.
11 HID_PROP_REFVALUE d3 You can enter a reference value for the web form, which will be remitted to a server when sending the form. With database forms, the value entered is written in the database field, assigned to the control field.
14 HID_PROP_BOUNDCOLUMN a9 Use an index to specify the table field or table SQL query to link to the field that is provided under Data field. Valid values for this property are 1, 2, 3, and so on.
13 HID_PROP_LISTSOURCE b3 With database forms, specifies the data source for the list content of the form-element. This field can be used to define a value list for documents without a database connection.
14 HID_EVT_MOUSEPRESSED 6f The Mouse button pressed event occurs if the mouse button is pressed while the mouse pointer is on the control.
14 HID_EVT_MOUSEDRAGGED 65 The Mouse moved while key pressed event takes place when the mouse is dragged while a key is pressed.
15 HID_EVT_MOUSERELEASED 71 The Mouse button released event occurs if the mouse button is released while the mouse pointer is on the control.
14 HID_EVT_MOUSEENTERED 4c The Mouse inside event takes place if the mouse is inside the control field.
10 HID_EVT_KEYTYPED 5b The Key pressed event occurs when the user presses any key while the control has the focus.
17 HID_EVT_ACTIONPERFORMED 3a The Execute action event occurs when an action is started.
1e HID_EVT_APPROVEACTIONPERFORMED 4d This event takes place before an action is triggered by clicking the control.
f HID_EVT_CHANGED 82 The Changed event takes place when the control loses the focus and the content of the control has changed since it lost the focus.
13 HID_EVT_MOUSEEXITED 50 The Mouse outside event takes place when the mouse is outside the control field.
13 HID_EVT_TEXTCHANGED 52 The Text modified event takes place if you enter or modify text in an input field.
12 HID_EVT_MOUSEMOVED 41 The Mouse moved event occurs if the mouse moves over the control.
11 HID_EVT_FOCUSLOST 4b The When losing focus event takes place if a control field loses the focus.
18 HID_EVT_ITEMSTATECHANGED 59 The Item status changed event takes place if the status of the control field has changed.
d HID_EVT_KEYUP 5d The Key released event occurs when the user releases any key while the control has the focus.
13 HID_EVT_FOCUSGAINED 51 The When receiving focus event takes place if a control field receives the focus.
15 .uno%3AFormProperties 66 In this dialogue box you can specify, among others, the data source and the events for the whole form.
18 HID_PROP_SUBMIT_ENCODING 32 Specifies the type for encoding the data transfer.
16 HID_PROP_SUBMIT_METHOD 40 Specifies the method to transfer the completed form information.
18 HID_EVT_APPROVEPARAMETER 63 The Fill parameters event occurs when the form to be loaded has parameters that must be filled out.
12 HID_EVT_POSITIONED 60 The After record change event occurs directly after the current record pointer has been changed.
11 HID_EVT_ROWCHANGE 58 The After record action event occurs directly after the current record has been changed.
18 HID_EVT_APPROVEROWCHANGE 4b The Before record action event occurs before the current record is changed.
15 HID_EVT_CONFIRMDELETE 4b The Confirm deletion event occurs as soon as data is deleted from the form.
10 HID_EVT_UNLOADED 73 The When unloading event occurs directly after the form has been unloaded; that is, separated from its data source.
10 HID_EVT_RELOADED 49 TheWhen reloading event occurs directly after the form has been reloaded.
17 HID_EVT_APPROVERESETTED 37 The Prior to reset event occurs before a form is reset.
11 HID_EVT_UNLOADING 67 The Before unloading event occurs before the form is unloaded; that is, separated from its data source.
13 HID_EVT_AFTERUPDATE 66 The After update event occurs after the changed control content has been written into the data source.
11 HID_EVT_SUBMITTED 40 The Before submitting event occurs before the form data is sent.
15 HID_EVT_ERROROCCURRED 58 The Error occurred event is activated if an error occurs when accessing the data source.
10 HID_EVT_RESETTED 3d The After resetting event occurs after a form has been reset.
13 HID_EVT_POSITIONING 53 The Before record change event occurs before the current record pointer is changed.
e HID_EVT_LOADED 46 The When loading event occurs directly after the form has been loaded.
11 HID_EVT_RELOADING 3e The Before reloading event occurs before the form is reloaded.
14 HID_PROP_ALLOW_EDITS 27 Determines if the data can be modified.
13 HID_PROP_NAVIGATION 4d Specifies whether the navigation functions in the lower form bar can be used.
14 HID_PROP_SLAVEFIELDS 6c If you create a sub-form, enter the variable where possible values from the parent form field can be stored.
18 HID_PROP_ALLOW_ADDITIONS 20 Determines if data can be added.
e HID_PROP_CYCLE 3f Determines how the navigation should be done using the tab key.
12 HID_PROP_DATAENTRY 70 Determines if the form only allows the addition of new data (Yes) or if it allows other properties as well (No).
15 HID_PROP_CURSORSOURCE ff Determines the content to be used for the form. The content can be an existing table or a query (previously created in the database), or it can be defined by an SQL statement. Before you enter the content you have to define the exact type in Content type.
18 HID_PROP_ALLOW_DELETIONS 26 Determines if the data can be deleted.
13 HID_PROP_DATASOURCE 37 Defines the data source to which the form should refer.
19 HID_PROP_CURSORSOURCETYPE 8a Defines whether the data source is to be an existing database table or query, or if the form is to be generated based on an SQL statement.
1a HID_PROP_ESCAPE_PROCESSING 46 Specifies whether the SQL statement is to be analysed by %PRODUCTNAME.
15 HID_PROP_MASTERFIELDS 82 If you create a sub-form, enter the data field of the parent form responsible for the synchronisation between parent and sub-form.
18 HID_PROP_FILTER_CRITERIA 8c Enter the required conditions for filtering the data in the form. The filter specifications follow SQL rules without using the WHERE clause.
16 HID_PROP_SORT_CRITERIA 9c Specifies the conditions to sort the data in the form. The specification of the sorting conditions follows SQL rules without the use of the ORDER BY clause.
2a modules%2Fspropctrlr%2Fui%2Ftaborder%2FupB 5c Click the Move Up button to shift the selected control one position higher in the tab order.
2c modules%2Fspropctrlr%2Fui%2Ftaborder%2FautoB 6f Click the Automatic Sort button to automatically sort the controls according to their position in the document.
2c modules%2Fspropctrlr%2Fui%2Ftaborder%2FdownB 5d Click the Move Down button to shift the selected control one position lower in the tab order.
10 .uno%3ATabDialog 83 In the Tab Order dialogue box you can modify the order in which control fields acquire the focus when the user presses the tab key.
2f modules%2Fspropctrlr%2Fui%2Ftaborder%2FCTRLtree 76 Lists all controls in the form. These controls can be selected with the tab key in the given order from top to bottom.
d HID_FIELD_SEL 88 The field selection window lists all database fields of the table or query that was specified as the data source in the Form Properties.
f .uno%3AAddField 55 Opens a window in which you can select a database field to add to the form or report.
1e .uno%3ASwitchControlDesignMode b1 Toggles the Design mode on or off. This function is used to switch quickly between Design and User mode. Activate to edit the form controls, deactivate to use the form controls.
1a .uno%3AShowPropertyBrowser 3a Starts the Properties dialogue box for the selected entry.
12 HID_FORM_NAVIGATOR 68 The Form Navigator contains a list of all created (logical) forms with the corresponding control fields.
a SID_FM_NEW 6f Adds new elements to the form. The Add function can only be called if a form is selected in the Form Navigator.
d SID_FM_DELETE 1b Deletes the selected entry.
14 SID_FM_RENAME_OBJECT 1c Renames the selected object.
15 .uno%3AShowFmExplorer 85 Opens the Form Navigator. The Form Navigator displays all forms and sub-forms of the current document with their respective controls.
f SID_FM_NEW_FORM 23 Creates a new form in the document.
11 SID_FM_NEW_HIDDEN bc Creates a hidden control in the selected form that is not visible on screen and is hidden from the user. A hidden control serves to include data that is transmitted together with the form.
34 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Ftableselectionpage%2Ftable 1c Specifies the desired table.
39 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Ftableselectionpage%2Fdatasource 3a Specifies the data source that contains the desired table.
38 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fcontentfieldpage%2Fselectfield 3f Displays the data fields that are accepted into the form field.
32 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fcontenttablepage%2Ftable 76 In the Table field, select the table containing the data field whose content should be displayed in the control field.
3e DBP_EDIT_RID_PAGE_LCW_CONTENTSELECTION_FIELD_ET_DISPLAYEDFIELD 4a Specifies the field whose data are to be shown in the combo or list boxes.
3e DBP_LISTBOX_RID_PAGE_LCW_CONTENTSELECTION_FIELD_LB_SELECTFIELD 3d Displays all table fields chosen on the previous Wizard page.
33 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Ffieldlinkpage%2Flisttable 5b Specifies the linked table data field, which is related to the specified value table field.
34 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Ffieldlinkpage%2Fvaluefield 5d Specifies the current form data field which should be related to a field in the linked table.
3b modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Foptiondbfieldpage%2FnoRadiobutton 7a Specifies that the value of this combination field will not be written in the database and will only be saved in the form.
3c modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Foptiondbfieldpage%2FyesRadiobutton 6d Specifies whether the user's entered or selected combination field value should be saved in a database field.
42 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Foptiondbfieldpage%2FstoreInFieldCombobox 4b Specifies the data field where the combination field value should be saved.
13 .uno%3AOpenReadOnly 3a Opens forms in Design Mode so that the form can be edited.
11 .uno%3AUseWizards 51 Specifies whether to start the wizard automatically when inserting a new control.
15 .uno%3ADesignerDialog 67 Specifies whether to show or hide the Styles window, which is where you can assign and organise Styles.
11 .uno%3AStyleApply 57 Assigns a style to the current paragraph, selected paragraphs, or to a selected object.
15 SVX_HID_STYLE_LISTBOX 57 Assigns a style to the current paragraph, selected paragraphs, or to a selected object.
16 .uno%3AStyleApplyState 57 Assigns a style to the current paragraph, selected paragraphs, or to a selected object.
13 .uno%3ACharFontName 4d Allows you to select a font name from the list or enter a font name directly.
11 .uno%3AFontHeight 5d Allows you to choose between different font sizes from the list, or to enter a size manually.
1e .uno%3ATextdirectionLeftToRigh 2f Specifies the horizontal direction of the text.
1e .uno%3ATextdirectionTopToBotto 2d Specifies the vertical direction of the text.
16 .uno%3ADecrementIndent 92 Click the Decrease Indent icon to reduce the left indent of the current paragraph or cell content and set it to the previous default tab position.
16 .uno%3AIncrementIndent 90 Click the Increase Indent icon to increase the left indent of the current paragraph or cell content and set it to the next default tab position.
10 .uno%3ABackColor 15c Applies the current highlight colour to the background of a text selection. If no text is selected, click the Highlight Colour icon, select the text that you want to highlight, and then click the Highlight Colour icon again. To change the highlight colour, click the arrow next to the Highlight Colour icon, and then click the colour that you want.
16 .uno%3ABackgroundColor ad Click to open a toolbar where you can click a background colour for a paragraph. The colour is applied to the background of the current paragraph or the selected paragraphs.
18 .uno%3AParaspaceIncrease 5f Click the Increase Spacing icon to increase the paragraph spacing above the selected paragraph.
18 .uno%3AParaspaceDecrease 5f Click the Decrease Spacing icon to decrease the paragraph spacing above the selected paragraph.
15 .uno%3ASetBorderStyle 76 Click the Borders icon to open the Borders toolbar, with which you can modify the border of a sheet area or an object.
10 .uno%3ALineStyle 60 Click this icon to open the Line Style toolbar, with which you can modify the border line style.
15 .uno%3AFrameLineColor 89 Click the Line Colour (of the border) icon to open the Border Colour toolbar, which enables you to change the border colour of an object.
17 .uno%3AToggleAnchorType 2f Allows you to switch between anchoring options.
14 .uno%3AOptimizeTable 57 Opens a toolbar that contains functions for optimising the rows and columns in a table.
13 .uno%3ALineEndStyle 69 Opens the Arrowheads toolbar. Use the symbols shown to define the style for the end of the selected line.
1d .uno%3AToggleObjectRotateMode 1c Rotates the selected object.
12 .uno%3AObjectAlign 2b Modifies the alignment of selected objects.
15 .uno%3ADecrementLevel 50 Moves the selected paragraph down one level in a numbering or bullets hierarchy.
15 .uno%3AIncrementLevel 50 Moves the selected paragraph up one level in the numbering or bullets hierarchy.
d .uno%3AMoveUp 39 Positions the selected paragraph before the one above it.
f .uno%3AMoveDown 38 Positions the selected paragraph after the one below it.
14 .uno%3ADefaultBullet 5b Assigns bullet points to the selected paragraphs, or removes them from bulleted paragraphs.
e .uno%3AOpenURL 9e Loads a document specified by an entered URL. You can type a new URL, edit an URL or select one from the list. Displays the full path of the current document.
d .uno%3AReload 3a Replaces the current document with the last saved version.
1c HID_HELP_TEXT_SELECTION_MODE d6 You can enable a selection cursor in a read-only text document or in the Help. Choose Edit - Select Text or open the context menu of a read-only document and choose Select Text. The selection cursor does not blink.
e .uno%3AEditDoc 3b Enables you to edit a read-only document or database table.
11 .uno%3ADSBEditDoc 3d Turns the edit mode for the current database table on or off.
b .uno%3AStop 5e Click to interrupt the current loading process, Ctrl-click to interrupt all loading processes.
18 .uno%3AExportDirectToPDF 50 Exports the current document directly as PDF. No settings dialogue box is shown.
15 .uno%3AStatusGetTitle 42 Displays information about the active %PRODUCTNAME Basic document.
18 .uno%3AStatusGetPosition 7d Displays the current cursor position in the %PRODUCTNAME Basic document. The row number is specified, then the column number.
18 HID_ICCDIALOG_CANCEL_BTN 27 Closes the dialogue box without saving.
14 HID_ICCDIALOG_OK_BTN 22 Applies the data to your document.
17 HID_ICCDIALOG_RESET_BTN 3f Resets the entries in the dialogue box to their original state.
14 .uno%3AEditHyperlink 21 Opens the Hyperlink dialogue box.
16 .uno%3AHyperlinkDialog 44 Opens a dialogue box that enables you to create and edit hyperlinks.
1c .uno%3AOpenHyperlinkOnCursor 30 Opens the hyperlink in your default web browser.
18 HID_ICCDIALOG_CHOICECTRL 2c Select the type of hyperlink to be inserted.
1c .uno%3ACopyHyperlinkLocation 20 Copies the URL to the clipboard.
16 .uno%3ARemoveHyperlink 2a Removes the hyperlink, leaving plain text.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkinternetpage%2Fname 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinknewdocpage%2Findication 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkmailpage%2Fname 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkinternetpage%2Findication 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinknewdocpage%2Fscript 8d Opens the Assign Macro dialogue box, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkdocpage%2Fscript 8d Opens the Assign Macro dialogue box, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkinternetpage%2Fscript 8d Opens the Assign Macro dialogue box, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinknewdocpage%2Fname 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
33 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkinternetpage%2Flinktyp_internet 1a Creates an http hyperlink.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkmarkdialog%2Fapply 45 Inserts the target in the Target field of the Hyperlink dialogue box.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkmarkdialog%2FTreeListBox 48 Specifies the position in the target document where you wish to jump to.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkinternetpage%2Fpassword 3f Specifies your password, if you are working with FTP addresses.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkinternetpage%2Fanonymous 3d Allows you to log in to the FTP address as an anonymous user.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkmarkdialog%2Fclose 6a Once the hyperlink has been completely entered, click on Close to set the link and leave the dialogue box.
1a CUI_HID_HYPERDLG_INET_PATH a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkmailpage%2Findication 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkinternetpage%2Flogin 41 Specifies your login name, if you are working with FTP addresses.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkmailpage%2Fframe c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkdocpage%2Fname 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinknewdocpage%2Fframe c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkdocpage%2Fframe c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkinternetpage%2Fframe c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkdocpage%2Findication 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkinternetpage%2Flinktyp_ftp 19 Creates an FTP hyperlink.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkinternetpage%2Fform 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkmailpage%2Fscript 8d Opens the Assign Macro dialogue box, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkmailpage%2Fform 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinknewdocpage%2Fform 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkdocpage%2Fform 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkmailpage%2Fsubject 57 Specifies the subject that is inserted in the subject line of the new message document.
1a CUI_HID_HYPERDLG_MAIL_PATH 36 Assigns the specified e-mail address to the hyperlink.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkmailpage%2Fadressbook 27 Hides or shows the data source browser.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkdocpage%2Furl 45 Specifies the URL, which results from the entries in Path and Target.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkdocpage%2Fbrowse 2a Opens the Target in Document dialogue box.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkdocpage%2Ftarget 4c Specifies a target for the hyperlink into the document specified under Path.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkdocpage%2Ffileopen 39 Opens the Open dialogue box, where you can select a file.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinkdocpage%2FHyperlinkDocPage a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame.
19 CUI_HID_HYPERDLG_DOC_PATH a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinknewdocpage%2Ftypes 2d Specifies the file type for the new document.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinknewdocpage%2Fcreate 40 Opens the Select Path dialogue box, where you can select a path.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinknewdocpage%2Fpath 4c Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinknewdocpage%2Feditnow 4e Specifies that the new document is created and immediately opened for editing.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fhyperlinknewdocpage%2Feditlater 48 Specifies that the document is created but it is not immediately opened.
13 .uno%3APreviousPage 30 Moves back to the previous page in the document.
f .uno%3ANextPage 2f Moves forward to the next page in the document.
10 .uno%3AFirstPage 28 Moves to the first page of the document.
f .uno%3ALastPage 27 Moves to the last page of the document.
f .uno%3ACloseWin 1a Closes the current window.
16 .uno%3ADSBAdministrate c1 Opens a dialogue box to add/edit/remove a database file from the list of registered databases. The same dialogue box opens by choosing %PRODUCTNAME Base - Databases in the Options dialogue box.
10 .uno%3ADSBEditDB 2d Opens the selected database file for editing.
21 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_RENAME_ENTRY c5 To rename an entry, call this command and enter the new name. You can also do this by selecting the entry and pressing F2. The database must support renaming, otherwise this command is not enabled.
18 .uno%3ADSBrowserExplorer 36 Turns on and off the view of the data source explorer.
19 .uno%3ADSBCloseConnection 6a Closes the connection to the data source. See %PRODUCTNAME Base - Connections in the Options dialogue box.
f .uno%3ASortDown 39 Sorts the data of the selected field in descending order.
11 .uno%3AAutoFilter 4f Filters the records, based on the content of the currently selected data field.
17 .uno%3ARemoveFilterSort 51 Cancels the filter settings and displays all of the records in the current table.
1f HID_BROWSER_REFRESH_REBUILDVIEW 6b Rebuilds the view of the database table. Use this command when you have changed the structure of the table.
e .uno%3ARefresh 1d Refreshes the displayed data.
13 .uno%3ASbaBrwInsert 59 Inserts all fields of the marked record into the current document at the cursor position.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftableformat 84 Opens the Table Format dialogue box, which enables you to define the table properties such as borders, background, and column width.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Frowonly 32 Inserts an empty heading line into the text table.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ffromdatabase 1d Accepts the database formats.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fallleft 3e Removes all database fields from the Table column(s) list box.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftabledbcols 42 Specifies the database columns to be inserted into the text table.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fcolumnname 5a Uses the field names of the database table as headings for each of the text table columns.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fallright 43 Moves all listed database fields into the Table column(s) list box.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fnumformat 63 Specifies a format from the list, if the format information of certain data fields is not accepted.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fastable 50 Inserts data selected from the data source browser into the document as a table.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftablecols 3c Lists all database columns to be inserted into the document.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftableheading 4d Specifies whether to insert a heading line for the columns in the text table.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Foneright 44 Moves the selected database field into the Table column(s) list box.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fautoformat 7f Opens the AutoFormat dialogue box, in which you can select format styles that are immediately applied when inserting the table.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Foneleft 45 Removes the selected database field from the Table column(s) list box
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftextview 9f Lists the database columns that you selected to be inserted into the document. You can also enter text here. This text will be also inserted into the document.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftoedit 5d Moves the fields that you selected in the Database columns list box into the selection field.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fparastyle 73 This is where you can select other Paragraph Styles to apply to the paragraph you want to insert into the document.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fasfields 4f Inserts data selected from the data source browser into the document as fields.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftabletxtcols 47 Select the database columns that you want to insert it in the document.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fastext 4d Inserts data selected from the data source browser into the document as text.
28 .uno%3ADataSourceBrowser%2FInsertContent 4b Updates the contents of the existing database fields by the marked records.
11 .uno%3AFilterCrit 28 Allows you to set the filtering options.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Fvalue1 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fval3 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fval1 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fval2 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Fcond2 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Fvalue2 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Fcond1 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fconnect2 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fcond2 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Fvalue3 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
35 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2FQueryFilterDialog 3b Specifies the logical conditions to filter your table data.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Ffield2 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
1f .uno%3ADataFilterStandardFilter 3b Specifies the logical conditions to filter your table data.
27 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Fop2 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Fcond3 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fcond3 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fconnect1 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Ffield2 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Ffield3 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
42 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2FStandardFilterDialog 3b Specifies the logical conditions to filter your table data.
27 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Fop3 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Ffield1 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Ffield3 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fqueryfilterdialog%2Ffield1 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fcond1 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
10 .uno%3AOrderCrit 3a Specifies the sort order (either ascending or descending).
29 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FpbSearchAgain 1d Starts or cancels the search.
25 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FcbRegular 22 Searches with regular expressions.
27 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FcbStartOver 78 Restarts the search. A forwards search restarts with the first record. A backwards search restarts with the last record.
27 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FcbBackwards 63 Specifies that the search process will run in reverse direction, from the last to the first record.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FcbWildCard 27 Allows a search with a * or ? wildcard.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FlbPosition 45 Specifies the relationship of the search term and the field contents.
21 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2Fclose 63 Closes the dialogue box. The settings of the last search will be saved until you quit %PRODUCTNAME.
29 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FrbSingleField 28 Searches through a specified data field.
27 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FcbUseFormat 57 Specifies that all field formats are considered when searching in the current document.
2b cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FrbSearchForText 3c Enter the search term in the box or select it from the list.
10 .uno%3ARecSearch 23 Searches database tables and forms.
22 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FcbCase 54 Specifies that upper- and lower-case are taken into consideration during the search.
22 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FlbForm 46 Specifies the logical form in which you want the search to take place.
2b cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FrbSearchForNull 39 Specifies that fields will be found that contain no data.
2e cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FrbSearchForNotNull 36 Specifies that fields will be found that contain data.
27 cui%2Fui%2Ffmsearchdialog%2FrbAllFields 1c Searches through all fields.
11 .uno%3AFormFilter 4d Prompts the database server to filter the visible data by specified criteria.
13 .uno%3AFormFiltered 3f Switches between the filtered and unfiltered view of the table.
15 .uno%3AViewFormAsGrid 39 Activates an additional table view when in the form view.
2d .uno%3ADataSourceBrowser%2FDocumentDataSource 57 Displays, in the data source browser, the table that is linked to the current document.
14 .uno%3ASbaExecuteSql 31 Runs the SQL query and displays the query result.
13 .uno%3ADBClearQuery 3f Clears the query and removes all tables from the design window.
28 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftablesjoindialog%2Fclose 23 Closes the Add Tables dialogue box.
26 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftablesjoindialog%2Fadd 25 Inserts the currently selected table.
2c dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftablesjoindialog%2Ftablelist 1b Lists the available tables.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftablesjoindialog%2Fqueries 13 Shows only queries.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftablesjoindialog%2Ftables 12 Shows only tables.
19 .uno%3ADBChangeDesignMode 36 Displays the design view or the SQL view of the query.
13 .uno%3ASbaNativeSql 8c In Native SQL mode you can enter SQL commands that are not interpreted by $[officename], but are instead passed directly to the data source.
16 .uno%3ADBViewFunctions 5c Displays the "Function" row in the lower part of the design view of the Query Design window.
17 .uno%3ADBViewTableNames 3f Displays the "Table" row in the lower part of the Query Design.
14 .uno%3ADBViewAliases 3f Displays the "Alias" row in the lower part of the Query Design.
17 .uno%3ADBDistinctValues 66 Expands the created select statement of the SQL Query in the current column by the parameter DISTINCT.
13 .uno%3ASelectObject 35 Allows you to select objects in the current document.
11 .uno%3ASourceView 8b Displays the source text of the current HTML document. This view is available when creating a new HTML document or opening an existing one.
11 SW_HID_SOURCEVIEW 8b Displays the source text of the current HTML document. This view is available when creating a new HTML document or opening an existing one.
13 .uno%3ALayoutStatus 65 Displays the current Page Style. Double-click to edit the style, right-click to select another style.
10 .uno%3AStateZoom 2f Specifies the current page display zoom factor.
11 .uno%3AInsertMode 5d Displays the current insert mode. You can toggle between INSRT = insert and OVER = overwrite.
1a .uno%3AStatusSelectionMode 36 Here you can switch between different selection modes.
10 SID_MODIFYSTATUS 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents.
12 .uno%3ACurrentTime 1a Displays the current time.
12 .uno%3ACurrentDate 1a Displays the current date.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fmosaicdialog%2Fedges 2f Enhances, or sharpens, the edges of the object.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fmosaicdialog%2Fheight 2b Defines the height of the individual tiles.
1f .uno%3AGraphicFilterRemoveNoise 2a Removes noise by applying a median filter.
1c .uno%3AGraphicFilterSolarize cb Opens a dialogue box for defining solarisation. Solarisation refers to an effect that looks like what can happen when there is too much light during photo development. The colours become partly inverted.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterInvert 88 Inverts the colour values of a colour image, or the brightness values of a greyscale image. Apply the filter again to revert the effect.
1b .uno%3AGraphicFilterSharpen 32 Sharpens the image by applying a high pass filter.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fsolarizedialog%2Fvalue 5b Specifies the degree of brightness, in percent, above which the pixels are to be solarised.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fsolarizedialog%2Finvert 45 Specifies whether the pixels to be solarised are also to be inverted.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fagingdialog%2Fvalue 86 Defines the intensity of ageing, in percent. At 0% you see the grey values of all pixels. At 100% only the red colour channel remains.
19 .uno%3AGraphicFilterSobel 7f Displays the image as a charcoal sketch. The contours of the image are drawn in black, and the original colours are suppressed.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fmosaicdialog%2Fwidth 2a Defines the width of the individual tiles.
1b .uno%3AGraphicFilterToolbox 71 This icon on the Image bar opens the Image Filter bar, where you can use various filters on the selected picture.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterSmooth 39 Softens or blurs the image by applying a low pass filter.
19 .uno%3AGraphicFilterSepia a2 All pixels are set to their grey values, and then the green and blue colour channels are reduced by the amount you specify. The red colour channel is not changed.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterPoster 3f Opens a dialogue box to determine the number of poster colours.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fposterdialog%2Fvalue 44 Specifies the number of colours to which the image is to be reduced.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterPopart 26 Converts an image to a pop-art format.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterRelief 2d Displays a dialogue box for creating reliefs.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterMosaic 47 Joins small groups of pixels into rectangular areas of the same colour.
f .uno%3AGrafMode a2 Lists view attributes for the selected graphic object. The embedded or linked graphic object in the current file will not be changed, only the view of the object.
e .uno%3AGrafRed 56 Specifies the proportion of red RGB colour components for the selected graphic object.
10 .uno%3AGrafGreen 58 Specifies the proportion of green RGB colour components for the selected graphic object.
f .uno%3AGrafBlue 50 Specifies the proportion of blue RGB colour components for the selected graphic.
14 .uno%3AGrafLuminance 39 Specifies the brightness for the selected graphic object.
13 .uno%3AGrafContrast 3e Specifies the contrast for viewing the selected graphic image.
10 .uno%3AGrafGamma 72 Specifies the gamma value for the view of the selected object, which affects the brightness of the midtone values.
17 .uno%3AGrafTransparence 31 Specifies the transparency in the graphic object.
b .uno%3ACrop 3b Drag any of the eight cropping handles to crop the picture.
13 .uno%3AGrafAttrCrop 76 Allows to crop the display of an inserted picture. Only the display gets cropped, the inserted picture is not changed.
18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.paper 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
16 .uno%3ABasicShapes.can 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.block-arc 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3ABasicShapes.ring 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
19 .uno%3ABasicShapes.circle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.frame 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1b .uno%3ABasicShapes.pentagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ABasicShapes.round-quadrat 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.quadrat 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3ABasicShapes.cube 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.cross 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3ABasicShapes.round-rectangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.diamond 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
12 .uno%3ABasicShapes 57 Opens the Basic Shapes toolbar which you can use to insert graphics into your document.
21 .uno%3ABasicShapes.right-triangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ABasicShapes.parallelogram 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.rectangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.ellipse 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3ABasicShapes.isosceles-triangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.octagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3ABasicShapes.circle-pie 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.hexagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.trapezoid 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3AArrowShapes.s-sharped-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.quad-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.circular-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-down--arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2b .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.down-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
24 .uno%3AArrowShapes.split-round-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1b .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.pentagon-right 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3AArrowShapes.right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
12 .uno%3AArrowShapes 55 Opens the Block Arrows toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.corner-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3AArrowShapes.chevron 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.quad-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3AArrowShapes.split-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.striped-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.notched-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-2 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.rectangular-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-3 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
14 .uno%3ACalloutShapes 51 Opens the Callouts toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document.
23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-1 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2e .uno%3ACalloutShapes.round-rectangular-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.round-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.cloud-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
14 .uno%3AColorSettings 4c With the Colour toolbar you can edit some properties of the selected object.
2e .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-magnetic-disk 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
32 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-sequential-access 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-delay 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2c .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-stored-data 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-merge 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-extract 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-collate 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-or 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-summing-junction 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2d .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-punched-tape 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
36 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-direct-access-storage 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
33 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-predefined-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2c .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-preparation 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-display 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
32 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-alternate-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2a .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-connector 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-data 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-sort 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-manual-operation 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2b .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-terminator 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-decision 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
16 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes 52 Opens the Flowchart toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document.
29 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-document 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2d .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-manual-input 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2e .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-multidocument 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-internal-storage 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
33 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-off-page-connector 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-card 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3AFontworkGalleryFloater 87 Opens the Fontwork dialogue box from which you can insert styled text not possible through standard font formatting into your document.
e .uno%3ADBLimit 4b Expands the created select statement of the SQL Query by the LIMIT X clause
17 .uno%3AFormatPaintbrush 93 First select some text or an object, then click this icon. Then click on or drag across other text or click an object to apply the same formatting.
33 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fquerypropertiesdialog%2Fnondistinct 21 Not use distinct values in query.
3d dbaccess%2Fui%2Fquerypropertiesdialog%2FQueryPropertiesDialog 1d Use distinct values in query.
30 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fquerypropertiesdialog%2Fdistinct 1d Use distinct values in query.
1b .uno%3AStarShapes.doorplate 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3AStarShapes.signet 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AStarShapes.vertical-scroll 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1f .uno%3AStarShapes.concave-star6 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3AStarShapes.star12 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star4 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
11 .uno%3AStarShapes 5a Opens the Stars and Banners toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document.
23 .uno%3AStarShapes.horizontal-scroll 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star8 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star5 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3AStarShapes.star24 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
16 .uno%3AStarShapes.bang 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star6 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.diamond-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.octagon-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3ASymbolShapes.lightning 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
19 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.heart 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.right-bracket 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.quad-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.left-brace 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.sun 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.smiley 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.flower 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
19 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.cloud 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.puzzle 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.moon 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.bracket-pair 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.brace-pair 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.left-bracket 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
13 .uno%3ASymbolShapes 56 Opens the Symbol Shapes toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document.
1d .uno%3ASymbolShapes.forbidden 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1f .uno%3ASymbolShapes.right-brace 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1c HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_FORWARD 1f Moves forwards to the next page
1e HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_BOOKMARKS 20 Adds this page to your bookmarks
1d HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_BACKWARD 1f Moves back to the previous page
1a HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_INDEX 23 Hides and shows the navigation pane
1a HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_START 31 Moves to the first page of the current Help topic
1f sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpcontrol%2Factive 5d The list box located at the very top is where you can select other %PRODUCTNAME Help modules.
1a HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_PRINT 17 Prints the current page
1e sfx%2Fui%2Fsearchdialog%2Fwrap 4e Searches the entire Help page, starting at the current position of the cursor.
11 .uno%3AHelpOnHelp 27 Provides an overview of the Help system
10 HID_HELP_TOOLBOX 48 The Toolbar contains important functions for controlling the Help system
21 HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_SEARCHDIALOG 29 Opens the Find on this page dialogue box.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fsearchdialog%2Fmatchcase 3a Distinguishes between upper-case text and lower-case text.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fsearchdialog%2Fsearchterm 4e Enter the text that you want to search for or select a text entry in the list.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fsearchdialog%2Fbackwards 3b Searches backwards from the current position of the cursor.
20 sfx%2Fui%2Fsearchdialog%2Fsearch 2d Finds the next occurrence of the search term.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fsearchdialog%2Fwholewords 1a Finds complete words only.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpcontrol%2Ftabcontrol 62 The navigation pane of the Help window contains the tab pages Contents, Index, Find and Bookmarks.
22 sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpindexpage%2Fdisplay 24 Click to display the selected topic.
28 sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpindexpage%2FHelpIndexPage 45 Double-click an entry or type the word you want to find in the index.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpsearchpage%2Fheadings 4a Specifies whether to only search in document headings for the search term.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpsearchpage%2Fcompletewords 71 Specifies whether to carry out an exact search for the word that you entered. Incomplete words will not be found.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpsearchpage%2Fresults 6a Lists the headings of the pages found in your full-text search. To display a page, double-click its entry.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpsearchpage%2Fdisplay 28 Displays the entry selected in the list.
22 sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpsearchpage%2Fsearch 3d Enter the search term here. The search is not case-sensitive.
20 sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpsearchpage%2Ffind 40 Click to start a full-text search for the term that you entered.
19 HID_HELP_BOOKMARKS_DELETE 1d deletes the bookmark selected
17 HID_HELP_BOOKMARKS_OPEN 22 displays the selected help subject
19 HID_HELP_BOOKMARKS_RENAME 3f opens a dialogue box for entering another name for the bookmark
2a sfx%2Fui%2Fbookmarkdialog%2FBookmarkDialog 58 Displays the name of the bookmarked page. You can also type a new name for the bookmark.
2e sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpbookmarkpage%2FHelpBookmarkPage 7c Double-clicking a bookmark or pressing the Return key opens the assigned page in Help. A right-click opens the context menu.
2c sfx%2Fui%2Fhelpcontentpage%2FHelpContentPage 56 Displays the main help themes, arranged in a similar way to folders in a file manager.
17 .uno%3AExtrusion3DColor 23 Opens the Extrusion Colour toolbar.
1e .uno%3AExtrusionSurfaceFloater 23 Opens the Extrusion Surface window.
1f .uno%3AExtrusionLightingFloater 24 Opens the Extrusion Lighting window.
1a SVX_HID_POPUP_LINEEND_CTRL 13 Select a direction.
20 .uno%3AExtrusionDirectionFloater 25 Opens the Extrusion Direction window.
18 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltDown 34 Tilts the selected object downwards by five degrees.
38 svx%2Fui%2Fextrustiondepthdialog%2FExtrustionDepthDialog 19 Enter an extrusion depth.
16 .uno%3AExtrusionToggle 3d Switches the 3-D effects on and off for the selected objects.
16 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltUp 32 Tilts the selected object upwards by five degrees.
18 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltLeft 2f Tilts the selected object left by five degrees.
19 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltRight 30 Tilts the selected object right by five degrees.
1c .uno%3AExtrusionDepthFloater 21 Opens the Extrusion Depth window.
14 .uno%3AAutoPilotMenu 63 Guides you through creating business and personal letters, faxes, agendas, presentations, and more.
14 HID_LTRWIZARD_CREATE 68 According to your selections, the wizard creates a new document template and saves it on your hard disc.
12 HID_LTRWIZARD_NEXT 3a Saves the current settings and continues to the next page.
16 .uno%3AAutoPilotLetter 28 Starts the wizard for a letter template.
12 HID_LTRWIZARD_BACK 46 Allows you to view the selections that you made on the previous steps.
1b HID_LTRWIZ_LSTBUSINESSSTYLE 2b Select the design for your letter template.
1b HID_LTRWIZ_CHKBUSINESSPAPER 93 Specifies whether paper is used that already contains an imprinted logo, address, or footer line. The Wizard shows the Letterhead layout page next.
1b HID_LTRWIZ_OPTPRIVATELETTER 34 Specifies that you want to create a personal letter.
20 HID_LTRWIZ_OPTPRIVOFFICIALLETTER 3b Specifies that you want to create a formal personal letter.
10 HID_LETTER_PAGE1 45 Specifies whether you want to create a personal or a business letter.
1c HID_LTRWIZ_OPTBUSINESSLETTER 3d Specifies that you want to create a business letter template.
1a HID_LTRWIZ_NUMFOOTERHEIGHT 81 Enter the height of the footer area that is already imprinted on your letterhead paper. %PRODUCTNAME does not print in that area.
19 HID_LTRWIZ_CHKPAPERFOOTER 6f Specifies that a footer area is already printed on your letterhead paper. %PRODUCTNAME does not print a footer.
21 HID_LTRWIZ_CHKPAPERCOMPANYADDRESS 6e Specifies that an address is already printed on your letterhead paper. %PRODUCTNAME does not print an address.
1e HID_LTRWIZ_CHKPAPERCOMPANYLOGO 66 Specifies that a logo is already printed on your letterhead paper. %PRODUCTNAME does not print a logo.
18 HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOHEIGHT 21 Defines the height of the object.
17 HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOWIDTH 20 Defines the width of the object.
10 HID_LETTER_PAGE2 57 Allows you to specify the elements that are already imprinted on your letterhead paper.
13 HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOX 33 Sets the object distance from the left page margin.
1d HID_LTRWIZ_CHKCOMPANYRECEIVER a3 Specifies that your own address is already imprinted in small size above the area of the recipient's address. %PRODUCTNAME does not print an address in small size.
13 HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOY 32 Sets the object distance from the top page margin.
17 HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEFOOTER 29 Includes a footer on the letter template.
19 HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEGREETING 59 Includes a complimentary close on the letter template. Select the text from the list box.
1a HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEBENDMARKS 2b Includes fold marks on the letter template.
15 HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSELOGO 27 Includes a logo on the letter template.
10 HID_LETTER_PAGE3 38 Defines the items to be included in the letter template.
16 HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSESIGNS 4c Includes a line with references to a business letter on the letter template.
1b HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSESALUTATION 56 Includes a salutation on the letter template. Select the salutation from the list box.
20 HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEADDRESSRECEIVER 3c Includes a small size return address on the letter template.
18 HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSESUBJECT 2f Includes a subject line on the letter template.
1e HID_LTRWIZ_OPTRECEIVERDATABASE 3e Address database fields are inserted into the letter template.
21 HID_LTRWIZ_OPTRECEIVERPLACEHOLDER 48 Specifies that placeholder fields are inserted into the letter template.
10 HID_LETTER_PAGE4 2f Specifies the sender and recipient information.
1f HID_LTRWIZ_OPTSENDERPLACEHOLDER 4f Use the address data from %PRODUCTNAME - User Data in the Options dialogue box.
1a HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERSTREET 2b Specifies the street address of the sender.
1a HID_LTRWIZ_OPTSENDERDEFINE 33 Use the address data from the following text boxes.
18 HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERNAME 21 Specifies the name of the sender.
1c HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERPOSTCODE 29 Specifies the address data of the sender.
1f HID_LTRWIZ_CHKFOOTERPAGENUMBERS 2e Includes page numbers in your letter template.
25 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKFOOTERNEXTPAGES 3c Select this option to suppress the footer on the first page.
10 HID_LETTER_PAGE5 39 Specifies the information to include in the footer space.
14 HID_LTRWIZ_TXTFOOTER 24 Enter the text for the footer lines.
19 HID_LTRWIZ_OPTMAKECHANGES 31 Saves the template and keeps it open for editing.
1a HID_LTRWIZ_OPTCREATELETTER 5c Saves and closes the template, and then opens a new untitled document based on the template.
12 HID_LTRWIZ_TXTPATH 68 Enter the path and file name for the template, or click the ... button to select the path and file name.
10 HID_LETTER_PAGE6 50 Specifies where and under which name you want to save the document and template.
1a HID_LTRWIZ_TXTTEMPLATENAME 2d Specifies the title of the document template.
1c WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_CREATE b0 According to your selections, the wizard creates a document template and saves it. A new document based on the template appears in the work area, with the filename "UntitledX".
1a WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_NEXT 8a The wizard saves the current settings and goes to the next page. The Next button will become inactive once you have reached the last page.
13 .uno%3AAutoPilotFax 1b Opens the wizard for faxes.
1a WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_BACK c8 Click the Back button to view the settings chosen on the previous page. The current settings will not be modified or deleted if you click this button. Back will be active from the second page onwards.
1b WIZARDS_HID_LSTPRIVATESTYLE 1f Specifies the predefined style.
23 WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZ_LSTBUSINESSSTYLE 1f Specifies the predefined style.
d HID_FAX_PAGE1 27 Defines the style of your fax document.
20 WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZ_OPTPRIVATEFAX 29 Creates a fax template for a private fax.
21 WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZ_OPTBUSINESSFAX 30 Creates a fax template for a business-style fax.
17 WIZARDS_HID_LSTGREETING 3b Includes a greeting. Select the greeting from the list box.
1a WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSEGREETING 3b Includes a greeting. Select the greeting from the list box.
19 WIZARDS_HID_LSTSALUTATION 3f Includes a salutation. Select the salutation from the list box.
1c WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSESALUTATION 3f Includes a salutation. Select the salutation from the list box.
16 WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSELOGO 18 Includes a company logo.
18 WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSEFOOTER 12 Includes a footer.
16 WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSEDATE 16 Includes a date field.
23 WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSECOMMUNICATIONTYPE 46 Includes a communication type line. Select the line from the list box.
d HID_FAX_PAGE2 29 Specifies the fax elements to be printed.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LSTCOMMUNICATIONTYPE 46 Includes a communication type line. Select the line from the list box.
19 WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSESUBJECT 18 Includes a subject line.
1f WIZARDS_HID_OPTRECEIVERDATABASE 45 Inserts database fields for a later mail merge with the fax document.
22 WIZARDS_HID_OPTRECEIVERPLACEHOLDER 84 Inserts placeholders for the address on the fax template. Later in the fax document, click the placeholder to enter the actual data.
18 WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERFAX 1e Enter the sender address data.
19 WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERCITY 1e Enter the sender address data.
1a WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERSTATE 1e Enter the sender address data.
20 WIZARDS_HID_OPTSENDERPLACEHOLDER 84 Inserts placeholders for the address on the fax template. Later in the fax document, click the placeholder to enter the actual data.
1b WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERSTREET 1e Enter the sender address data.
1b WIZARDS_HID_OPTSENDERDEFINE 82 Select this option to enter the address data in the following text boxes. The data is inserted as normal text in the fax document.
19 WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERNAME 1e Enter the sender address data.
d HID_FAX_PAGE3 3a Specifies the receiver and sender information for the fax.
1d WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERPOSTCODE 1e Enter the sender address data.
20 WIZARDS_HID_CHKFOOTERPAGENUMBERS 28 Prints a page number in the footer area.
1e WIZARDS_HID_CHKFOOTERNEXTPAGES 45 Suppresses the footer on the first page of a multi-page fax document.
d HID_FAX_PAGE4 1a Specifies the footer data.
15 WIZARDS_HID_TXTFOOTER 34 Specifies the text to be printed in the footer area.
1a WIZARDS_HID_OPTMAKECHANGES 50 Creates and saves the fax template, then opens the template for further editing.
1a WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZ_CMDPATH 58 Click to enter or select the complete path, including the file name of the fax template.
d HID_FAX_PAGE5 27 Defines the template name and location.
18 WIZARDS_HID_OPTCREATEFAX 59 Creates and saves the fax template, then opens a new fax document based on that template.
1b WIZARDS_HID_TXTTEMPLATENAME 23 Enter the name of the fax template.
16 .uno%3AAutoPilotAgenda 38 Starts the wizard to help you create an agenda template.
10 HID_AGENDA_PAGE1 27 Specifies a page design for the agenda.
1f WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_1_CHK_MINUTES 4d Prints out a page on which you can write down the minutes during the meeting.
23 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_1_LIST_PAGEDESIGN 29 Select the page design from the list box.
20 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_LOCATION 26 Specifies the location of the meeting.
1d WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_TITLE 23 Specifies the title of the meeting.
10 HID_AGENDA_PAGE2 3d Specifies the date, time, title, and location of the meeting.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_TIME 22 Specifies the time of the meeting.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_DATE 22 Specifies the date of the meeting.
1d WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_NOTES 28 Specifies whether to print a Notes line.
1d WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_BRING 2f Specifies whether to print a Please bring line.
10 HID_AGENDA_PAGE3 3e Specifies the headings that you want to include in the agenda.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_READ 2e Specifies whether to print a Please read line.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_MEETING_TYPE 34 Specifies whether to print the type of meeting line.
27 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_RESOURCEPERSONS 50 Specifies whether to print a line in which you can enter the facility personnel.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_OBSERVERS 47 Specifies whether to print a line in which you can enter the observers.
22 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_TIMEKEEPER 47 Specifies whether to print a line in which you can enter the moderator.
10 HID_AGENDA_PAGE4 30 Specifies the names to be printed on the agenda.
23 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_FACILITATOR 49 Specifies whether to print a line in which you can enter the chairperson.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_NOTETAKER 47 Specifies whether to print a line in which you can enter the secretary.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_CALLED_BY 5b Specifies whether to print a line in which you can enter the person who called the meeting.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_ATTENDEES 47 Specifies whether to print a line in which you can enter the attendees.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_DOWN 21 Moves the current topic row down.
1f WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_TXT_TOPIC_1 52 Enter the agenda topics. Use the Move up and Move down buttons to sort the topics.
1a WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_UP 1f Moves the current topic row up.
1e WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_INSERT 34 Inserts a new empty topic row above the current row.
1e WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_REMOVE 1e Removes the current topic row.
10 HID_AGENDA_PAGE5 3a Specifies the topics to be printed on the agenda template.
25 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_TXT_RESPONSIBLE_1 52 Enter the agenda topics. Use the Move up and Move down buttons to sort the topics.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_TXT_MINUTES_1 52 Enter the agenda topics. Use the Move up and Move down buttons to sort the topics.
23 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_OPT_MAKECHANGES 53 Creates and saves the agenda template, then opens the template for further editing.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_BTN_TEMPLATEPATH 4c Specifies the complete path, including the file name of the agenda template.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_OPT_CREATEAGENDA 5f Creates and saves the agenda template, then opens a new agenda document based on that template.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_TXT_TEMPLATEPATH 4c Specifies the complete path, including the file name of the agenda template.
10 HID_AGENDA_PAGE6 36 Choose the title and location for the agenda template.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_TXT_TEMPLATENAME 2a Specifies the name of the agenda template.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDFINISH 39 Click to create the form without answering further pages.
12 HID_DLGFORM_DIALOG 28 Activates the Wizard for creating forms.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVEDOWN 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEFIELDDOWN 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVE_PK_SELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_FIELDSAVAILABLE 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEDOWN 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list.
17 WIZARDS_HID2_BTN_DOC_UP 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
21 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVEUP 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVEUP 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
2c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEDOWN_PK_SELECTED 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDREMOVE_PK_SELECTED 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
2d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDS 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_LBTABLES 42 Specifies the table or query that you want to create the form for.
21 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDS 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_FIELDSAVAILABLE 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_FIELDSAVAILABLE 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
2c WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVEDOWN 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
2f WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEFIELDUP 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list.
29 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
29 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERMOVEDOWN 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
1e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEUP 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
24 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
19 WIZARDS_HID2_BTN_DOC_DOWN 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVEUP 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_FIELDSSELECTED 2d Displays the fields that are in the new form.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVEDOWN 3c Click to move the selected field down one entry in the list.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEUP_PK_SELECTED 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERMOVEUP 3a Click to move the selected field up one entry in the list.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKCREATESUBFORM 19 Select to add a sub-form.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTSELECTMANUALLY 3e Click to add a sub-form based on a manual selection of fields.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_lstRELATIONS 33 Select the relation on which the sub-form is based.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTONEXISTINGRELATION 36 Click to add a sub-form based on an existing relation.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_FIELDSSELECTED 3e Displays all fields that will be included in the new sub-form.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_LBTABLES 45 Specifies the table or query for which the sub-form is to be created.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK4 7a Select the main form field that is joined to the sub-form field, which you select from the list box next to this list box.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK4 7a Select the sub-form field that is joined to the main form field, which you select from the list box next to this list box.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK1 7a Select the main form field that is joined to the sub-form field, which you select from the list box next to this list box.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK2 7a Select the main form field that is joined to the sub-form field, which you select from the list box next to this list box.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK1 7a Select the sub-form field that is joined to the main form field, which you select from the list box next to this list box.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK3 7a Select the sub-form field that is joined to the main form field, which you select from the list box next to this list box.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK2 7a Select the sub-form field that is joined to the main form field, which you select from the list box next to this list box.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK3 7a Select the main form field that is joined to the sub-form field, which you select from the list box next to this list box.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTOPJUSTIFIED2 31 Arranges the labels above the corresponding data.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTABLESTYLE2 2d Aligns the database fields in a tabular form.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTOPLABELED2 47 Aligns the database fields column-wise with the labels above the field.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDLEFTLABELED2 51 Aligns the database fields column-wise with the labels to the left of the fields.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDALIGNRIGHT 1d The labels are right-aligned.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDALIGNLEFT 1c The labels are left-aligned.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDLEFTLABELED 51 Aligns the database fields column-wise with the labels to the left of the fields.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTOPLABELED 47 Aligns the database fields column-wise with the labels above the field.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTABLESTYLE 2d Aligns the database fields in a tabular form.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTOPJUSTIFIED 31 Arranges the labels above the corresponding data.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKNODELETION 21 Select to disallow deleting data.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKNOMODIFICATION 20 Select to disallow editing data.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKNOADDITION 23 Select to disallow adding new data.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTNEWDATAONLY 37 Creates a form that is only used for entering new data.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTDISPLAYALLDATA 4f Creates a form that can be used to display existing data and to enter new data.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDSIMPLEBORDER 2b Specifies that the field borders look flat.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMD3DBORDER 31 Specifies that the field borders have a 3-D look.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LSTSTYLES 26 Specifies the page style for the form.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDNOBORDER 29 Specifies that the fields have no border.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTMODIFYFORM 3f Saves the form, and opens it in edit mode to change the layout.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_TXTPATH 1f Specifies the name of the form.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTWORKWITHFORM 4a Saves the form, and opens it as a form document to enter and display data.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_DIALOG 1d Select the report properties.
1b .uno%3ADBNewReportAutoPilot 2a Activates the wizard for creating reports.
1c HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
1f HID_DLGREPORT_1_FIELDSAVAILABLE 4a Displays the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
1a HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
18 HID_DLGREPORT_1_LBTABLES 40 Select the table or query for which the report is to be created.
1f HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
1e HID_DLGREPORT_1_FIELDSSELECTED 38 Displays all fields that are included in the new report.
21 HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
1a HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_6 94 Displays the names of the fields to be included in the report. At the right you can enter a label for each field that will be printed in the report.
18 HID_DLGREPORT_2_CMDGROUP 4a Click to move the selected field to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
1a HID_DLGREPORT_2_CMDUNGROUP 4a Click to move the selected field to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
18 HID_DLGREPORT_2_GROUPING c6 Lists the fields from your selection on the previous page of the Wizard. To group the report by a field, select the field name, then click the > button. You may select up to four levels of grouping.
1f HID_DLGREPORT_2_PREGROUPINGDEST b4 Lists the fields by which the report will be grouped. To remove one level of grouping, select the field name, then click the < button. You may select up to four levels of grouping.
1b HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTDESCEND4 2d Sorts the field contents in descending order.
1a HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTASCEND4 2c Sorts the field contents in ascending order.
15 HID_DLGREPORT_3_SORT1 33 Select the first field by which to sort the report.
15 HID_DLGREPORT_3_SORT4 37 Select an additional field by which to sort the report.
18 HID_DLGREPORT_4_PORTRAIT 33 Selects a portrait page orientation for the report.
19 HID_DLGREPORT_4_LANDSCAPE 34 Selects a landscape page orientation for the report.
1a HID_DLGREPORT_4_DATALAYOUT 65 Defines a set of styles for the report. The styles assign fonts, indents, table background, and more.
1a HID_DLGREPORT_4_PAGELAYOUT 8a Defines a page layout for the report. The page layouts are loaded from template files, which assign a header, footer, and page background.
1e HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTUSETEMPLATE 30 When you click Finish, the report will be saved.
1f HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTEDITTEMPLATE 44 When you click Create, the report will be saved and opened for edit.
1e HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTDYNTEMPLATE 6f Saves the report as a template. When you open a dynamic report, it will display with the current data contents.
15 HID_DLGREPORT_4_TITLE 43 Specifies the title that is printed at the title line of each page.
1f HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTSTATDOCUMENT 89 Saves the report as a static report. When you open a static report, it will always display the data from the time the report was created.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FnextPageButton 36 Saves the current settings and moves to the next page.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FlastPageButton 34 Returns to the selections made on the previous page.
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FdelDesingButton 31 Deletes the selected design from the design list.
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FdesignsTreeview 1e Displays all existing designs.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FnewDesignRadiobutton 35 Creates a new design in the next pages of the Wizard.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FoldDesignRadiobutton 81 Loads an existing design from the design list to use as a starting point for the steps to follow on the next pages of the Wizard.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FASPRadiobutton 99 When you select the ASP option, the WebCast export creates ASP pages. Note that the HTML presentation can only be offered by a web server supporting ASP.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FwebCastRadiobutton 52 In a WebCast export, automatic scripts will be generated with Perl or ASP support.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FdurationSpinbutton 32 Defines the amount of time for each slide display.
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FperlRadiobutton 3d Used by WebCast export to create HTML pages and Perl scripts.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FchgAutoRadiobutton 8b The page transition takes place automatically after the specified period of time elapses and does not depend on the presentation's contents
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FendlessCheckbutton 55 Automatically restarts the HTML presentation after the last slide has been displayed.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FframesRadiobutton b2 Creates standard HTML pages with frames. The exported page will be placed in the main frame, and the frame to the left will display a table of contents in the form of hyperlinks.
35 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FURLEntry 6f Specifies the URL (absolute or relative), where the created HTML presentation on the web server has been saved.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FindexEntry 66 Specifies the URL (absolute or relative) to be entered by the viewer in order to see the presentation.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FstandardRadiobutton 2e Creates standard HTML pages from export pages.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FcontentCheckbutton 27 Creates a title page for your document.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FnotesCheckbutton 2d Specifies that your notes are also displayed.
35 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FCGIEntry 48 Specifies the URL (absolute or relative) for the generated Perl scripts.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FkioskRadiobutton 87 Creates a default HTML presentation as a kiosk export, in which the slides are automatically advanced after a specified amount of time.
42 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FchgDefaultRadiobutton d4 The slide transition depends on the timing that you set for each slide in the presentation. If you set a manual page transition, the HTML presentation introduces a new page by pressing any key from your keyboard.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FsldSoundCheckbutton 60 Specifies that the sound files that are defined as an effect for slide transitions are exported.
43 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2Fresolution2Radiobutton 3d Select the medium resolution for a medium-sized presentation.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FpngRadiobutton 7a The files are exported as PNG files. PNG files are compressed without loss of data, and can contain more than 256 colours.
43 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2Fresolution3Radiobutton 3a Select a high resolution for a high quality slide display.
32 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2Fpage3 7a The files are exported as PNG files. PNG files are compressed without loss of data, and can contain more than 256 colours.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FgifRadiobutton 76 The files are exported as GIF files. GIF files are compressed without loss of data, and have a maximum of 256 colours.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FjpgRadiobutton 83 The files are exported as JPEG files. JPEG files are compressed, with adjustable compression and can contain more than 256 colours.
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FqualityCombobox b4 Specifies the compression factor of the JPEG graphic. A 100% value offers the best quality for a large data range. The 25% factor indicates small files with inferior image quality.
43 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2Fresolution1Radiobutton 5f Select the low resolution to keep the file size small, even for presentations with many slides.
39 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FmiscTextview 36 Specifies additional text to appear on the title page.
38 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FauthorEntry 2f Specifies the name of the publication's author.
35 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FwwwEntry 49 Specifies your homepage. A hyperlink will be inserted in the publication.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FemailEntry 1d Specifies the e-mail address.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FtextOnlyCheckbutton 30 Inserts only text hyperlinks instead of buttons.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FbackButton 61 Opens the Colour dialogue box, in which you can select the background colour of the presentation.
38 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FvLinkButton 63 Opens the Colour dialogue box, in which you can select the visited link colour of the presentation.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FdefaultRadiobutton 35 Uses the default colours of the viewer's Web Browser.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FdocColorsRadiobutton 44 Determines the colours from the styles used in the current document.
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FuserRadiobutton 44 Allows you to define your own colours for some presentation objects.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FlinkButton 60 Opens the Colour dialogue box, in which you can select the hyperlink colour of the presentation.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FtextButton 5b Opens the Colour dialogue box, in which you can select the text colour of the presentation.
38 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpublishingdialog%2FaLinkButton 62 Opens the Colour dialogue box, in which you can select the active link colour of the presentation.
15 HID_LISTWIZARD_FINISH 13 Creates the object.
3a modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fgroupradioselectionpage%2Ftoleft 31 Removes the selected option fields from the list.
40 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fgroupradioselectionpage%2Fradiobuttons 46 Displays all option fields which have to be included in the group box.
3f modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fgroupradioselectionpage%2Fradiolabels 6d Specifies the respective label for each option field. You will see the label of the option field in the form.
3b modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fgroupradioselectionpage%2Ftoright 4a Confirms the current label and copies the label to the Option fields list.
48 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fdefaultfieldselectionpage%2Fdefaultselectionno 49 Specifies that you do not want any option field to be the default choice.
49 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fdefaultfieldselectionpage%2Fdefaultselectionyes 5b Specifies that you want an option field to be selected as a default after opening the form.
47 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fdefaultfieldselectionpage%2Fdefselectionfield 53 Select the option field that you want to have as the default when opening the form.
39 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Foptionvaluespage%2Fradiobuttons 49 Select the option field for which you want to assign the reference value.
38 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Foptionvaluespage%2Foptionvalue 54 Select a number or a text string as a reference value for the selected option field.
3b modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Foptiondbfieldpage%2FnoRadiobutton 5f Specifies that you want to save the reference values in the form only, and not in the database.
3c modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Foptiondbfieldpage%2FyesRadiobutton 43 Specifies that you want to save the reference values in a database.
42 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Foptiondbfieldpage%2FstoreInFieldCombobox 45 Select the data field in which the reference values have to be saved.
33 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Foptionsfinalpage%2Fnameit 66 Specifies the label for the option box. You will see the label of the group box displayed in the form.
27 macro%3A%2F%2F%2FImportWizard.Main.Main 55 Copies and converts documents into the OpenDocument XML format used by $[officename].
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CMDHELP 55 Copies and converts documents into the OpenDocument XML format used by $[officename].
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_DIALOG 55 Copies and converts documents into the OpenDocument XML format used by $[officename].
1a HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CHKLOGFILE 59 Creates a log file in your working directory showing which documents have been converted.
1d HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CHKPOWERPOINT 5a Converts documents in Microsoft PowerPoint format *.ppt into OpenDocument *.odp documents.
17 HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CHKWORD 54 Converts documents in Microsoft Word format *.doc into OpenDocument *.odt documents.
18 HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CHKEXCEL 55 Converts documents in Microsoft Excel format *.xls into OpenDocument *.ods documents.
1a HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBDOCUMENT 31 Indicates that the documents are to be converted.
25 HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CMDDOCUMENTPATHSELECT 30 Opens a dialogue box to select the desired path.
1e HID_DLGIMPORT_2_LBDOCUMENTPATH 34 Specifies the directory containing the source files.
1e HID_DLGIMPORT_2_EDDOCUMENTPATH 43 Specifies the directory to which the destination files are written.
1a HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBTEMPLATE 2d Specifies that templates are to be converted.
21 HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBDOCUMENTRECURSE 61 Indicates that the subdirectories of the selected directory are also searched for matching files.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON4 5b All currency cells in the range selected before the converter was called will be converted.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON3 3c All currency cells in the active document will be converted.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON1 36 All cells with the selected Cell Styles are converted.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_COMBOBOX1 31 Specifies the currency to be converted into euro.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHECKBOX1 1d Converts the entire document.
31 macro%3A%2F%2F%2FEuro.AutoPilotRun.StartAutoPilot 8a Converts the currency amounts found in $[officename] Calc documents and in fields and tables of $[officename] Writer documents into euros.
14 .uno%3AEuroConverter 8a Converts the currency amounts found in $[officename] Calc documents and in fields and tables of $[officename] Writer documents into euros.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OBDIR 6b Converts all $[officename] Calc and $[officename] Writer documents and templates in the selected directory.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_TBSOURCE 4b Indicates the directory or the name of the single document to be converted.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHKTEXTDOCUMENTS 57 Converts currency amounts found in fields and tables of $[officename] Writer documents.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBCANCEL 1a Closes the Euro Converter.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBGOON 16 Starts the conversion.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBSOURCEOPEN 41 Opens a dialogue box to select the desired directory or document.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON2 3f All currency cells in the active spreadsheet will be converted.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_DIALOG 8a Converts the currency amounts found in $[officename] Calc documents and in fields and tables of $[officename] Writer documents into euros.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHKPROTECT c2 Specifies that sheet protection will be disabled during conversion and thereafter re-enabled. If sheet protection is covered by a password, you will see a dialogue box for entering the password.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_TBTARGET 4b Specifies the folder and path in which the converted files are to be saved.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_LISTBOX1 32 Displays the ranges to be converted from the list.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHECKRECURSIVE 49 Specifies whether all sub-folders of the selected directory are included.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBBACK 30 Returns to the first page of the Euro Converter.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBTARGETOPEN 55 Opens a dialogue box in which you can select a directory to hold the converted files.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OBFILE 2a Converts a single $[officename] Calc file.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBHELP 28 Activates the help for the dialogue box.
11 HID_ABSPILOT_NEXT 10 Go to next step.
15 HID_ABSPILOT_PREVIOUS 14 Go to previous step.
13 HID_ABSPILOT_FINISH 4a Establishes the connection to the data source and closes the dialogue box.
30 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttypepage%2Fother 60 Select this option if you want to register another data source as address book in $[officename].
34 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttypepage%2Fevolution 43 Select this option if you already use an address book in Evolution.
34 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttypepage%2Fgroupwise 43 Select this option if you already use an address book in Groupwise.
2e modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttypepage%2Fkde 4a Select this option if you already use an address book in KDE Address book.
c slot%3A10934 51 This wizard registers an existing address book as a data source in $[officename].
32 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttypepage%2Fevoldap 48 Select this option if you already use an address book in Evolution LDAP.
39 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttypepage%2FSelectTypePage 51 This wizard registers an existing address book as a data source in $[officename].
21 .uno%3AAutoPilotAddressDataSource 51 This wizard registers an existing address book as a data source in $[officename].
31 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttypepage%2Fmacosx 4c Select this option if you already use an address book in macOS Address book.
17 EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT 51 This wizard registers an existing address book as a data source in $[officename].
32 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttypepage%2Ffirefox 4e Select this option if you already use an address book in Firefox or Iceweasel.
13 HID_ABSPILOT_CANCEL 32 Exits the wizard without implementing any changes.
36 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttypepage%2Fthunderbird 50 Select this option if you already use an address book in Thunderbird or Icedove.
34 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Finvokeadminpage%2Fsettings 40 Calls a dialogue box in which you can enter additional settings.
3b modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Finvokeadminpage%2FInvokeAdminPage 5e Allows you to enter additional settings for LDAP address data and other external data sources.
31 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttablepage%2Ftable 59 Specifies the table that is to serve as the address book for the $[officename] templates.
3b modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fselecttablepage%2FSelectTablePage 76 Specifies a table from the Seamonkey / Netscape address book source that is used as the address book in $[officename].
34 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fdatasourcepage%2Favailable dc Registers the newly created database file in %PRODUCTNAME. The database will then be listed in the data source window (F4). If this check box is unmarked, the database will be available only by opening the database file.
39 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fdatasourcepage%2FDataSourcePage 81 Specifies a location for the address book file and a name under which the data source will be listed in the data source explorer.
2f modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fdatasourcepage%2Fname 1f Specifies the data source name.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_BROWSECONN 31 Specifies the location using a file dialogue box.
31 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Fdatasourcepage%2Fbrowse 31 Specifies the location using a file dialogue box.
32 modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Ffieldassignpage%2Fassign 3a Opens the Templates: Address Book Assignment dialogue box.
3b modules%2Fsabpilot%2Fui%2Ffieldassignpage%2FFieldAssignPage 45 Opens a dialogue box that allows you to specify the field assignment.
17 HID_QRYDGN_ROW_FUNCTION a0 The Parameter Input dialogue box asks the user to enter the parameter values. Enter a value for each query parameter and confirm by clicking OK or typing Enter.
13 HID_QRYDGN_ROW_CRIT 51 Specifies the criteria by which the content of the data field should be filtered.
16 HID_QRYDGN_ROW_VISIBLE 5a If you mark the Visible property for a data field, that field will be visible in the query
14 HID_QRYDGN_ROW_ORDER 65 If you click the cell, you can select from the sorting options: ascending, descending and not sorted.
14 HID_QRYDGN_ROW_TABLE 4b The corresponding database table of the selected data field is listed here.
14 HID_QRYDGN_ROW_ALIAS 8d Specifies an alias. This alias will be listed in a query instead of the field name. This makes it possible to use user-defined column labels.
1d HID_QUERY_EDIT_JOINCONNECTION 15 Edit Join Properties.
11 HID_CTL_QRYDGNTAB 50 Double-click fields to add them to the query. Drag-and-drop to define relations.
12 HID_CTL_QRYDGNCRIT 26 Select conditions to define the query.
22 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fsavedialog%2Ftitle 2a Enter the name of the query or table view.
23 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fsavedialog%2Fschema 49 Enter the name of the schema that is assigned to the query or table view.
14 HID_QRYDGN_ROW_FIELD 7c Enter the name of the data field that you referred to in the Query. All settings made in the lower rows refer to this field.
21 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fjoindialog%2Ftype 54 For a full join, the results table contains all fields of the left and right tables.
23 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fjoindialog%2Ftable2 35 Specifies two different tables that you want to join.
5 dummy 64 If you click More, a dialogue box displaying more information about the current problem will appear.
26 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fnewpassword 17 Enter the new password.
1c sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fusered 23 Specifies the name of the new user.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fconfirmpassword 1d Enter the new password again.
26 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Foldpassword 17 Enter the old password.
1c HID_TABLE_DESIGN_HELP_WINDOW 13 Displays help text.
12 HID_TAB_ENT_FORMAT 30 This button opens the Field Format dialogue box.
19 HID_TAB_ENT_FORMAT_SAMPLE 41 Displays the format code that you can select with the ... button.
20 SID_TABLEDESIGN_TABED_PRIMARYKEY 4e If this command has a tick mark, the data field in this line is a primary key.
16 HID_TABDESIGN_NAMECELL 84 Specifies the name of the data field. Note the database restrictions, such as the length of the name, special characters and spaces.
18 HID_TABDESIGN_BACKGROUND 32 This area is where you define the table structure.
13 HID_TAB_ENT_DEFAULT 3c Specifies the value that is the default in new data records.
16 HID_TABDESIGN_TYPECELL 19 Specifies the field type.
19 HID_TABDESIGN_COMMENTCELL 22 Specifies an optional description.
d .uno%3ADelete 19 Deletes the selected row.
1a SID_TABLEDESIGN_INSERTROWS 96 Inserts an empty row above the current row, if the table has not been saved. Inserts an empty row at the end of the table if the table has been saved.
23 HID_DLGINDEX_INDEXDETAILS_SORTORDER 1a Determines the sort order.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Findexdesigndialog%2Fclose 18 Closes the dialogue box.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Findexdesigndialog%2FUNIQUE 3e Specifies whether the current index allows only unique values.
32 dbaccess%2Fui%2Findexdesigndialog%2FID_INDEX_RESET 56 Resets the current index to the setting that it had when the dialogue box was started.
14 .uno%3ADBIndexDesign 53 The Index Design dialogue box allows you to edit the indexes for the current table.
31 dbaccess%2Fui%2Findexdesigndialog%2FID_INDEX_DROP 1a Deletes the current index.
1f HID_DLGINDEX_INDEXDETAILS_FIELD 57 Displays a list of the fields in the current table. You can select more than one field.
30 dbaccess%2Fui%2Findexdesigndialog%2FID_INDEX_NEW 14 Creates a new index.
33 dbaccess%2Fui%2Findexdesigndialog%2FID_INDEX_RENAME 1a Renames the current index.
2e dbaccess%2Fui%2Findexdesigndialog%2FINDEX_LIST 8b Displays the available indexes. Select an index from the list to edit. The details of the selected index are displayed in the dialogue box.
31 dbaccess%2Fui%2Findexdesigndialog%2FID_INDEX_SAVE 2b Saves the current index in the data source.
13 HID_CTL_RELATIONTAB 57 Here you can link together tables from the current database through common data fields.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Frelationdialog%2Fdeldefault 60 If you delete the corresponding primary key, a set value will be set to all external key fields.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Frelationdialog%2Fdelcascade 69 Specifies that all external key fields will be deleted if you delete the corresponding primary key field.
28 dbaccess%2Fui%2Frelationdialog%2Fdelnull 6d If you delete the corresponding primary key, the "IS NULL" value will be assigned to all external key fields.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Frelationdialog%2Fadddefault 76 If the corresponding primary key has been modified, use this option to set a default value to all external key fields.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Frelationdialog%2Fdelaction 63 Specifies that the deletion of a primary key will not have any effect on other external key fields.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Frelationdialog%2Faddcascade 77 Updates all the external key fields if the value of the corresponding primary key has been modified (Cascading Update).
14 .uno%3ADBAddRelation 3c Allows you to define and edit a relation between two tables.
27 dbaccess%2Fui%2Frelationdialog%2Ftable2 4a The names of the tables selected for the link appear here as column names.
26 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fjoindialog%2Frelations 28 Defines the key fields for the relation.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Frelationdialog%2Faddaction 5a Specifies that any change made to a primary key does not affect other external key fields.
28 dbaccess%2Fui%2Frelationdialog%2Faddnull a1 If the corresponding primary key has been modified, use this option to set the "IS NULL" value to all external key fields. IS NULL means that the field is empty.
27 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcopytablepage%2Fdefdata 29 Creates a 1:1 copy of the database table.
27 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcopytablepage%2Fkeyname 46 Specifies a name for the primary key generated. This name is optional.
23 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcopytablepage%2Fdef 40 Copies only the table definition and not the corresponding data.
24 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcopytablepage%2Fdata 7a If the data cannot be attached, you will see a list of fields in the Column Info dialogue box whose data cannot be copied.
24 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcopytablepage%2Fview c0 If the database supports Views and you selected this option, a query will be created in the table container as a table. This option allows you to view the query results as a normal table view.
24 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcopytablepage%2Fname 1e Specifies a name for the copy.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcopytablepage%2Fprimarykey 4a Automatically generates a primary key data field and fills it with values.
24 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fapplycolpage%2Fcolrh 5a Adds or removes the selected field (> or < button) or all of the fields (<< or >> button).
23 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fapplycolpage%2Ffrom bc Lists the available data fields that you can include in the copied table. To copy a data field, click its name, and then click the > button. To copy all of the fields, click the >> button.
21 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fapplycolpage%2Fto 3e Lists the fields that you want to include in the copied table.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftypeselectpage%2Fautobutton 23 Enables automatic type recognition.
25 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftypeselectpage%2Fauto 40 Enter the number of lines to use for automatic type recognition.
16 HID_TAB_ENT_COLUMNNAME 54 Displays the name of the selected data field. If you want, you can enter a new name.
2c dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftypeselectpage%2Fcolumnnames 40 Lists the data fields that will be included in the copied table.
10 HID_TAB_ENT_TYPE 14 Select a field type.
f HID_TAB_ENT_LEN 32 Enter the number of characters for the data field.
11 HID_TAB_ENT_SCALE 78 Enter the number of decimal places for the data field. This option is only available for numeric or decimal data fields.
18 HID_TAB_ENT_BOOL_DEFAULT 2c Select the default value for a Yes/No field.
27 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fnamematchingpage%2Fnone 2a Clears all of the check boxes in the list.
26 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fnamematchingpage%2Fall 2b Selects all of the data fields in the list.
2d dbaccess%2Fui%2Fnamematchingpage%2Fdown_right 37 Moves the selected entry down one position in the list.
27 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fnamematchingpage%2Fleft 165 Lists the data fields in the source table. To include a data field from the source table in the destination table, mark the check box in front of the data field name. To map the content of a data field in the source table to a different data field in the destination table, click the data field in the source table list, and then click the up or down arrow.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Fnamematchingpage%2Fup_right 35 Moves the selected entry up one position in the list.
28 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fnamematchingpage%2Fright a0 Lists the possible data fields in the destination table. Only the data fields that are selected in the source table list will be included the destination table.
16 HID_DSADMIN_USECATALOG b7 Uses the current data source of the Catalogue. This is useful when the ODBC data source is a database server. If the ODBC data source is a dBASE driver, leave this check box unmarked.
18 HID_DSADMIN_CHARSET_ODBC 79 Select the code conversion that you want to use to view the database in $[officename]. This does not affect the database.
22 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fodbcpage%2Foptions 56 Use this text field to enter additional optional driver settings if this is necessary.
32 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fgeneratedvaluespage%2Fautoretrieve 67 Enables $[officename] support of auto-incremented data fields for the current ODBC or JDBC data source.
2f dbaccess%2Fui%2Fgeneratedvaluespage%2Fstatement 70 Enter the SQL command specifier that instructs the data source to auto-increment a specified Integer data field.
2e dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fusesql92 8a Only allows names that use characters that conform to the SQL-92 naming constraints in the data source. All other characters are rejected.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Fgeneratedvaluespage%2Fquery 63 Enter an SQL statement that returns the last auto-incremented value for the primary key data field.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbasepage%2FindiciesButton 6a Opens the Indexes dialogue box, in which you can organise the table indexes in the current dBASE database.
32 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbasepage%2FshowDelRowsCheckbutton 7d Displays all the records in a file, including those marked as deleted. If you mark this check box, you cannot delete records.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbaseindexdialog%2Fremove 3a Moves the selected table indexes to the Free Indexes list.
28 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbaseindexdialog%2Ftable 31 Select the database table that you want to index.
33 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbaseindexdialog%2FDBaseIndexDialog 29 Lets you organise dBASE database indexes.
2d dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbaseindexdialog%2Ftableindex 3a Lists the current indexes for the selected database table.
26 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbaseindexdialog%2Fadd 33 Moves the selected index to the Table Indexes list.
2c dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbaseindexdialog%2Fremoveall 38 Moves all of the table indexes to the Free Indexes list.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbaseindexdialog%2Faddall 38 Moves all of the free indexes to the Table Indexes list.
2c dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbaseindexdialog%2Ffreeindex 3b Lists the available indexes that you can assign to a table.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdirectsqldialog%2Fexecute 40 Runs the command that you entered in the Command to execute box.
2c dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdirectsqldialog%2Fsqlhistory 6a Lists the previously executed SQL commands. To run a command again, click the command, and then click Run.
28 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdirectsqldialog%2Fstatus 48 Displays the results, including errors, of the SQL command that you ran.
31 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdirectsqldialog%2FDirectSQLDialog 58 Opens a dialogue box in which you can enter an SQL command for administering a database.
25 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdirectsqldialog%2Fsql 3a Enter the SQL administration command that you want to run.
1e HID_DSADMIN_SUPPRESS_VERSIONCL 5b Sorts the list of table names in ascending order starting at the beginning of the alphabet.
27 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SUPPRESS_VERSIONCL f2 Some databases track changes to each record by assigning version number to fields that are changed. This number is incremented by 1 each time that the field is changed. Displays the internal version number of the record in the database table.
35 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fuseodbcliterals 35 Use date/time literals that conform to ODBC standard.
31 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Finputchecks d8 When you enter a new record or update an existing record in a form, and you leave a field empty which is bound to a database column which requires input, then you will see a message complaining about the empty field.
31 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fcreateindex 2d Creates an index with ASC or DESC statements.
34 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fusecatalogname b9 Uses the current data source of the catalogue. This option is useful when the ODBC data source is a database server. Do not select this option if the ODBC data source is a dBASE driver.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Feol 6d Select to use the CR + LF code pair to end every text line (preferred for DOS and Windows operating systems).
30 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fdisplayver 49 Displays the internal version number of the record in the database table.
31 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fignoreprivs 43 Ignores access privileges that are provided by the database driver.
34 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fignorecurrency a9 Only for Oracle JDBC connections. When enabled it specifies that no column is treated as a currency field. The field type returned from the database driver is discarded.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fuseas 9b Some databases use the keyword "AS" between a name and its alias, while other databases use a whitespace. Enable this option to insert AS before the alias.
2c dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fappend 39 Appends the alias to the table name in SELECT statements.
33 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fuseschemaname 37 Allows you to use the schema name in SELECT statements.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fuseoj 5c Use escape sequences for outer joins. The syntax for this escape sequence is {oj outer-join}
31 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Fprimarykeys 5f Enable to overrule Base's heuristics used to detect whether the database supports primary keys.
26 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_BOOLEANCOMPARISON 3b Select the type of Boolean comparison that you want to use.
33 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fspecialsettingspage%2Freplaceparams 44 Replaces named parameters in a data source with a question mark (?).
1c DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_CHARSET 54 Select the character set that you want to use to view the database in $[officename].
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SPECIAL_MESSAGE 39 Select the type of database to which you want to connect.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_PB_TESTMYSQLCLASS 3c Tests the database connection through the JDBC driver class.
31 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fconnectionpage%2FconnectionButton 38 Tests the database connection with the current settings.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DBASE_PATH 3e Enter the path to the directory that contains the dBASE files.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_FLAT_PATH 4e Enter the path to the folder containing the text files that the database uses.
2d DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLCLASS 49 Enter the name of the JDBC driver class that connects to the data source.
30 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fconnectionpage%2FpassCheckbutton 60 If marked, the user will be asked to enter the password that is required to access the database.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_CALC_PATH 4e Enter the path to the spreadsheet document that you want to use as a database.
2e DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLDBNAME 1f Enter the name of the database.
2f dbaccess%2Fui%2Fgeneralpagewizard%2FPageGeneral 57 The Database Wizard creates a database file that contains information about a database.
32 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fgeneralpagewizard%2FdatasourceType 3e Select the database type for the existing database connection.
30 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fgeneralpagewizard%2FopenDatabase b5 Opens a file selection dialogue box in which you can select a database file. Click Open or OK in the file selection dialogue box to open the file immediately and to exit the wizard.
2e dbaccess%2Fui%2Fgeneralpagewizard%2FdocListBox 86 Select a database file to open from the list of recently used files. Click Finish to open the file immediately and to exit the wizard.
33 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fgeneralpagewizard%2FconnectDatabase 49 Select to create a database document for an existing database connection.
32 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fgeneralpagewizard%2FcreateDatabase 20 Select to create a new database.
38 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fgeneralpagewizard%2FopenExistingDatabase 68 Select to open a database file from a list of recently used files or from a file selection dialogue box.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Ffinalpagewizard%2Fusewizard 46 Select to call the Table Wizard after the Database Wizard is finished.
2c dbaccess%2Fui%2Ffinalpagewizard%2Fnoregister 4e Select to keep the database information only within the created database file.
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Ffinalpagewizard%2FPageFinal 6a Specifies whether you want to register the database, open the database for editing, or insert a new table.
2d dbaccess%2Fui%2Ffinalpagewizard%2Fopenediting 4f Select to display the database file, where you can edit the database structure.
2d dbaccess%2Fui%2Ffinalpagewizard%2Fyesregister 11e Select to register the database within your user copy of %PRODUCTNAME. After registering, the database is displayed in the View - Data Sources window. You must register a database to be able to insert the database fields in a document (Insert - Fields - More Fields) or in a mail merge.
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_MSACCESS_PB_MSACCESSLOCATION 2c Click to open a file selection dialogue box.
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_MSACCESS_ET_MSACCESSLOCATION 28 Specifies the path to the database file.
28 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ADO_PB_ADOURL 30 Click to open a database selection dialogue box.
28 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ADO_ET_ADOURL 1a Enter the data source URL.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_DBASE_PB_DBASELOCATION 23 Open a path selection dialogue box.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_DBASE_ET_DBASELOCATION 28 Enter the path to the dBASE *.dbf files.
2f dbaccess%2Fui%2Fjdbcconnectionpage%2FjdbcButton 2f Tests the connection with the current settings.
37 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fjdbcconnectionpage%2FJDBCConnectionPage 30 Specifies the options to access a JDBC database.
32 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLHOSTSERVER 41 hostname is the name of the machine that runs the MySQL database.
2e dbaccess%2Fui%2Fjdbcconnectionpage%2FjdbcEntry 22 Enter the name of the JDBC driver.
2e dbaccess%2Fui%2Fjdbcconnectionpage%2Fbrowseurl df Enter the URL for the database. For example, for the MySQL JDBC driver, enter "jdbc:mysql://<Servername>/<name of the database>". For more information on the JDBC driver, consult the documentation that came with the driver.
30 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fconnectionpage%2FjavaDriverLabel 22 Enter the name of the JDBC driver.
2c DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLPORT df Enter the URL for the database. For example, for the MySQL JDBC driver, enter "jdbc:mysql://<Servername>/<name of the database>". For more information on the JDBC driver, consult the documentation that came with the driver.
17 HID_DSADMIN_USESSL_LDAP 56 Creates a secure connection to the LDAP server through the Secure Sockets Layer (SSL).
19 HID_DSADMIN_LDAP_HOSTNAME 45 Enter the name of the LDAP server using the format "ldap.server.com".
1b HID_DSADMIN_LDAP_PORTNUMBER 30 Enter the port of the LDAP server, normally 389.
17 HID_DSADMIN_LDAP_BASEDN 4c Enter the starting point to search the LDAP database, for example, "dc=com".
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbwizmysqlintropage%2Fjdbc 48 Connects to an existing JDBC data source that was set on a system level.
2a dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbwizmysqlintropage%2Fodbc 48 Connects to an existing ODBC data source that was set on a system level.
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ODBC_PB_NAMEOFODBCDATASOURCE 39 Click to open an ODBC data source selection dialogue box:
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ODBC_ET_NAMEOFODBCDATASOURCE 24 Enter the path to the database file.
30 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fconnectionpage%2FjavaDriverLabel 22 Enter the name of the JDBC driver.
2f DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ORACLE_ET_ORACLEPORT 2e Enter the port number for the database server.
35 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ORACLE_ET_ORACLEHOSTSERVER 26 Enter the name of the Oracle database.
30 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ORACLE_ET_ORACLECLASS 26 Enter the URL for the database server.
37 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbwizspreadsheetpage%2Fpasswordrequired 44 Select to request a password from the user of the database document.
2d dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbwizspreadsheetpage%2Fbrowse 2c Click to open a file selection dialogue box.
3b dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbwizspreadsheetpage%2FDBWizSpreadsheetPage 35 Enter the path and file name to the spreadsheet file.
30 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbwizspreadsheetpage%2Fbrowseurl 35 Enter the path and file name to the spreadsheet file.
2d dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftextpage%2Fthousandsseparator 90 Enter or select the character that is used as a thousands separator in the text file, for example a comma (1,000), or a dot-on-the-line (1.000).
2b dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftextpage%2Fdecimalseparator 8a Enter or select the character that is used as a decimal separator in the text file, for example, a dot-on-the-line (0.5) or a comma (0,5).
28 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftextpage%2Ftextseparator 4c Enter or select the character that identifies a text field in the text file.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftextpage%2Ffieldseparator 4a Enter or select the character that separates data fields in the text file.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbwiztextpage%2Fbrowseurl fd Enter the path to the text file or files. If you just want one text file, you can use any extension of the file name. If you enter a folder name, the text files in that folder must have the extension *.csv to be recognised as files of the text database.
24 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftextpage%2Fextension 42 Click to access custom files. Enter the extension in the text box.
2d dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbwiztextpage%2FDBWizTextPage 3f Specifies the settings for importing a database in text format.
26 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdbwiztextpage%2Fbrowse 2c Click to open a file selection dialogue box.
23 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftextpage%2Ftextfile 1a Click to access txt files.
21 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftextpage%2Fcustom 42 Click to access custom files. Enter the extension in the text box.
22 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftextpage%2Fcsvfile 1a Click to access CSV files.
3b dbaccess%2Fui%2Fauthentificationpage%2FtestConnectionButton 46 Check if the configured connection can be used to access the database.
3b dbaccess%2Fui%2Fauthentificationpage%2FgeneralUserNameEntry 2b Enter the user name to access the database.
3e dbaccess%2Fui%2Fauthentificationpage%2FpassRequiredCheckbutton 3e Select to prompt a user for a password to access the database.
1b .uno%3ADBDSAdvancedSettings 2b Opens the Advanced Properties dialogue box.
19 .uno%3ADBDSConnectionType 21 Opens the Connection Type Wizard.
2b .uno%3ADBNewReportAutoPilotWithPreSelection 40 Starts the Report Wizard for the selected table, query, or view.
d .uno%3ADBEdit 50 Opens a window in which you can edit the selected table, query, form, or report.
15 .uno%3ADBDSProperties 2b Opens the Database Properties dialogue box.
29 .uno%3ADBNewFormAutoPilotWithPreSelection 3e Starts the Form Wizard for the selected table, query, or view.
1f DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_TABLE_EDIT 50 Opens a window in which you can edit the selected table, query, form, or report.
16 .uno%3ADBConvertToView cf Converts the selected query to a view. The original query remains in your database file and an additional view is generated on the database server. You must have write permission to add a view to a database.
1f .uno%3ADBDatabasePropertiesMenu 11 Opens a sub-menu.
18 HID_BROWSER_TABLE_DELETE 33 Deletes the selected table, query, form, or report.
f .uno%3ADBRename 71 Renames the selected object. Depending on the database, some names, characters, and name length might be invalid.
d .uno%3ADBOpen 32 Opens the selected object in the last saved state.
1b .uno%3ADBSendReportToWriter 86 Exports the selected report to a text document. A dynamic report is exported as a copy of the database contents at the time of export.
19 .uno%3ADBSendReportAsMail 10e Opens the default e-mail application to send a new e-mail. The selected report is appended as an attachment. You can enter the subject, the recipients and the main text of the e-mail. A dynamic report is exported as a copy of the database contents at the time of export.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcollectionviewdialog%2Fok 2e Click to save the form into the database file.
34 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcollectionviewdialog%2FfileNameEntry 27 Enter the file name for the saved form.
2f dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcollectionviewdialog%2FupButton 31 Click to go up one level in the folder hierarchy.
35 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcollectionviewdialog%2FCollectionView 36 Click to create a new folder within the database file.
36 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fcollectionviewdialog%2FnewFolderButton 36 Click to create a new folder within the database file.
12 .uno%3ADBNewFolder 4f Opens a dialogue box with which you can save a new folder in the database file.
13 .uno%3ADBNewViewSQL 1d Opens a new view in SQL mode.
12 .uno%3ADBNewReport 48 Starts the Report Builder window for the selected table, view, or query.
10 .uno%3ADBNewForm 27 Opens a new text document in form mode.
14 .uno%3ADBNewQuerySql 1e Opens a new query in SQL mode.
11 .uno%3ADBNewQuery 21 Opens a new query in design mode.
11 .uno%3ADBNewTable 1c Opens the table design view.
10 .uno%3ADBNewView 20 Opens a new view in design mode.
12 .uno%3ADBDirectSQL 41 Opens the SQL dialogue box in which you can enter SQL statements.
33 dbaccess%2Fui%2Ftablesfilterpage%2FTablesFilterPage 6d Opens the Table Filter dialogue box in which you can specify which tables of the database to show or to hide.
17 .uno%3ADBRelationDesign 5d Opens the Relation Design view and checks whether the database connection supports relations.
12 .uno%3ADBUserAdmin 51 Opens the User Administration dialogue box if the database supports this feature.
16 .uno%3ADBRefreshTables 15 Refreshes the tables.
17 .uno%3ADBShowDocPreview 36 The preview displays the document of a form or report.
10 .uno%3ADBPreview 11 Opens a sub-menu.
12 .uno%3ADBViewForms 43 Selects the forms container and shows all forms in the detail view.
17 .uno%3ADBDisablePreview 2c Disables the preview in the database window.
d .uno%3ADBSort 11 Opens a sub-menu.
1b .uno%3ADBShowDocInfoPreview 49 The preview window displays the document information of a form or report.
1c .uno%3ADBDatabaseObjectsMenu 11 Opens a sub-menu.
14 .uno%3ADBViewReports 47 Selects the reports container and shows all reports in the detail view.
14 .uno%3ADBViewQueries 47 Selects the queries container and shows all queries in the detail view.
13 .uno%3ADBViewTables 45 Selects the tables container and shows all tables in the detail view.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fsummarypage%2FSummaryPage 96 The Database Document Macro Migration Wizard moves existing macros from sub-documents of an old Base file into the new Base file's macro storage area.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fprepagepage%2FPreparePage 96 The Database Document Macro Migration Wizard moves existing macros from sub-documents of an old Base file into the new Base file's macro storage area.
26 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fsummarypage%2Ftextview 42 The list shows all changes that were applied to the database file.
23 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fbackuppage%2Fbrowse c1 Choose a location and file name to save the new database file. By default, the new file gets the same name as the old file, while the old file gets renamed with the string "backup" in the name.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fmigratepage%2FMigratePage 96 The Database Document Macro Migration Wizard moves existing macros from sub-documents of an old Base file into the new Base file's macro storage area.
27 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fbackuppage%2FBackupPage 96 The Database Document Macro Migration Wizard moves existing macros from sub-documents of an old Base file into the new Base file's macro storage area.
17 .uno%3ADBMigrateScripts 96 The Database Document Macro Migration Wizard moves existing macros from sub-documents of an old Base file into the new Base file's macro storage area.
36 svtools%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_LOGIN%3ACB_LOGIN_SAVEPASSWORD a1 Select to use the same user name and password without a further dialogue box, when you connect again to the same data source in the current %PRODUCTNAME session.
2e svtools%3AEdit%3ADLG_LOGIN%3AED_LOGIN_USERNAME 32 Enter the user name to connect to the data source.
2e svtools%3AEdit%3ADLG_LOGIN%3AED_LOGIN_PASSWORD 31 Enter the password to connect to the data source.
17 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD 36 The Query Wizard helps you to design a database query.
24 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTSELFIELDS 3b Displays all fields that will be included in the new query.
21 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTTABLES 39 Specifies the table for which the query is to be created.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT4 64 Specifies additional fields by which the created query is sorted, if previous sort fields are equal.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT3 64 Specifies additional fields by which the created query is sorted, if previous sort fields are equal.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND4 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND3 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND2 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT2 64 Specifies additional fields by which the created query is sorted, if previous sort fields are equal.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND1 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND4 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND2 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT1 39 Specifies the field by which the created query is sorted.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND1 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND3 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTVALUE_3 29 Enter the value for the filter condition.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTVALUE_2 29 Enter the value for the filter condition.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTVALUE_1 29 Enter the value for the filter condition.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTOPERATOR_3 24 Select the condition for the filter.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTOPERATOR_2 24 Select the condition for the filter.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTMATCHANY 47 Select to filter the query by any of the conditions using a logical OR.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTMATCHALL 45 Select to filter the query by all the conditions using a logical AND.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTOPERATOR_1 24 Select the condition for the filter.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDNAME_1 2f Select the field name for the filter condition.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDNAME_2 2f Select the field name for the filter condition.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDNAME_3 2f Select the field name for the filter condition.
29 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_BTNAGGREGATEMINUS 21 Removes the last row of controls.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_BTNAGGREGATEPLUS 1e Appends a new row of controls.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTAGGREGATEFIELDS_1 1e Select the numeric field name.
2e WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTAGGREGATEFUNCTION_1 1e Select the aggregate function.
2f WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTAGGREGATEDETAILQUERY 28 Select to show all records of the query.
30 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTAGGREGATESUMMARYQUERY 33 Select to show only results of aggregate functions.
2a WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERSELFIELDS 3b Displays all fields that are to be used to group the query.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTFILTERVALUE_2 2b Enter the value for the grouping condition.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTGROUPMATCHANY 46 Select to group the query by any of the conditions using a logical OR.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTFILTERVALUE_3 2b Enter the value for the grouping condition.
2b WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTEROPERATOR_3 26 Select the condition for the grouping.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTGROUPMATCHALL 44 Select to group the query by all the conditions using a logical AND.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDNAME_3 31 Select the field name for the grouping condition.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDNAME_1 31 Select the field name for the grouping condition.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTFILTERVALUE_1 2b Enter the value for the grouping condition.
2b WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTEROPERATOR_2 26 Select the condition for the grouping.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDNAME_2 31 Select the field name for the grouping condition.
2b WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTEROPERATOR_1 26 Select the condition for the grouping.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTTITLE_1 23 Enter the alias for the field name.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTSUMMARY 20 Displays a summary of the query.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTMODIFYQUERY 31 Select to save the query and open it for editing.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTQUERYTITLE 1c Enter the name of the query.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDISPLAYQUERY 25 Select to save and display the query.
2f modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fdatetimedialog%2Ftime 94 Enable Include Time to insert a time field into the active area of the report. The time field displays the current time when the report is executed.
1a .uno%3AInsertDateTimeField 65 You can open the Date and Time dialogue box of the Report Builder by choosing Insert - Date and Time.
2f modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fdatetimedialog%2Fdate 94 Enable Include Date to insert a date field into the active area of the report. The date field displays the current date when the report is executed.
39 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fdatetimedialog%2FDateTimeDialog 65 You can open the Date and Time dialogue box of the Report Builder by choosing Insert - Date and Time.
1a .uno%3ASectionShrinkBottom 3a Shrinks the selected section to remove bottom empty space.
11 .uno%3AVFixedLine 2c Inserts a vertical line to the current area.
14 .uno%3ASectionShrink 42 Shrinks the selected section to remove top and bottom empty space.
15 .uno%3AGreatestHeight 5c Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the greatest height.
14 .uno%3AGreatestWidth 5b Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the greatest width.
11 .uno%3AHFixedLine 2e Inserts a horizontal line to the current area.
18 .uno%3ASectionAlignRight 64 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the right margin of the area.
17 .uno%3ASectionAlignLeft 63 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the left margin of the area.
19 .uno%3ASectionAlignBottom 65 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the bottom margin of the area.
14 .uno%3ASmallestWidth 5b Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the smallest width.
17 .uno%3ASectionShrinkTop 37 Shrinks the selected section to remove top empty space.
16 .uno%3ASectionAlignTop 62 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the top margin of the area.
15 .uno%3ASmallestHeight 5c Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the smallest height.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PREEVALUATED 57 If Pre evaluation is enabled, functions are evaluated only when the report is finished.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_REPORT_NAVIGATOR_TREE 9f Click an entry in the Report Navigator. The corresponding object or area is selected in the Report Builder view. Right-click an entry to open the context menu.
16 .uno%3AReportNavigator 7f The Report Navigator reveals the structure of the report. You can use the Report Navigator to insert functions into the report.
28 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_INITIALFORMULA 5a Enter the initial value for the evaluation of the formula. Often this is set to 0 or to 1.
12 .uno%3ANewFunction ae In the context menu of the Report Navigator, you will see the same commands as in the Report Builder view, plus additional commands to create new functions or to delete them.
21 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_FORMULA 44 Enter the formula that defines the function. Use OpenFormula syntax.
28 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_DEEPTRAVERSING e8 If Deep traversing is enabled, functions are evaluated considering all lower levels of hierarchy. This would be used for instance for line numbering. If Deep traversing is not enabled, only the first level of hierarchy is evaluated.
36 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2Falignment 9 Alignment
37 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2Fbottompage 17 Bottom of Page (Footer)
34 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2Ftoppage 14 Top of Page (Header)
35 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2Fpagenofm b Page N of M
3d modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2FPageNumberDialog 63 You can open the Page Numbers dialogue box of the Report Builder by choosing Insert - Page Numbers.
32 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2Fpagen 6 Page N
23 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_DATAFIELD 43 On the Data tab page, you can change the data contents to be shown.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VERTICAL_ALIGN f Vert. Alignment
2e REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PRINTWHENGROUPCHANGE 17 Print when group change
22 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_FONT 2d Select the font for the selected text object.
23 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_WIDTH 26 Sets the width of the selected object.
2d REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PRINTREPEATEDVALUES 23 Specifies to print repeated values.
2a REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PAGEFOOTEROPTION 78 Specifies in which context the page footer will be printed: on all pages, or not on pages with a report header or footer
2a REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PAGEHEADEROPTION 79 Specifies in which context the page header will be printed: on all pages, or not on pages with a report header or footer.
24 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_HEIGHT 2a Defines the height of the selected object.
2b REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_GROUPKEEPTOGETHER 5c Groups are kept together by page or by column (default). You must enable Keep Together also.
1e REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_FIELD_SEL c4 The Add Field window is shown automatically when you have selected a table in the Contents box and leave that box. You can also click the Add Field icon on the toolbar, or choose View - Add Field.
13 .uno%3ASelectReport 67 To display the Data or General tab page for the whole report, choose Edit - Select All - Select Report.
21 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_VISIBLE 68 An invisible object is not shown in the executed report. It is still visible in the Report Builder view.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_KEEPTOGETHER 78 Keep Together specifies to print the current object starting on top of a new page if it doesn't fit on the current page.
29 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_BACKTRANSPARENT 51 Specifies whether the background of the selected object is transparent or opaque.
23 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_BACKCOLOR 54 Sets the background colour for the selected object, both on screen and for printing.
27 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_POSITIONX 2a Set the X Position for the selected object
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_FORCENEWPAGE 66 Force New Page specifies whether the current section and/or the next section is printed on a new page.
25 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_NEWROWORCOL 93 New Row Or Column specifies, for a multi-column design, whether the current section and/or the next section will be printed on a new row or column.
27 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_POSITIONY 2a Set the Y Position for the selected object
34 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_CONDITIONALPRINTEXPRESSION 5b If the Conditional Print Expression evaluates to TRUE, the selected object will be printed.
25 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PRESERVEIRI f5 For a picture, you can specify to either insert the picture as a link to a file or only as an embedded object in the Base file. The embedded option increases the size of the Base file, while the link option is not as portable to other computers.
31 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2Finterval 3b Enter the group interval value that records are grouped by.
2e modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2Fgroup 4b Select to create a new group on each changed value, or on other properties.
2f modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2Ffooter 28 Select to show or hide the Group Footer.
30 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2Fsorting 19 Select the sorting order.
35 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2FFloatingSort b8 In the Sorting and Grouping dialogue box of Report Builder, you can define the fields that should be sorted in your report, and the fields that should be kept together to form a group.
2d modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2Fkeep 4e Select the level of detail by which a group is kept together on the same page.
2f modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2Fdelete 29 Removes the selected field from the list.
1b .uno%3ADbSortingAndGrouping b8 In the Sorting and Grouping dialogue box of Report Builder, you can define the fields that should be sorted in your report, and the fields that should be kept together to form a group.
2c modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2Fbox 9f Lists the fields that will be used for sorting or grouping. The field at the top has the highest priority, the second field has the second priority, and so on.
2b modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2Fup 28 Moves the selected field up in the list.
2d modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2Fdown 2a Moves the selected field down in the list.
2f modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Ffloatingsort%2Fheader 28 Select to show or hide the Group Header.
24 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_FIELDEXPRESSION 37 Click to open a list from which you can select a field.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_DIALOG 36 The Table Wizard helps you to create a database table.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_FIELDSSELECTED 3b Displays all fields that will be included in the new table.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LBTABLES a2 Select one of the sample tables. Then select fields from that table from the left list box. Repeat this step until you have selected all the fields that you need.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPTBUSINESS 40 Select the business category to see only business sample tables.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPTPRIVATE 3e Select the private category to see only private sample tables.
21 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_BOOL_DEFAULT 2f Specifies the default value for a Yes/No field.
1d DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_REQUIRED 2c If set to Yes, this field must not be empty.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMINUS 2c Remove the selected field from the list box.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_COLNAME 54 Displays the name of the selected data field. If you want, you can enter a new name.
18 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_LEN 36 Specifies the number of characters for the data field.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LB_SELFIELDNAMES 36 Select a field in order to edit the field information.
1a DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_SCALE 7c Specifies the number of decimal places for the data field. This option is only available for numeric or decimal data fields.
19 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_TYPE 14 Select a field type.
22 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_AUTOINCREMENT 53 If set to Yes, the values for this data field are generated by the database engine.
23 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_AUTOINCREMENTVALUE 70 Enter the SQL command specifier that instructs the data source to auto-increment a specified Integer data field.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDPLUS 25 Add a new data field to the list box.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_FIELDS_PK_AVAILABLE 47 Select a field and click > to add it to the list of primary key fields.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_PK_SEVERAL 4f Select to create a primary key from a concatenation of several existing fields.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_PK_AUTOMATIC 41 Select to automatically add a primary key as an additional field.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CHK_USEPRIMEKEY cd Select to create a primary key. Add a primary key to every database table to uniquely identify each record. For some database systems within %PRODUCTNAME, a primary key is mandatory for editing the tables.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_PK_SINGLE 44 Select to use an existing field with unique values as a primary key.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_FIELDS_PK_SELECTED aa Select a field and click < to remove it from the list of primary key fields. The primary key is created as a concatenation of the fields in this list, from top to bottom.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LB_PK_FIELDNAME 16 Select the field name.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CK_PK_AUTOVALUE b6 Select to automatically insert a value and increment the field's value for each new record. The database must support automatic incrementation in order to use the Auto value feature.
2e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CK_PK_AUTOVALUE_AUTOMATIC b6 Select to automatically insert a value and increment the field's value for each new record. The database must support automatic incrementation in order to use the Auto value feature.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_STARTFORMWIZARD 83 Select to create a form based on this table. The form is created on a text document with the last used settings of the Form Wizard.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_WORKWITHTABLE 29 Select to save and edit the table design.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LST_SCHEMA 52 Select the schema for the table. (Available only if the database supports schemas)
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_TXT_NAME 19 Specifies the table name.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_MODIFYTABLE 41 Select to save the table design and open the table to enter data.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LST_CATALOG 58 Select the catalogue for the table. (Available only if the database supports catalogues)
15 .uno%3ADBReportDelete 1c Deletes the selected report.
15 .uno%3ADBReportRename 1c Renames the selected report.
13 .uno%3ADBReportEdit 37 Opens the selected report so you can change the layout.
13 .uno%3ADBFormRename 1a Renames the selected form.
11 .uno%3ADBFormEdit 35 Opens the selected form so you can change the layout.
13 .uno%3ADBFormDelete 1a Deletes the selected form.
14 .uno%3ADBQueryRename 1b Renames the selected query.
14 .uno%3ADBQueryDelete 1b Deletes the selected query.
13 .uno%3ADBReportOpen 44 Opens the selected report so you can enter, edit, or delete records.
12 .uno%3ADBTableOpen 43 Opens the selected table so you can enter, edit, or delete records.
12 .uno%3ADBQueryOpen 43 Opens the selected query so you can enter, edit, or delete records.
11 .uno%3ADBFormOpen 42 Opens the selected form so you can enter, edit, or delete records.
12 .uno%3ADBTableEdit 39 Opens the selected table so you can change the structure.
14 .uno%3ADBTableDelete 1b Deletes the selected table.
14 .uno%3ADBTableRename 1b Renames the selected table.
12 .uno%3ADBQueryEdit 39 Opens the selected query so you can change the structure.
38 svx%2Fui%2Ffontworkspacingdialog%2FFontworkSpacingDialog 2b Enter the Fontwork character spacing value.
26 .uno%3AFontworkCharacterSpacingFloater 2c Opens the Fontwork Character Spacing window.
1f .uno%3AFontworkAlignmentFloater 24 Opens the Fontwork Alignment window.
18 .uno%3AFontworkShapeType 64 Opens the Fontwork Shape toolbar. Click a shape to apply the shape to all selected Fontwork objects.
20 .uno%3AFontworkSameLetterHeights 6b Switches the letter height of the selected Fontwork objects from normal to the same height for all objects.
30 fps%2Fui%2Fremotefilesdialog%2FRemoteFilesDialog 1f Remote Files Service User Guide
3d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fsharedocumentdlg%2FShareDocumentDialog 6f Opens the Share Document dialogue box in which you can enable or disable collaborative sharing of the document.
14 .uno%3AShareDocument 6f Opens the Share Document dialogue box in which you can enable or disable collaborative sharing of the document.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconflictsdialog%2Fkeepallothers 39 Keeps the changes of all other users, voids your changes.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fsharedocumentdlg%2Fshare dc Enable to share the current document with other users. Disable to use the document unshared. This will invalidate the not yet saved edits that other users applied in the time since you last opened or saved this document.
38 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconflictsdialog%2FConflictsDialog 8f If the same contents are changed by different users, the Resolve Conflicts dialogue box opens. For each conflict, decide which changes to keep.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconflictsdialog%2Fkeepmine 2a Keeps your change, voids the other change.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconflictsdialog%2Fkeepallmine 30 Keeps all your changes, voids all other changes.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconflictsdialog%2Fkeepother 36 Keeps the change of the other user, voids your change.
15 .uno%3AFormFilterExit 64 If you click on the Close button on the Form Filter toolbar, the form is displayed without a filter.
18 .uno%3AFormFilterExecute 65 If you click the Apply Form-Based Filter icon on the Form Filter toolbar, the filter will be applied.
1e .uno%3AConfigureToolboxVisible 41 Opens a dialogue box in which you can add, edit and remove icons.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fnewtoolbardialog%2FNewToolbarDialog 41 Opens a dialogue box in which you can add, edit and remove icons.
19 SID_FM_FILTER_IS_NOT_NULL de You can edit the filter conditions in this area directly as text. If you wish to check if a field has content or no content, you can select the filter conditions "empty" (SQL:"Is Null") or "not empty" (SQL: "Is not Null").
1a .uno%3AFormFilterNavigator 69 To connect several filter conditions with Boolean OR, click the Filter navigation icon on the filter bar.
14 HID_FILTER_NAVIGATOR 194 The filter conditions that have been set appear in the Filter navigator. As soon as a filter is set, you see a blank filter entry at the bottom of the Filter navigator. You can select this entry by clicking the word "Or". Once you have selected the blank filter entry, you can enter additional filter conditions in the form. These conditions are linked by Boolean OR to the previously defined conditions.
2f svx%2Fui%2Ffontworkgallerydialog%2FctlFavorites bc Select a Fontwork style and click OK to insert the Fontwork into your document. Double-click or Ctrl+double-click the Fontwork in your document to enter text edit mode and change the text.
38 svx%2Fui%2Ffontworkgallerydialog%2FFontworkGalleryDialog bc Select a Fontwork style and click OK to insert the Fontwork into your document. Double-click or Ctrl+double-click the Fontwork in your document to enter text edit mode and change the text.
12 .uno%3ASaveGraphic 9c To export a bitmap in Writer: Right-click the bitmap, choose Save Graphics. You see the Image Export dialogue box. Enter a file name and select a file type.
1c .uno%3APreviousTrackedChange 41 Jumps to and selects the previous change in the document, if any.
18 .uno%3ANextTrackedChange 3d Jumps to and selects the next change in the document, if any.
21 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fmath_all 44 The document buttons each open a new document of the specified type.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fimpress_all 44 The document buttons each open a new document of the specified type.
21 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fdraw_all 44 The document buttons each open a new document of the specified type.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fwriter_all 44 The document buttons each open a new document of the specified type.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Ftemplates_all 67 Click the Templates drop-down button to display all existing templates on the right side of the window.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Flocal_view 51 The Recent Files button shows thumbnails of the most recent documents you opened.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fdatabase_all 44 The document buttons each open a new document of the specified type.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fall_recent 51 The Recent Files button shows thumbnails of the most recent documents you opened.
1d sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fhelp 4e Click a button on the left pane to open a new document or a file dialogue box.
15 FWK_HID_BACKINGWINDOW 4e Click a button on the left pane to open a new document or a file dialogue box.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fextensions 94 The Extensions button opens the https://extensions.libreoffice.org/ page, where you can download templates and additional features for %PRODUCTNAME.
21 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fcalc_all 44 The document buttons each open a new document of the specified type.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2FStartCenter 4e Click a button on the left pane to open a new document or a file dialogue box.
21 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fopen_all 37 The Open File button presents a file open dialogue box.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fopen_remote 64 The Remote Files button presents a Remote files dialogue box to open files stored on remote servers.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fopen_recent 51 The Recent Files button shows thumbnails of the most recent documents you opened.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Ftemplatedlg%2Fimport_btn 99 Press the Import button at the bottom right, and then choose a Category to import a template from your computer to that category in the Template Manager.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Ftemplatedlg%2Fexport_btn 8e Choose a template in the main window and then press the Export button at the bottom right to export the template to a folder on your computer.
21 sfx%2Fui%2Ftemplatedlg%2Fmove_btn bb Choose the Move option at the bottom right after selecting a template to move it to a different category. Default templates cannot be moved, but copies can be created in other categories.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Ftemplatedlg%2Fsearch_filter 7c You may search for a template by entering text in the search box at the top left. The Main window shows the templates found.
2b sfx%2Fui%2Ftemplatedlg%2Ffilter_application b9 You may filter for All Applications, Documents, Spreadsheets or Drawings by choosing an option from the drop-down box at the top-centre. The main window displays the filtered templates.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Ftemplatedlg%2Faction_menu 48 Click on the Settings icon at the bottom left to open the Settings menu.
27 sfx%2Fui%2Ftemplatedlg%2FTemplateDialog 76 The Template Manager dialogue box makes it easy to manage templates and allows to start new documents using templates.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Ftemplatedlg%2Ffilter_folder 36 Categories are folders where you place your templates.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Ftemplatedlg%2Fonline_link b5 To browse for more templates online, click on the Browse online templates icon at bottom left to open a browser window and search for templates at https://templates.libreoffice.org.
c .uno%3AAbout 4b Displays general program information such as version number and copyrights.
13 .uno%3AOnlineUpdate ee Enable an Internet connection for %PRODUCTNAME. If you need a Proxy, check the %PRODUCTNAME Proxy settings in Tools - Options - Internet. Then choose Check for Updates to check for the availability of a newer version of your office suite.
12 .uno%3AShowLicense d3 Displays the CREDITS.odt document which lists the names of individuals who have contributed to OpenOffice.org source code (and whose contributions were imported into LibreOffice) or LibreOffice since 2010-09-28.
10 .uno%3AHelpIndex 4a Opens the main page of the $[officename] Help for the current application.
13 .uno%3ASendFeedback 4f Opens a feedback form in the web browser, where users can report software bugs.
f .uno%3AHelpMenu 4c The Help menu allows you to start and control the $[officename] Help system.
16 .uno%3AQuestionAnswers 34 Opens the community support page in the web browser.
f .uno%3ASafeMode b0 Safe mode is a mode where %PRODUCTNAME temporarily starts with a fresh user profile and disables hardware acceleration. It helps to restore a non-working %PRODUCTNAME instance.
14 .uno%3ADocumentation 8f Opens the documentation page in the web browser, where users can download, read or purchase %PRODUCTNAME user guides, written by the community.
13 .uno%3AExtendedHelp 48 Enables extended help tips under the mouse pointer until the next click.
e RID_ENVTOOLBOX 41 The Standard bar is available in every $[officename] application.
12 .uno%3ATableDesign 43 Opens the Table Design. Double-click a preview to format the table.
18 .HelpId%3Atableobjectbar 75 The Table Bar contains functions you need when working with tables. It appears when you move the cursor into a table.
14 .uno%3ADSBFormLetter 34 Starts the Mail Merge Wizard to create form letters.
17 .uno%3ADSBInsertColumns 59 Inserts all fields of the marked record into the current document at the cursor position.
13 .uno%3ADeleteRecord 40 Deletes a record. A query needs to be confirmed before deleting.
10 .uno%3ANewRecord 15 Creates a new record.
e .uno%3ARecUndo 20 Allows you to undo a data entry.
12 .uno%3AFirstRecord 1e Takes you to the first record.
11 .uno%3ALastRecord 1d Takes you to the last record.
15 .uno%3AAbsoluteRecord 59 Shows the number of the current record. Enter a number to go to the corresponding record.
11 .uno%3APrevRecord 21 Takes you to the previous record.
11 .uno%3ANextRecord 1d Takes you to the next record.
e .uno%3ARecSave 41 Saves a new data entry. The change is registered in the database.
e .uno%3AGridUse 3d Specifies that you can move objects only between grid points.
12 .uno%3ABezierClose 19 Closes a line or a curve.
13 .uno%3ABezierSmooth 41 Converts a corner point or symmetrical point into a smooth point.
11 .uno%3ABezierEdge 39 Converts the selected point or points into corner points.
11 .uno%3ABezierMove 2e Activates a mode in which you can move points.
13 .uno%3ABezierDelete a8 Use the Delete Points icon to delete one or several selected points. If you wish to select several points click the appropriate points while holding down the Shift key.
12 HID_BEZIER_TOOLBOX 53 The Edit Points Bar appears when you select a polygon object and click Edit Points.
14 .uno%3ABezierConvert 4f Converts a curve into a straight line or converts a straight line into a curve.
13 .uno%3ABezierInsert 41 Activates the insert mode. This mode allows you to insert points.
1c .uno%3ABezierEliminatePoints 3c Marks the current point or the selected points for deletion.
16 .uno%3ABezierSymmetric 4d This icon converts a corner point or a smooth point into a symmetrical point.
14 .uno%3ABezierCutLine 79 The Split Curve icon splits a curve. Select the point or points at which you want to split the curve, then click the icon
18 .uno%3AInsertObjectChart 4e Inserts a chart based on data from a cell or table range or with default data.
1a .uno%3AInsertFrameInteract 84 This sub-menu contains form controls like a text box, check box, option button, and list box that can be inserted into the document.
15 .uno%3AShapesLineMenu 4b This sub-menu contains straight, free-form, curved and polygon line shapes.
11 .uno%3AShapesMenu ad This sub-menu contains common shapes like a line, circle, triangle and square, or a symbol shape like a smiley face, heart and flower that can be inserted into the document.
16 HID_OFADLG_TREELISTBOX 18 Select an entry to edit.
18 .uno%3AOptionsTreeDialog 49 This command opens a dialogue box for a customised program configuration.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Femail 18 Type your email address.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fwork 24 Type your work number in this field.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fhome 31 Type your private telephone number in this field.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Ftitle 1e Type your title in this field.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fizip 21 Type your postcode in this field.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fcompany 2c Type the name of your company in this field.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Ficity 2e Type the name of the post town where you live.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2FOptUserPage 2d Use this tab page to enter or edit user data.
1c cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Ffax 23 Type your fax number in this field.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fstreet 2b Type the name of your street in this field.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fstate 2b Type the name of the county where you live.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Ffirstname 13 Type your forename.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fposition 30 Type your position in the company in this field.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Flastname 12 Type your surname.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fshortname 13 Type your initials.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fsaveas b7 Specifies how documents of the type selected on the left will always be saved as this file type. You may select another file type for the current document in the Save as dialogue box.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fdoctype 51 Specifies the document type for which you want to define the default file format.
20 sfx%2Fui%2Falienwarndialog%2Fask c4 You can choose to get a warning message when you save a document in a format that is not OpenDocument or which you did not set as default format in Load/Save - General in the Options dialogue box.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fwarnalienformat c4 You can choose to get a warning message when you save a document in a format that is not OpenDocument or which you did not set as default format in Load/Save - General in the Options dialogue box.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Frelative_fsys 43 Mark this check box for relative saving of URLs in the file system.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fload_settings 47 Loads the user-specific settings saved in a document with the document.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2FOptSavePage 72 In the General section, you can select default settings for saving documents, and can select default file formats.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fuserautosave 8d Specifies that %PRODUCTNAME saves all open documents when saving auto recovery information. Uses the same time interval as AutoRecovery does.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fautosave_spin 49 Specifies the time interval in minutes for the automatic recovery option.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fload_docprinter 173 If marked, the printer settings will be loaded with the document. This can cause a document to be printed on a distant printer, if you do not change the printer manually in the Print dialogue box. If unmarked, your standard printer will be used to print this document. The current printer settings will be stored with the document whether or not this check box is marked.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Frelative_inet 40 Mark this check box for relative saving of URLs in the Internet.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fbackup d5 Saves the previous version of a document as a backup copy whenever you save a document. Every time %PRODUCTNAME creates a backup copy, the previous backup copy is replaced. The backup copy gets the extension .BAK.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fodfversion fd Some companies or organisations may require ODF documents in the ODF 1.0/1.1 format. You can select that format to save in the list box. This older format cannot store all new features, so the new format ODF 1.2 (Extended) is recommended where possible.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fdocinfo 66 Specifies that the Properties dialogue box will appear every time that you select the Save As command.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fautosave 9b Specifies that %PRODUCTNAME saves the information needed to restore all open documents in case of a crash. You can specify the time interval between saves.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptpathspage%2Fedit 3c Click to display the Select Path or Edit Paths dialogue box.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptpathspage%2Fdefault 48 The Default button resets the predefined paths for all selected entries.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptpathspage%2FOptPathsPage 75 This section contains the default paths to important folders in $[officename]. These paths can be edited by the user.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptpathspage%2Fpaths 65 To modify an entry in this list, click the entry and click Edit. You can also double-click the entry.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fselectpathdialog%2Fadd 6c Opens the Select Path dialogue box to select another folder or the Open dialogue box to select another file.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fselectpathdialog%2Fpaths 5f Contains a list of the paths that have already been added. Mark the default path for new files.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fbreaknumberoptions%2FBreakNumberOption 50 Type the minimum number of characters that must come before or after the hyphen.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptnewdictionarydialog%2Fnameedit 30 Specifies the name of the new custom dictionary.
29 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Freplace 279 This input field is only available if you are editing an exception dictionary or a language-dependent custom dictionary. In exception dictionaries, the field shows the alternative suggestion for the current word in the "Word" text box. In language-dependent custom dictionaries, the field contains a known root word, as a model of affixation of the new word or its usage in compound words. For example, in a German custom dictionary, the new word “Litschi” (lychee) with the model word “Gummi” (gum) will result recognition of “Litschis” (lychees), “Litschibaum” (lychee tree), “Litschifrucht” (lychee fruit) etc.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flingudictsnew 90 Opens the New Dictionary dialogue box, in which you can name a new user-defined dictionary or dictionary of exceptions and specify the language.
26 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Fword 86 You can type a new word for inclusion in the dictionary. In the list below you will see the contents of the current custom dictionary.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flingumodulesedit 34 To edit a language module, select it and click Edit.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2FOptLinguPage 49 Specifies the properties of the spell checker, thesaurus and hyphenation.
2c cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Fnewreplace a0 Adds the word in the Word text field to your current custom dictionary. The word in the Suggestion field is also added when working with exception dictionaries.
28 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Fdelete 3b Removes the marked word from the current custom dictionary.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flinguoptionsedit 44 If you want to change a value, select the entry and then click Edit.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flingudictsedit 77 Opens the Edit custom dictionary dialogue box, in which you can add to your custom dictionary or edit existing entries.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flingumodules 28 Contains the installed language modules.
12 .uno%3ASpellOnline 41 Automatically checks spelling as you type, and underlines errors.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptnewdictionarydialog%2Flanguage 4f By selecting a certain language you can limit the use of the custom dictionary.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flingudictsdelete 59 Deletes the selected dictionary after a confirmation, provided it is not write-protected.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flinguoptions 34 Defines the options for spell check and hyphenation.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptnewdictionarydialog%2Fexcept 44 Specifies whether you wish to avoid certain words in your documents.
26 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Fbook 20 Specifies the book to be edited.
26 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Flang 38 Assigns a new language to the current custom dictionary.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feditmodulesdialog%2Fback 37 Click here to undo the current changes in the list box.
21 cui%2Fui%2Feditmodulesdialog%2Fup 4b Increases the priority of the module selected in the list box by one level.
29 cui%2Fui%2Feditmodulesdialog%2Flingudicts 71 Specifies the language and the available spelling, hyphenation and Thesaurus sub-modules for the selected module.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feditmodulesdialog%2Fdown 4b Decreases the priority of the module selected in the list box by one level.
27 cui%2Fui%2Feditmodulesdialog%2Flanguage 25 Specifies the language of the module.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2FB_custom 5b The colour code of the blue component of the colour. Possible values are between 0 and 255.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2FG_custom 5c The colour code of the green component of the colour. Possible values are between 0 and 255.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2Fnewpreview 73 Displays a preview of the colour selected from the colour palette and the changes you make with the controls below.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2Fpaletteselector 52 Specifies the name of a selected palette. You can select a different palette here.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2FR_custom 5a The colour code of the red component of the colour. Possible values are between 0 and 255.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2FColorPage 64 Allows you to select a colour from a colour palette, edit an existing colour, or define new colours.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2Fcolorset 58 Contains a list of available colours. Click on the desired one in the list to select it.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2Fhex_custom 3f The colour code of the colour expressed as a hexadecimal value.
1a cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2Fadd 2a Adds the new colour to the Custom palette.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2Frecentcolorset 36 Displays the last twelve colours selected and applied.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpage%2Fdelete 31 Deletes the selected colour without confirmation.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FkeySpinbutton 50 Set the Black colour value or key (black) as expressed in the CMYK colour model.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FmagSpinbutton 43 Set the Magenta colour value as expressed in the CMYK colour model.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FyellowSpinbutton 42 Set the Yellow colour value as expressed in the CMYK colour model.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FbrightSpinbutton 60 Set the Brightness directly in the HSB colour model. Values are expressed in percent (0 to 100).
30 cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FbrightRadiobutton c5 Sets the Brightness component modifiable on the vertical colour slider, and the Hue and Saturation components in the two dimensional colour picker field. Values are expressed in percent (0 to 100).
27 cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2Fprevious 63 In the right part of the bottom bar, you will see the original colour from the parent tab, Colours.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FgreenRadiobutton ab Sets the Green component modifiable on the vertical colour slider, and the Red and Blue components in the two dimensional colour picker field. Allowed values are 0 to 255.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FcolorField 127 Click in the big colour area on the left to select a new colour. Using this selector area you can modify two components of the colour as represented in the RGB or HSB colour models. Note that these are the two components not selected with the radio buttons on the right side of the dialogue box.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2Fpreview 64 In the left part of the bottom bar, the current result of your work in this dialogue box is visible.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FblueRadiobutton ab Sets the Blue component modifiable on the vertical colour slider, and the Green and Red components in the two dimensional colour picker field. Allowed values are 0 to 255.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FcyanSpinbutton 40 Set the Cyan colour value as expressed in the CMYK colour model.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FcolorSlider 63 With the vertical colour component slider you can modify the value of each component of the colour.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FredSpinbutton 3f Set the Red colour value directly. Allowed values are 0 to 255.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FgreenSpinbutton 41 Set the Green colour value directly. Allowed values are 0 to 255.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FblueSpinbutton 40 Set the Blue colour value directly. Allowed values are 0 to 255.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FColorPicker 8b %PRODUCTNAME lets you define custom colours using a two-dimensional graphic and numerical gradient chart of the Pick a Colour dialogue box.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FhexEntry 5d Displays and sets the colour value in the RGB colour model expressed as a hexadecimal number.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FhueRadiobutton c8 Sets the Hue component modifiable on the vertical colour slider, and the Saturation and Brightness components in the two dimensional colour picker field. Values are expressed in degrees from 0 to 359.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FredRadiobutton ab Sets the Red component modifiable on the vertical colour slider, and the Green and Blue components in the two dimensional colour picker field. Allowed values are 0 to 255.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FsatSpinbutton 60 Set the Saturation directly in the HSB colour model. Values are expressed in percent (0 to 100).
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FhueSpinbutton 5c Set the Hue directly in the HSB colour model. Values are expressed in degrees from 0 to 359.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fcolorpickerdialog%2FsatRadiobutton c5 Sets the Saturation component modifiable on the vertical colour slider, and the Hue and Brightness components in the two dimensional colour picker field. Values are expressed in percent (0 to 100).
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fcollectusageinfo 4f Send usage data to help The Document Foundation improve the software usability.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fyear 4a Defines a date range, within which the system recognises a two-digit year.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2FOptGeneralPage 31 Specifies the general settings for $[officename].
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fdocstatus 48 Specifies whether the printing of the document counts as a modification.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Ffiledlg 92 Specifies whether $[officename] dialogue boxes are used to open and save documents. Otherwise the dialogue boxes of the operating system are used.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fexthelp 72 Displays some short help text when you rest the cursor on an icon, a menu command, or a control in a dialogue box.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Ffontheight 41 Select a font size for the display of HTML and Basic source code.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Fnonpropfontonly 51 Mark this check box to display only non-proportional fonts in the Fonts list box.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Ffontname 3e Select the font for the display of HTML and Basic source code.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Fusetable 36 Enables the font replacement settings that you define.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Freplacements ca Substitutes a font with a font of your choice. The substitution only replaces a font when it is displayed on screen or during printing. It does not change the font specified in your document formatting.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Ffont1 3e Enter or select the name of the font that you want to replace.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Fapply 26 Applies the selected font replacement.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Fdelete 26 Deletes the selected font replacement.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Fchecklb 111 Lists the original font and the font that will replace it. Select Always to replace both the screen font and the printer font, even if the original font is installed on your system. Select Screen only to replace the screen font only and never replace the font for printing.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Ffont2 31 Enter or select the name of the replacement font.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Fuseopengl 97 Use the high performance Open Graphics Library (OpenGL) to render all visual elements of the application, including windows, menus, toolbars and icons.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Fuseaa b0 When supported, you can enable and disable anti-aliasing of graphics. With anti-aliasing enabled, the display of most graphical objects looks smoother and with fewer artifacts.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Fmenuicons a4 Displays icons next to the corresponding menu items. Select from "Automatic", "Hide" and "Show". "Automatic" displays icons according to system settings and themes.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Fuseaccel 63 Directly accesses hardware features of the graphical display adapter to improve the screen display.
5 20201 4a Press Shift+Ctrl+R to restore or refresh the view of the current document.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Fnotebookbariconsize 31 Specifies the display size of notebook bar icons.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Fforceopengl 44 Forces the use of OpenGL even if the graphics device is blacklisted.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Faafont 2f Select to smooth the screen appearance of text.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Fshowfontpreview 7b Displays the names of selectable fonts in the corresponding font, for example, fonts in the Font box on the Formatting bar.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Ficonsize 2c Specifies the display size of toolbar icons.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Fmousemiddle 30 Defines the function of the middle mouse button.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Fmousepos 59 Specifies if and how the mouse pointer will be positioned in newly opened dialogue boxes.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Fsidebariconsize 2c Specifies the display size of sidebar icons.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Ficonstyle 42 Specifies the icon style for icons in toolbars and dialogue boxes.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptviewpage%2Faanf 34 Enter the smallest font size to apply anti-aliasing.
27 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Fconverttogray 39 Specifies that all colours are printed only as greyscale.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducetransnone 2f With this option transparency is never printed.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducetransauto 76 Specifies that the transparency is only printed if the transparent area covers less than a quarter of the entire page.
2b sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmaptrans 75 If this field is marked, the reduction in print quality for bitmaps also applies to the transparent areas of objects.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Fpaperorient 5e Mark this check box if you need a certain paper orientation for printing the current document.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducetrans a5 If you mark this field the transparent objects will be printed like normal, non-transparent objects, depending on your selection in the following two option buttons.
2b sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmapresol 61 Specifies the maximum print quality in dpi. The resolution can only be reduced and not increased.
1f sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Ftrans 69 Mark this check box if you always want to be warned if transparent objects are contained in the document.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Fpapersize 58 Mark this check box if a certain paper size is needed for printing the current document.
1e sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Ffile 57 Specifies whether the print settings apply to direct printing or to printing to a file.
20 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Fframe2 35 Defines which warnings appear before printing begins.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2FOptPrintPage 24 Specifies the print setting options.
21 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Fprinter 57 Specifies whether the print settings apply to direct printing or to printing to a file.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmap 6e Specifies that bitmaps are printed with reduced quality. The resolution can only be reduced and not increased.
2b sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducegradstripes 3e Specifies the maximum number of gradient stripes for printing.
2d sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmapoptimal 75 High print quality corresponds to a resolution of 300dpi. Normal print quality corresponds to a resolution of 200dpi.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducegrad 44 If this field is marked, gradients are printed with reduced quality.
2c sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmapnormal 75 High print quality corresponds to a resolution of 300dpi. Normal print quality corresponds to a resolution of 200dpi.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmapdpi 61 Specifies the maximum print quality in dpi. The resolution can only be reduced and not increased.
28 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducegradstep 3e Specifies the maximum number of gradient stripes for printing.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducegradcolor 4a Specifies that gradients are only printed in a single intermediate colour.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptappearancepage%2Fcolorconfig 33 Select the colours for the user interface elements.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptappearancepage%2Fdelete 58 Deletes the colour scheme shown in the Scheme box. You cannot delete the Default scheme.
23 HID_OPTIONS_COLORCONFIG_NAME_SCHEME 23 Enter a name for the colour scheme.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptappearancepage%2Fsave 48 Saves the current settings as a colour scheme that you can reload later.
30 cui%2Fui%2Foptappearancepage%2FOptAppearancePage 36 Sets the colours for the $[officename] user interface.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptappearancepage%2Fcolorschemelb 2a Selects the colour scheme you want to use.
38 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Fsystempagepreviewcolor 4c Applies the high-contrast settings of the operating system to page previews.
32 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Fanimatedgraphics 40 Previews animated graphics, such as GIF images, in %PRODUCTNAME.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Fanimatedtext 48 Previews animated text, such as blinking and scrolling, in %PRODUCTNAME.
36 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2FOptAccessibilityPage 83 Sets options that make %PRODUCTNAME programs more accessible for users with reduced sight, limited dexterity or other disabilities.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Fautodetecthc 5d Switches %PRODUCTNAME into high-contrast mode when the system background colour is very dark.
33 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Ftextselinreadonly 27 Displays cursor in read-only documents.
2f cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Fautofontcolor 6d Displays fonts in %PRODUCTNAME using the system colour settings. This option only affects the screen display.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2FOptSavePage 25 Specifies general Load/Save settings.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fftp 2a Type the name of the proxy server for FTP.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fftpport 31 Type the port for the corresponding proxy server.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fnoproxy 62 Specifies the names of the servers that do not require any proxy servers, separated by semicolons.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fhttps 53 Type the name of the proxy server for HTTPS. Type the port in the right-hand field.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fproxymode 27 Specifies the type of proxy definition.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fhttp 2b Type the name of the proxy server for HTTP.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptemailpage%2Fbrowse 37 Opens a file dialogue box to select the e-mail program.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptemailpage%2Furl 27 Enter the e-mail program path and name.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Fcert 28 Opens the Certificate Path dialogue box.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Fmacro 26 Opens the Macro Security dialogue box.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fstoredwebconnectiondialog%2Fchange 5a Opens a dialogue box in which you can view and change the password for the selected entry.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fstoredwebconnectiondialog%2Fremoveall 22 Removes all entries from the list.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fstoredwebconnectiondialog%2Fremove 29 Removes the selected entry from the list.
40 cui%2Fui%2Fstoredwebconnectiondialog%2FStoredWebConnectionDialog 29 Removes the selected entry from the list.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Foptions 37 Opens the "Security Options and Warnings" dialogue box.
33 uui%2Fui%2Fmasterpassworddlg%2FMasterPasswordDialog 26 Enter the master password to continue.
2b uui%2Fui%2Fsetmasterpassworddlg%2Fpassword1 1a Enter the master password.
2b uui%2Fui%2Fsetmasterpassworddlg%2Fpassword2 20 Enter the master password again.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Ftsas 34 Opens the Time Stamping Authority URLs dialogue box.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Fconnections 76 Asks for the master password. If master password is correct, shows the Stored Web Connection Information dialogue box.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2FOptSecurityPage 76 Defines the security options for saving documents, for web connections, and for opening documents that contain macros.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Fsavepassword bb If enabled, %PRODUCTNAME will securely store all passwords that you use to access files from web servers. You can retrieve the passwords from the list after you enter the master password.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Fmasterpassword 2d Opens the Enter Master Password dialogue box.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fblockuntrusted 88 Blocks the use of links pointing to images not in the trusted locations defined on the Trusted Sources tab of the Macro Security dialog.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fctrlclick 88 If enabled, you must hold down the Ctrl key while clicking a hyperlink to follow that link. If not enabled, a click opens the hyperlink.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fpassword 95 Select to always enable the Save with password option in the file save dialogue boxes. Deselect the option to save files by default without password.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fsavesenddocs 83 Select to see a warning dialogue box when you try to save or send a document that contains recorded changes, versions, or comments.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2FSecurityOptionsDialog 50 Set security related options and warnings about hidden information in documents.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fwhenprinting 71 Select to see a warning dialogue box when you try to print a document that contains recorded changes or comments.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fwhensigning d1 Select to see a warning dialogue box when you try to sign a document that contains recorded changes, versions, fields, references to other sources (for example linked sections or linked pictures), or comments.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fwhenpdf 99 Select to see a warning dialogue box when you try to export a document to PDF format that displays recorded changes in Writer, or that displays comments.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fremovepersonal e3 Select to always remove user data from the file properties. If this option is not selected, you can still remove the personal information for the current document with the Reset Properties button on File - Properties - General.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fcharset 33 Select the appropriate character set for the export
25 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fsavegrflocal e3 Mark this check box to automatically upload the embedded pictures to the Internet server when uploading using FTP. Use the Save As dialogue box to save the document and enter a complete FTP URL as the file name in the Internet.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fprintextension a2 If you mark this field, the print layout of the current document (for example, table of contents with justified page numbers and dot leaders) is exported as well.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fstarbasicwarning 6f If this field is marked, when exporting to HTML a warning is shown that %PRODUCTNAME Basic macros will be lost.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fsize7 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML <font size=1> to <font size=7> tags.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2FOptHtmlPage 20 Defines settings for HTML pages.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fnumbersenglishus dd If not marked, numbers will be interpreted according to the setting in Language Settings - Language of - Locale setting in the Options dialogue box. If marked, numbers will be interpreted using the 'English (USA)' locale.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Funknowntag 67 Mark this check box if you want tags that are not recognised by $[officename] to be imported as fields.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fignorefontnames 97 Mark this check box to ignore all font settings when importing. The fonts that were defined in the HTML Page Style will be the fonts that will be used.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fstarbasic 62 Mark this check box to include the $[officename] Basic instructions when exporting to HTML format.
14 .uno%3ASwEditOptions a4 These settings determine the way text documents that are created in $[officename] are handled. It is also possible to define settings for the current text document.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fcomments db Displays comments. Click a comment to edit the text. Use the context menu in Navigator to locate or delete a comment. Use the comment's context menu to delete this comment or all comments or all comments of this author.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Ffieldcodes 4f Displays the field names in the document instead of the contents of the fields.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fdrawings 3e Displays the drawings and controls contained in your document.
16 .uno%3ATableBoundaries 8c To display the table boundaries, right-click any table and choose Table Boundaries, or choose Table - Table Boundaries in a Writer document.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Ftables 2f Displays the tables contained in your document.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fmeasureunit 26 Specifies the Unit for HTML documents.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fhelplines aa Displays snap lnes around the frames when frames are moved. You can select the Helplines While Moving option to show the exact position of the object using lineal values.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fgraphics 3e Specifies whether to display images and objects on the screen.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fsmoothscroll 2d Activates the smooth page scrolling function.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2FViewOptionsPage 81 Defines the default settings for displaying objects in your text documents and also the default settings for the window elements.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fvrulercombobox 5d Displays the vertical ruler. Select the desired measurement unit from the corresponding list.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fvrulerright 30 Aligns the vertical ruler with the right border.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fhrulercombobox 5f Displays the horizontal ruler. Select the desired measurement unit from the corresponding list.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Fidxbox 52 Specifies the font used for indexes, alphabetical indexes, and tables of contents.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Flabelbox 3e Specifies the font used for the captions of images and tables.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Flistbox 43 Specifies the fonts for lists and numbering and all derived styles.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Fstandardbox 3e Specifies the font to be used for the Default Paragraph Style.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Ftitlebox 2b Specifies the font to be used for headings.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Findexheight 1f Specifies the size of the font.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Ftitleheight 1f Specifies the size of the font.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Flistheight 1f Specifies the size of the font.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2FOptFontTabPage 3d Specifies the settings for the basic fonts in your documents.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Fstandardheight 1f Specifies the size of the font.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Flabelheight 1f Specifies the size of the font.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fpapertray a9 For printers with multiple trays, the "Paper tray from printer settings" option specifies whether the paper tray used is specified by the system settings of the printer.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintEmptyPages%3ACheckBox 190 If this check box is marked, automatically-inserted blank pages will be printed. This is best if you are printing double-sided. For example, in a book, a "chapter" paragraph style has been set to always start with an odd numbered page. If the previous chapter ends on an odd page, %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to print that even numbered page or not.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintAnnotationMode%3AListBox 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fendpage 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fend 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Ffax 84 If you have installed fax software on your computer and wish to fax directly from the text document, select the desired fax machine.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fbackground 96 Specifies whether to include colours and objects that are inserted to the background of the page (Format - Page - Background) in the printed document.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fgraphics 41 Specifies whether the graphics of your text document are printed.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fnone 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Finblack 30 Specifies whether to always print text in black.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fhiddentext 3a Enable this option to print text that is marked as hidden.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fblankpages 190 If this check box is marked, automatically-inserted blank pages will be printed. This is best if you are printing double-sided. For example, in a book, a "chapter" paragraph style has been set to always start with an odd numbered page. If the previous chapter ends on an odd page, %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to print that even numbered page or not.
3d .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintTextPlaceholder%3ACheckBox 7a Enable this option to print text placeholders. Unmark this check box to leave the text placeholders blank in the printout.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fonly 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fformcontrols 4b Specifies whether the form control fields of the text document are printed.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2FPrintOptionsPage 38 Specifies print settings within a text or HTML document.
3c .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPageBackground%3ACheckBox 96 Specifies whether to include colours and objects that are inserted to the background of the page (Format - Page - Background) in the printed document.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Ftextplaceholder 7a Enable this option to print text placeholders. Unmark this check box to leave the text placeholders blank in the printout.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fleftpages 4a Specifies whether to print all left (even numbered) pages of the document.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Frightpages 4a Specifies whether to print all right (odd numbered) pages of the document.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintHiddenText%3ACheckBox 3a Enable this option to print text that is marked as hidden.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fbrochure 45 Select the Brochure option to print your document in brochure format.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Frtl 67 Mark this check box to print the pages of the brochure in the correct order for a right-to-left script.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Ffixprop 4d Specifies that changes to a row or column have an effect on the entire table.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Ffix 56 Specifies that changes to a row or column only affect the corresponding adjacent area.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Frowinsert 2f Specifies the default value for inserting rows.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fcolmove 33 Specifies the value to be used for moving a column.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Frowmove 30 Specifies the value to be used for moving a row.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fcolinsert 32 Specifies the default value for inserting columns.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Frepeatheader 59 Specifies whether the table heading is carried over onto the new page after a page break.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fnumalignment 43 Specifies that numbers are always bottom right aligned in the cell.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fnumformatting 4f Specifies that numbers in a text table are recognised and formatted as numbers.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fnumfmtformatting 9a If Number format recognition is not marked, only input in the format that has been set at the cell is accepted. Any other input resets the format to Text.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fheader 60 Specifies that the first row of the table is formatted with the "Table heading" Paragraph Style.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fdontsplit 43 Specifies that tables are not split by any type of text flow break.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fvar 40 Specifies that changes to a row or column affect the table size.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2FOptTablePage 33 Defines the attributes of tables in text documents.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fborder 34 Specifies that table cells have a border by default.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fcursorinprot 57 Specifies that you can set the cursor in a protected area, but cannot make any changes.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fcursoronoff 1c Activates the direct cursor.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fhiddenparafield 6e If you have inserted text using the Hidden Paragraph field, specifies whether to display the hidden paragraph.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fhiddentextfield 47 Displays text that is hidden by Conditional Text or Hidden Text fields.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fhiddentext 5f Displays text that uses the character format "hidden", when View - Formatting Marks is enabled.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fbreak 82 Displays all line breaks inserted with the Shift+Enter shortcut. These breaks create a new line, but do not start a new paragraph.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fparagraph 79 Specifies whether paragraph delimiters are displayed. The paragraph delimiters also contain paragraph format information.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2FOptFormatAidsPage 6f In $[officename] text and HTML documents, defines the display for certain characters and for the direct cursor.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Ffillspace 9f When the Direct Cursor is used, a corresponding number of tabs and spaces are inserted in the new paragraph as necessary until the clicked position is reached.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fhyphens 185 Specifies whether soft hyphens (called also as optional or discretionary hyphens) are displayed. These are hidden user-defined delimiters that you enter within a word by pressing Ctrl+Hyphen(-). Words with soft hyphens are only separated at the end of a line at the point where a soft hyphen has been inserted, irrespective of whether the automatic hyphenation is activated or deactivated.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fspaces 42 Specifies whether to represent every space in the text with a dot.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Ffilltab 7f When the direct cursor is used, as many tabs as necessary are added in the new paragraph until the clicked position is reached.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fnonbreak af Specifies that non-breaking spaces are shown as grey boxes. Non-breaking spaces are not broken at the end of a line and are entered with the Ctrl+Shift+Spacebar shortcut keys.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Ffillindent 9d When the direct cursor is used, the left paragraph indent is set at the horizontal position where you click the direct cursor. The paragraph is left aligned.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Ffillmargin 101 Sets the paragraph alignment when the direct cursor is used. Depending on where the mouse is clicked, the paragraph is formatted left aligned, centred or right aligned. The cursor before the mouse-click shows, by means of a triangle, which alignment is set.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Ftabs 37 Specifies that tab stops are displayed as small arrows.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Finsert 4a Specifies how changes in the document are displayed when text is inserted.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2FOptRedLinePage 32 Defines the appearance of changes in the document.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fchangedcolor ea You can also choose a colour to display each type of recorded change. When you choose the condition "By author" in the list, the colour is automatically determined by $[officename], then modified to match to the author of each change.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fmarkcolor 44 Specifies the colour for highlighting the changed lines in the text.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fdeleted ca Specifies how changes in the document are displayed when text is deleted. If you record text deletions, the text is displayed with the selected attribute (for example, strikethrough) and is not deleted.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fchanged 88 Defines how changes to text attributes are displayed in the document. These changes affect attributes such as bold, italic or underline.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fmarkpos 3e Defines if and where changed lines in the document are marked.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fusecharunit 99 When this setting is enabled, the measurement units of indents and spacing on Format - Paragraph - Indents & Spacing tab will be character (ch) and line.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Ftab 37 Specifies the spacing between the individual tab stops.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fmetric 35 Specifies the unit of measurement for text documents.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Falways 9c Always updates links while loading a document, and only if the document is in a trusted file location or the global security level is Low (Not recommended).
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2FOptGeneralPage 2e Specifies general settings for text documents.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fnever 31 Links are never updated while loading a document.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fonrequest 37 Updates links only on request while loading a document.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fupdatefields c8 The contents of all fields are updated automatically whenever the screen contents are displayed as new. Even with this box unchecked, some fields are updated each time a special condition takes place.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fsquaremode 47 When this setting is enabled, the text grid will look like square page.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fupdatecharts be Specifies whether to automatically update charts. Whenever a Writer table cell value changes and the cursor leaves that cell, the chart that displays the cell value is updated automatically.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcompatpage%2Fdefault 69 Click to use the current settings on this tab page as the default for further sessions with %PRODUCTNAME.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcompatpage%2FOptCompatPage 8c Specifies compatibility settings for text documents. These options help in fine-tuning %PRODUCTNAME when importing Microsoft Word documents.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Flevel 4f Specifies the headings or chapter levels where you want the numbering to start.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fobjects 4a Select the object type for which the AutoCaption settings are to be valid.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fapplyborder 41 Applies the border and shadow of the object to the caption frame.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2FOptCaptionPage 4a Select the object type for which the AutoCaption settings are to be valid.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fcategory 2e Specifies the category of the selected object.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fnumbering 29 Specifies the type of numbering required.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fseparator 57 Defines the character to be displayed after the number of the heading or chapter level.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fcharstyle 1e Specifies the character style.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fchapseparator 57 Defines the character to be displayed after the number of the heading or chapter level.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fposition 42 Determines the position of the caption with respect to the object.
14 SID_SW_ONLINEOPTIONS 46 Defines the basic settings for $[officename] documents in HTML format.
15 .uno%3AHelplinesFront 2c Sets the snap lines in front of all objects.
10 .uno%3AGridFront 2e Sets the visible grid in front of all objects.
28 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fnumflddivisiony 4c Specify the number of intermediate spaces between grid points on the y-axis.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fusegridsnap 5a Specifies whether to move frames, drawing elements, and controls only between grid points.
12 .uno%3AGridVisible 26 Specifies whether to display the grid.
28 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fnumflddivisionx 4c Specify the number of intermediate spaces between grid points on the x-axis.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2FOptGridPage cc Specifies the settings for the configurable grid on your document pages. This grid helps you determine the exact position of your objects. You can also set this grid in line with the "magnetic" snap grid.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fgridvisible 26 Specifies whether to display the grid.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fsynchronize 44 Specifies whether to change the current grid settings symmetrically.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fmtrflddrawx 4e Defines the unit of measure for the spacing between grid points on the x-axis.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fmtrflddrawy 51 Defines the grid points spacing in the desired unit of measurement on the y-axis.
13 .uno%3AToolsOptions f4 Defines various settings for spreadsheets, contents to be displayed, and the cursor direction after a cell entry. You can also define sorting lists, determine the number of decimal places and the settings for recording and highlighting changes.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Ftblreg 56 Specifies whether to display the sheet tabs at the bottom of the spreadsheet document.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fvscroll 56 Specifies whether to display a vertical scrollbar at the right of the document window.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Frowcolheader 34 Specifies whether to display row and column headers.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fsynczoom 72 If marked, all sheets are shown with the same zoom factor. If not marked, each sheet can have its own zoom factor.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fformula 43 Specifies whether to show formulae instead of results in the cells.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fanchor 67 Specifies whether the anchor icon is displayed when an inserted object, such as a graphic, is selected.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fguideline 5a Specifies whether to view guides when moving drawings, frames, graphics and other objects.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fbreak 46 Specifies whether to view the page breaks within a defined print area.
28 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fdraw 40 Defines if drawing objects in your document are shown or hidden.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2FTpViewPage 86 Defines which elements of the %PRODUCTNAME Calc main window are displayed. You can also show or hide highlighting of values in tables.
27 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fnil 36 Specifies whether to show numbers with the value of 0.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fannot d3 Specifies that a small rectangle in the top right corner of the cell indicates that a comment exists. The comment will be shown only when you enable tips under %PRODUCTNAME - General in the Options dialogue box.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Foutline 84 If you have defined an outline, the Outline symbols option specifies whether to view the outline symbols at the border of the sheet.
12 .uno%3ANoteVisible 5f To display a comment permanently, select the Show comment command from the cell's context menu.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fhscroll 59 Specifies whether to display a horizontal scrollbar at the bottom of the document window.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fcolor 3e Specifies a colour for the grid lines in the current document.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fclipmark f5 If a cell contains text that is wider than the width of the cell, the text is displayed over empty neighbouring cells in the same row. If there is no empty neighbouring cell, a small triangle at the cell border indicates that the text continues.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fvalue 112 Mark the Value highlighting box to show the cell contents in different colours, depending on type. Text cells are formatted in black, formulas in green, number cells in blue, and protected cells are shown with light grey background, no matter how their display is formatted.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Frangefind c1 Specifies that each reference is highlighted in colour in the formula. The cell range is also enclosed by a coloured border as soon as the cell containing the reference is selected for editing.
28 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fgrid dd Specifies when grid lines will be displayed. Default is to display grid lines only on cells that do not have a background colour. You can choose to also display grid lines on cells with background colour, or to hide them.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fobjgrf 34 Defines if objects and graphics are shown or hidden.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fdiagram 37 Defines if charts in your document are shown or hidden.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Freplwarncb 6d Specifies that, when you paste cells from the clipboard to a cell range that is not empty, a warning appears.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Ftextfmtcb 6a Specifies that printer metrics are applied for printing and also for formatting the display on the screen.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Fmarkhdrcb 56 Specifies whether to highlight column and row headers in the selected columns or rows.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Ftabmf 1f Defines the tab stops distance.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Falignlb 64 Determines the direction that the cursor in the spreadsheet will move after you press the Enter key.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Funitlb 2c Defines the unit of measure in spreadsheets.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Feditmodecb 4e Allows you to immediately edit the selected cell after pressing the Enter key.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Fformatcb 74 Specifies whether to automatically apply the formatting attributes of the selected cell to the empty adjacent cells.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Fexprefcb f9 Specifies whether to expand references when inserting columns or rows adjacent to the reference range. This is only possible if the reference range, where the column or row is inserted, originally spanned at least two cells in the desired direction.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortlists%2Flists 4a Displays all the available lists. These lists can be selected for editing.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortlists%2Fentries 50 Displays the content of the currently selected list. This content can be edited.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortlists%2Fcopyfrom 99 Defines the spreadsheet and the cells to copy, in order to include them in the Lists box. The currently selected range in the spreadsheet is the default.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortlists%2Fadd 23 Adds a new list into the Lists box.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortlists%2FOptSortLists a2 All user-defined lists are displayed in the Sort Lists dialogue box. You can also define and edit your own lists. Only text can be used as sort lists, no numbers.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortlists%2Fcopy 119 Copies the contents of the cells in the Copy list from box. If you select a reference to related rows and columns, the Copy List dialogue box appears after clicking the button. You can use this dialogue box to define if the reference is converted to sort lists by row or by column.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortlists%2Fnew 37 Enters the contents of a new list into the Entries box.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fcolorrowdialog%2FColOrRowDialog 2f Allows you to copy marked cells to a sort list.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fcolorrowdialog%2Fcolumns 56 Select the Columns option to summarise the contents of the selected columns in a list.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fcolorrowdialog%2Frows 50 Select the Rows option to summarise the contents of the selected rows in a list.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Flookup cc Specifies that you can use the text in any cell as a label for the column below the text or the row to the right of the text. The text must consist of at least one word and must not contain any operators.
38 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fformulaliteral 66 Specifies that only literal strings are used when searching and also for character string comparisons.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fformularegex 84 Specifies that regular expressions instead of simple wildcards are enabled when searching and also for character string comparisons.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fmatch 14e Specifies that the search criteria you set for the Calc database functions must match the whole cell exactly. When both, the Search criteria = and <> must apply to whole cells box and the Enable wildcards in formulas box are marked, $[officename] Calc behaves exactly as Microsoft Excel when searching cells in the database functions.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fcase 6b Specifies whether to distinguish between upper- and lower-case in text strings when comparing cell content.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fcalc 11b Specifies whether to make calculations using the rounded values displayed in the sheet. Charts will be shown with the displayed values. If the Precision as shown option is not marked, the displayed numbers are rounded, but they are calculated internally using the non-rounded number.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fdate1904 65 Sets 1904-01-01 as day zero. Use this setting for spreadsheets that are imported in a foreign format.
3a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2FOptCalculatePage 32 Defines the calculation settings for spreadsheets.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fprec ae Defines the number of decimals to be displayed for numbers with the General number format. The numbers are displayed as rounded numbers, but are not saved as rounded numbers.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fsteps 2b Sets the maximum number of iteration steps.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fminchange ad Specifies the difference between two consecutive iteration step results. If the result of the iteration is lower than the minimum change value, then the iteration will stop.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fdatestd 1c Sets 1899-12-30 as day zero.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fgeneralprec dd You can specify the maximum number of decimal places that are shown by default for cells with General number format. If not enabled, cells with General number format show as many decimal places as the column width allows.
3a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fformulawildcards 5e Specifies that wildcards are enabled when searching and also for character string comparisons.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fiterate b1 Specifies whether formulae with iterative references (formulae that are continuously repeated until the problem is solved) are calculated after a specific number of repetitions.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fdatesc10 64 Sets 1900-01-01 as day zero. Use this setting for StarCalc 1.0 spreadsheets containing date entries.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptchangespage%2Fentries 36 Specifies the colour to highlight moved cell contents.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptchangespage%2Fdeletions 3a Specifies the colour to highlight deletions in a document.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptchangespage%2Finsertions 3b Specifies the colour to highlight insertions in a document.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptchangespage%2FOptChangesPage 62 The Changes dialogue box specifies various options for highlighting recorded changes in documents.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptchangespage%2Fchanges 32 Specifies the colour for changes of cell contents.
27 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptdlg%2FprintCB ef Specifies that only contents from selected sheets are printed, even if you specify a wider range in the File - Print dialogue box or in the Format - Print Ranges dialogue box. Contents from sheets that are not selected will not be printed.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptdlg%2FoptCalcPrintPage 31 Determines the printer settings for spreadsheets.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptdlg%2FsuppressCB 56 Specifies that empty pages that have no cell contents or draw objects are not printed.
42 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcompatibilitypage%2FOptCompatibilityPage 34 Defines compatibility options for %PRODUCTNAME Calc.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptformula%2FOptFormula 49 Defines formula syntax options and loading options for %PRODUCTNAME Calc.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptdefaultpage%2FOptDefaultPage 37 Defines default settings for new spreadsheet documents.
14 .uno%3ASdEditOptions ad Defines various settings for newly created presentation documents, such as the contents to be displayed, the measurement unit used, if and how grid alignment is carried out.
32 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fsdviewpage%2Fmoveoutline 59 %PRODUCTNAME displays the contour line of each individual object when moving this object.
34 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fsdviewpage%2Fhandlesbezier ec Displays the control points of all Bézier points if you have previously selected a Bézier curve. If the All control points in Bézier editor option is not marked, only the control points of the selected Bézier points will be visible.
32 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fsdviewpage%2Fdragstripes 3a Specifies whether to display guides when moving an object.
14 .uno%3AHelplinesMove 3a Specifies whether to display guides when moving an object.
31 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fsdviewpage%2FSdViewPage 26 Specifies the available display modes.
2c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fsdviewpage%2Fruler 54 Specifies whether to display the rulers at the top and to the left of the work area.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fmtrfldangle 7c Specifies that graphic objects can only be rotated within the rotation angle that you selected in the When rotating control.
21 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fbigortho 16b Specifies that a square is created based on the longer side of a rectangle when the Shift key is pressed before you release the mouse button. This also applies to an ellipse (a circle will be created based on the longest diameter of the ellipse). When the Extend edges box is not marked, a square or a circle will be created based on the shorter side or diameter.
1e svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fortho 79 Specifies that graphic objects are restricted vertically, horizontally or diagonally (45°) when creating or moving them.
26 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fsnaphelplines 57 Snaps the edge of a dragged object to the nearest snap line when you release the mouse.
23 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fsnapborder 58 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the nearest page margin.
27 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fmtrfldbezangle 26 Defines the angle for point reduction.
27 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fmtrfldsnaparea cc Defines the snap distance between the mouse pointer and the object contour. $[officename] Impress snaps to a snap point if the mouse pointer is nearer than the distance selected in the Snap range control.
13 HID_SD_OPTIONS_SNAP 3a Defines the grid settings for creating and moving objects.
22 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fsnapframe 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the border of the nearest graphic object.
23 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fsnappoints 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the points of the nearest graphic object.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fpapertryfrmprntrcb 52 Determines that the paper tray to be used is the one defined in the printer setup.
2b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fbackcb 2c Select Back to print the back of a brochure.
2d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fbrouchrb 44 Select the Brochure option to print the document in brochure format.
2e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Ffittopgrb 89 Specifies whether to scale down objects that are beyond the margins of the current printer, so that they fit on the paper in the printer.
32 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fpagedefaultrb 44 Specifies that you do not want to further scale pages when printing.
31 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fblackwhiterb 41 Specifies that you want to print the document in black and white.
30 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fgrayscalerb 36 Specifies that you want to print colours as greyscale.
2d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fpagenmcb 29 Specifies whether to print the page name.
2c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Ffrontcb 2e Select Front to print the front of a brochure.
2d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fprntopts 43 Specifies print settings within a drawing or presentation document.
2d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Ftilepgrb a8 Specifies that pages are to be printed in tiled format. If the pages or slides are smaller than the paper, several pages or slides will be printed on one page of paper.
2b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fdatecb 2c Specifies whether to print the current date.
2b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Ftimecb 2c Specifies whether to print the current time.
2e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fdefaultrb 35 Specifies that you want to print in original colours.
2f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fhiddenpgcb 55 Specifies whether to print the pages that are currently hidden from the presentation.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2FcbCompatibility 68 Specifies that $[officename] Impress calculates the paragraph spacing exactly like Microsoft PowerPoint.
3a modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2FscaleBox 2b Determines the drawing scale on the rulers.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2FmetricFields 26 Defines the spacing between tab stops.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fdistrotcb 71 Maintains relative alignment of Bézier points and 2-D drawing objects to each other when you distort the object.
3a modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fqickedit 6e If on, you can edit text immediately after clicking a text object. If off, you must double-click to edit text.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fenremotcont 54 Specifies that you want to enable Bluetooth remote control while Impress is running.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2FOptSavePage 42 Defines the general options for drawing or presentation documents.
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fobjalwymov a6 Specifies that you want to move an object with the Rotate tool enabled. If Object always moveable is not marked, the Rotate tool can only be used to rotate an object.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fcopywhenmove 56 If enabled, a copy is created when you move an object while holding down the Ctrl key.
10 .uno%3AQuickEdit 6e If on, you can edit text immediately after clicking a text object. If off, you must double-click to edit text.
12 .uno%3APickThrough 3e Specifies whether to select a text frame by clicking the text.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Funits 35 Determines the Unit of measurement for presentations.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fstartwithwizard 64 Specifies whether to activate the Wizard when opening a presentation with File - New - Presentation.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fbackgroundback 4e Specifies whether to use the cache for displaying objects on the master slide.
17 .uno%3ASdGraphicOptions ae Defines the global settings for drawing documents, including the contents to be displayed, the scale to be used, the grid alignment and the contents to be printed by default.
14 .uno%3ASmEditOptions 97 Defines the print format and print options for all new formula documents. These options apply when you print a formula directly from %PRODUCTNAME Math.
34 modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fnorightspaces 56 Specifies that these space wildcards will be removed if they are at the end of a line.
2c modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Ftitle 53 Specifies whether you want the name of the document to be included in the printout.
d tobeannounced 4a Saves only those symbols which each formula that are used in that formula.
2c modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fframe 3a Applies a thin border to the formula area in the printout.
2b modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fzoom 56 Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified enlargement factor.
34 modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2FSmathSettings 3e Defines formula settings that will be valid for all documents.
2b modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Ftext 5f Specifies whether to include the contents of the Commands window at the bottom of the printout.
31 modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fsizenormal 3b Prints the formula without adjusting the current font size.
31 modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fsizescaled 3c Adjusts the formula to the page format used in the printout.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptchartcolorspage%2Fdefault 4e Restores the colour settings that were defined when the program was installed.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptchartcolorspage%2Fcolors 37 Displays all the colours available for the data series.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fex_saveorig bf The VBA (Visual Basic for Applications) code will be loaded ready to be executed. If this check box is not marked, the VBA code will be commented out so it can be inspected, but will not run.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fpp_saveorig bf The VBA (Visual Basic for Applications) code will be loaded ready to be executed. If this check box is not marked, the VBA code will be commented out so it can be inspected, but will not run.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fwo_saveorig 120 Specifies that the original Microsoft Basic code contained in the document is held in a special internal memory for as long as the document remains loaded in $[officename]. When saving the document in Microsoft format the Microsoft Basic is saved again with the code in an unchanged form.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2FOptFltrPage 81 Specifies the general properties for loading and saving Microsoft Office documents with VBA (Visual Basic for Applications) code.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fwo_basic d8 Loads and saves the Basic code from a Microsoft document as a special $[officename] Basic module with the document. The disabled Microsoft Basic code is visible in the $[officename] Basic IDE between Sub and End Sub.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrembedpage%2Fchecklbcontainer ad The List Box field displays the entries for the pair of OLE objects that can be converted when loading into $[officename] (L) and/or when saving into a Microsoft format (S).
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fctlsupport 7c Activates complex text layout support. You can now modify the settings corresponding to complex text layout in %PRODUCTNAME.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fasiansupport 70 Activates Asian languages support. You can now modify the corresponding Asian language settings in %PRODUCTNAME.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fasianlanguage 4f Specifies the language used for the spelling check function in Asian alphabets.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fwesternlanguage 51 Specifies the language used for the spelling check function in western alphabets.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fcurrentdoc 5a Specifies that the settings for default languages are valid only for the current document.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fcomplexlanguage 42 Specifies the language for the complex text layout spelling check.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fuserinterface ca Select the language used for the user interface, for example menus, dialogue boxes, help files. You must have installed at least one additional language pack or a multi-language version of %PRODUCTNAME.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2FOptLanguagesPage 4b Defines the default languages and some other locale settings for documents.
32 cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fignorelanguagechange dd Indicates whether changes to the system input language/keyboard will be ignored. If ignored, when new text is typed that text will follow the language of the document or current paragraph, not the current system language.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Flocalesetting 7b Specifies the locale setting of the country setting. This influences settings for numbering, currency and units of measure.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fdecimalseparator 7a Specifies to use the decimal separator key that is set in your system when you press the respective key on the number pad.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fcurrencylb 5c Specifies the default currency that is used for the currency format and the currency fields.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fdatepatterns cd Specifies the date acceptance patterns for the current locale. Calc spreadsheet and Writer table cell input needs to match locale dependent date acceptance patterns before it is recognised as a valid date.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fstart 51 Specifies the characters that should not appear alone at the beginning of a line.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fstandard 75 When you mark Default, the following two text boxes are filled with the default characters for the selected language:
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fcharpunctkerning 4d Specifies that kerning is applied to both western text and Asian punctuation.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fnocompression 30 Specifies that no compression at all will occur.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fpunctcompression 32 Specifies that only the punctuation is compressed.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fpunctkanacompression 3c Specifies that punctuation and Japanese Kana are compressed.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fend 4b Specifies the characters that should not appear alone at the end of a line.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fcharkerning 37 Specifies that kerning is only applied to western text.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Flanguage 4e Specifies the language for which you want to define first and last characters.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fignoremiddledot 27 Specifies the characters to be ignored.
33 cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchprolongedsoundmark 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2Fnumerals ac Selects the type of numerals used within text, text in objects, fields, and controls, in all %PRODUCTNAME modules. Only cell contents of %PRODUCTNAME Calc are not affected.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2Fmovementvisual 9d Pressing the Right Arrow key moves the text cursor in the right-hand direction. Pressing the Left Arrow key moves the text cursor in the left-hand direction.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2Fmovementlogical b4 Pressing the Right Arrow key moves the text cursor towards the end of the current text. Pressing the Left Arrow key moves the text cursor towards the beginning of the current text.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2Frestricted 4b Prevents the use as well as the printing of illegal character combinations.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2FOptCTLPage 3c Defines the options for documents with complex text layouts.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2Fsequencechecking 3b Enables sequence input checking for languages such as Thai.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fconnpooloptions%2Ftimeout 45 Defines the time in seconds after which a pooled connection is freed.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fconnpooloptions%2Fconnectionpooling 34 Specifies whether the chosen connections are pooled.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fconnpooloptions%2Fenablepooling 74 Select a driver from the list and mark the Enable pooling for this driver check box in order to pool its connection.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fdbregisterpage%2Fedit 40 Opens the Database Link dialogue box to edit the selected entry.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fdbregisterpage%2Fdelete 29 Removes the selected entry from the list.
17 CUI_HID_DBPATH_CTL_PATH 67 Lists the registered name and database file of all registered databases. Double-click an entry to edit.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fdbregisterpage%2Fnew 3b Opens the Database Link dialogue box to create a new entry.
32 cui%2Fui%2Fdatabaselinkdialog%2FDatabaseLinkDialog 34 Creates or edits an entry in the Databases tab page.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fdatabaselinkdialog%2Fname 52 Enter a name for the database. %PRODUCTNAME uses this name to access the database.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fdatabaselinkdialog%2Fbrowse 44 Opens a file dialogue box in which you can select the database file.
31 cui%2Fui%2Foptbasicidepage%2Fextendedtypes_enable 2c Allow UNO object types as valid Basic types.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptbasicidepage%2Fautoclose_proc 37 Automatically insert closing statements for procedures.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptbasicidepage%2Fautoclose_paren 25 Automatically close open parenthesis.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptbasicidepage%2Fautoclose_quotes 20 Automatically close open quotes.
30 cui%2Fui%2Foptbasicidepage%2Fcodecomplete_enable 22 Display methods of a Basic object.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptbasicidepage%2Fautocorrect 3b Correct cases of Basic variables and keywords while typing.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fexpertconfig 64 Opens the Expert Configuration dialogue box for advanced settings and configuration of %PRODUCTNAME.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fjavas b7 Select the JRE that you want to use. On some systems, you must wait a minute until the list gets populated. On some systems, you must restart %PRODUCTNAME to use your changed setting.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fexperimental 1c Enable experimental features
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fadd 38 Add a path to the root folder of a JRE on your computer.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fmacrorecording 16 Enable macro recording
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fjavaenabled 34 Allows you to run Java applications in %PRODUCTNAME.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fparameters 2d Opens the Java Start Parameters dialogue box.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fclasspath 22 Opens the Class Path dialogue box.
23 cui%2Fui%2Faboutconfigdialog%2Fedit 2c Opens a dialogue box to edit the preference.
2a cui%2Fui%2Faboutconfigdialog%2Fpreferences 3f List the preferences organised hierarchically in a tree layout.
24 cui%2Fui%2Faboutconfigdialog%2Freset 2e Undo changes done so far in this dialogue box.
2b cui%2Fui%2Faboutconfigdialog%2FsearchButton 3d Click to search your preference text in the Preferences tree.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fexpertconfig 64 Opens the Expert Configuration dialogue box for advanced settings and configuration of %PRODUCTNAME.
2a cui%2Fui%2Faboutconfigdialog%2FsearchEntry 38 Type the preference you want to display in the text area
27 cui%2Fui%2Fjavaclasspathdialog%2Fremove 64 Select an archive or a folder in the list and click Remove to remove the object from the class path.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fjavaclasspathdialog%2Ffolder 35 Select a folder and add the folder to the class path.
30 SVX_EDIT_RID_SVXPAGE_INET_SCRIPTING_ED_CLASSPATH 3f Specifies the location of Java classes or Java class libraries.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fjavaclasspathdialog%2Farchive 4f Select an archive file in jar or zip format and add the file to the class path.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fjavastartparametersdialog%2Fremovebtn 29 Deletes the selected JRE start parameter.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fjavastartparametersdialog%2Fassignbtn 31 Adds the current JRE start parameter to the list.
35 cui%2Fui%2Fjavastartparametersdialog%2Fparameterfield 8e Enter a start parameter for a JRE as you would on a command line. Click Assign to add the parameter to the list of available start parameters.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fjavastartparametersdialog%2Feditbtn 4a Opens a dialogue box where the selected JRE start parameter can be edited.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fjavastartparametersdialog%2Fassignlist 72 Lists the assigned JRE start parameters. To remove a start parameter, select the parameter, and then click Remove.
25 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritylevelpage%2Flow c5 A macro can be set to auto-start, and it can perform potentially damaging actions, as for example delete or rename files. This setting is not recommended when you open documents from other authors.
25 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritylevelpage%2Fmed e6 Trusted sources can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Signed macros from a trusted source are allowed to run. In addition, any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run. All other macros require your confirmation.
33 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritylevelpage%2FSecurityLevelPage 7c Trusted file locations can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run.
26 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritylevelpage%2Fhigh bf Trusted sources can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Only signed macros from a trusted source are allowed to run. In addition, any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run.
27 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritylevelpage%2Fvhigh 7c Trusted file locations can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run.
2c xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Fremovefile 44 Removes the selected folder from the list of trusted file locations.
2a xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Fviewcert 45 Opens the View Certificate dialogue box for the selected certificate.
2c xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Fremovecert 47 Removes the selected certificate from the list of trusted certificates.
2e xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Fcertificates 1f Lists the trusted certificates.
2b xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Flocations c4 Trusted file locations are used only if the security level is set to "very high". With this setting, document macros are only executed if they have been opened from one of the following locations.
33 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2FSecurityTrustPage 1f Lists the trusted certificates.
29 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Faddfile 64 Opens a folder selection dialogue box. Select a folder from which all macros are allowed to execute.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Fserverauthentication 7b Opens the Server Authentication dialogue box in which you can specify the server authentication settings for secure e-mail.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Fsecure 39 When available, uses a secure connection to send e-mails.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Ftest 4a Opens the Test Account Settings dialogue box to test the current settings.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Fdisplayname 10 Enter your name.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Fserver 1b Enter the SMTP server name.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Faddress 26 Enter your e-mail address for replies.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Fport 14 Enter the SMTP port.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2FMailConfigPage 65 Specifies the user information and server settings for when you send form letters as e-mail messages.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Freplytocb 64 Uses the e-mail address that you enter in the Reply address text box as the reply-to e-mail address.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Freplyto 2c Enter the address to use for e-mail replies.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Fchangepath 2f Click to select a folder to download the files.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Fdestpathlabel 3b Displays the selected folder to store the downloaded files.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Fautodownload 41 Enable the automatic download of updates to the specified folder.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Fautocheck 82 Mark to check for online updates periodically, then select the time interval how often %PRODUCTNAME will check for online updates.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Feverymonth 27 A check will be performed once a month.
34 cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2FOptOnlineUpdatePage 68 Specifies some options for the automatic notification and downloading of online updates to %PRODUCTNAME.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Feveryday 25 A check will be performed once a day.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Feveryweek 43 A check will be performed once a week. This is the default setting.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Fchecknow 1e A check will be performed now.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fselect_persona_dialog%2Fframe4 56 Shows a random choice of nine themes based on the categories displayed in the buttons.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fselect_persona_dialog%2Fsearch_term 30 Type or paste the URL of the theme’s web page.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fpersonalization_tab%2Fown_persona 59 Choose this option to open the “Select Firefox Theme” dialogue box and pick your own.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpersonalization_tab%2Fno_persona 58 The toolbars’ background inherits the background settings of your desktop environment.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fpersonalization_tab%2Fdefault_persona 27 Display the system theme, if available.
42 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Finusername 28 Enter the user name for the IMAP server.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fimap 32 Specifies that the incoming mail server uses IMAP.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fpop3 33 Specifies that the incoming mail server uses POP 3.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fserver 38 Enter the server name of your POP 3 or IMAP mail server.
42 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Finpassword 13 Enter the password.
54 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2FAuthenticationSettingsDialog 43 Enables the authentication that is required to send e-mail by SMTP.
4e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fseparateauthentication 3d Select if your SMTP server requires a user name and password.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fport 2a Enter the port on the POP3 or IMAP server.
46 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fauthentication 43 Enables the authentication that is required to send e-mail by SMTP.
43 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Foutpassword 25 Enter the password for the user name.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fusername 28 Enter the user name for the SMTP server.
44 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fsmtpafterpop 50 Select if you are required to first read your e-mail before you can send e-mail.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftestmailsettings%2Fstop 36 Click the Stop button to stop a test session manually.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftestmailsettings%2FTestMailSettings 68 In the Errors list box you can read an explanation of any errors encountered while testing the settings.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftestmailsettings%2Ferrors 68 In the Errors list box you can read an explanation of any errors encountered while testing the settings.
21 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fcertpage%2FCertPage 77 The Certificate Path page of the View Certificate dialogue box displays the location and the status of the certificate.
23 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fcertpage%2Fsignatures 77 The Certificate Path page of the View Certificate dialogue box displays the location and the status of the certificate.
1f xmlsec%2Fui%2Fcertpage%2Fstatus 77 The Certificate Path page of the View Certificate dialogue box displays the location and the status of the certificate.
28 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fcertdetails%2Fvaluedetails 45 Use the value list box to view values and copy them to the clipboard.
2a xmlsec%2Fui%2Fcertdetails%2Ftablecontainer 6a The Details page of the View Certificate dialogue box displays detailed information about the certificate.
27 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fcertdetails%2FCertDetails 6a The Details page of the View Certificate dialogue box displays detailed information about the certificate.
20 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fcertgeneral%2Fbox1 67 The General page of the View Certificate dialogue box displays basic information about the certificate.